DELL 5130CDN User Manual

Dell™ 5130cdn Color Laser Printer User's Guide  
Before Beginning  
Know Your Printer  
Setting Up the Printer (Printer Setup)  
Using Your Printer  
Maintaining Your Printer  
Troubleshooting  
Appendix  
Notes, Notices, and Cautions  
NOTE: A NOTE indicates important information that helps you make better use of your printer.  
NOTICE: A NOTICE indicates either potential damage to hardware or loss of data and tells you how to avoid the  
problem.  
CAUTION: A CAUTION indicates a potential for property damage, personal injury, or death.  
Information in this document is subject to change without notice.  
© 2009 Dell Inc. All rights reserved.  
Reproduction of these materials in any manner whatsoever without the written permission of Dell Inc. is strictly forbidden.  
Trademarks used in this text: Dell and the DELL logo are trademarks of Dell Inc.; Microsoft, Windows, Windows Server,  
Windows Vista, and Active Directory are either trademarks or registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United  
States and/or other countries; MAC OS is a registered trademark of Apple Inc.; Adobe is either a registered trademark or  
a trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries; Wi-Fi is a registered trademarks  
of the Wi-Fi Alliance.  
Other trademarks and trade names may be used in this document to refer to either the entities claiming the marks and  
names or their products. Dell Inc. disclaims any proprietary interest in trademarks and trade names other than its own.  
Our printer software uses some of the codes defined by the Independent JPEG Group.  
 
Dell™ 5130cdn Color Laser Printer User's Guide  
Click the links to the left for information on the features, options, and operation of your printer. For information on other  
documentation included with your printer, see "Finding Information."  
To order replacement toner cartridges or supplies from Dell:  
1. Double-click the icon on your desktop.  
If you cannot find the icon on your desktop, follow the procedure below.  
a. Click DLRMM.EXE from "C:\Program Files\Dell Printers\Additional Color Laser  
Software\Reorder".  
NOTE: "C:\Program Files\" may be different depending on the destination of the folder which you installed  
the Dell software and documentation.  
b. Click File on the toolbar, and click Create Shortcut on the drop-down menu that appears.  
c. Right-click on the shortcut icon that is created.  
d. Choose Send To from the drop-down menu, and then click Desktop (create shortcut) on the submenu  
that appears.  
2. Visit the Dell Printer Supplies website at www.dell.com/supplies, or order Dell printer supplies by phone.  
For best service, have your Dell printer Service Tag available.  
For help locating your Service Tag, see "Express Service Code and Service Tag."  
 
Finding Information  
NOTE: The following are options you can buy separately.  
USB cable  
Ethernet cable  
Parallel cable  
Wireless adapter  
550-sheet feeder  
1100-sheet feeder  
Hard disk  
Upgradable Memory Module  
Output Expander  
What are you looking  
Find it here  
for?  
Drivers and Utilities CD  
Drivers for my  
printer  
My User's Guide  
The Drivers and Utilities CD contains Setup Video, Maintenance Video, documentation, and  
drivers for your printer. You can use the CD to uninstall/reinstall drivers or access the Setup  
Video and documentation.  
Readme files may be included on your CD to provide last-minute updates about technical  
changes to your printer or advanced technical reference material for experienced users or  
technicians.  
Quick Reference Guide  
How to use my  
printer  
Product Information Guide  
Safety information  
Warranty  
information  
   
CAUTION: Read and follow all safety instructions in your Product Information Guide  
prior to setting up and operating your printer.  
Setup diagram  
How to set up my  
printer  
Troubleshooting  
Express Service Code  
and Service Tag  
The Express Service Code and Service Tag are located on the right side of the toner cartridge  
inside the front cover and on the rear cover of your printer.  
See the Dell Support website at support.dell.com  
The Dell Support website, support.dell.com, provides several online tools, including:  
Latest drivers for  
my printer  
Answers to  
technical service  
and support  
questions  
Documentation for  
my printer  
Solutions - Troubleshooting hints and tips, articles from technicians, and online  
courses  
Upgrades - Upgrade information for components, such as printer driver  
Customer Care - Contact information, order status, warranty, and repair  
information  
Downloads - Drivers  
Manuals - Printer documentation and product specifications  
You can access the Dell Support website at support.dell.com. Select your region on the  
support page, and fill in the requested details to access help tools and information.  
About the Printer  
The following illustrations show the standard Dell™ 5130cdn Color Laser Printer and some optional accessories.  
Front, Side, and Back View  
Front View  
1 Center Output Tray  
3 Waste Toner Box  
2 Right Hand Cover  
4 Inner Cover  
5 550-Sheet Feeder (optional) 6 1100-Sheet Feeder (optional)  
7 Tray 1  
8 Front Cover  
9 Belt Unit  
NOTE: Your printer allows for a maximum of 6 trays (Tray 1, two 550-sheet feeders, 1100-sheet feeder, and MPF).  
NOTE: The following combinations of trays are available:  
Tray 1  
Tray 1 + 550-sheet feeder x 1  
Tray 1 + 550-sheet feeder x 2  
Tray 1 + 550-sheet feeder x 1 + 1100-sheet feeder  
Tray 1 + 550-sheet feeder x 2 + 1100-sheet feeder  
Tray 1 + 1100-sheet feeder  
However, you cannot combine two 1100-sheet feeders.  
   
Right View  
1 Duplexer  
2 Right Hand Cover Handle  
3 Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) 4 Power Switch  
5 Transfer Roller  
6 Fuser  
Left View  
Output Expander (optional)  
1 Stacker Tray 2 H Transport Unit  
3 Knob  
4 Stapler Cartridge  
Rear View  
1 Control Board Cover  
3 Wireless Adapter Socket  
5 Parallel Port  
2 Ethernet Port  
4 USB Port  
6 Power Connector for Main Unit  
7 Power Connector for Output Expander 8 Control Board  
NOTE: When you use the printer with the MPF opened, do not locate the printer in direct sunlight. Doing so may  
cause a malfunction or unnatural screen image.  
Provide enough room to open the printer tray, covers, and option. It is also important to allow space around the printer  
for proper ventilation.  
Operator Panel  
For details on the operator panel, see "Operator Panel."  
Securing the Printer  
To protect your printer from theft, you can use the optional Kensington lock.  
Attach the Kensington lock to the security slot of your printer.  
   
For details, see the operating instructions supplied with the Kensington lock.  
Ordering Supplies  
You can order consumables from Dell on the Internet when using a networked printer. Enter the IP address of your  
printer in your web browser, launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, and click the Order Supplies at: to  
order toner for your printer.  
You can also order toner cartridges by the following method:  
1. Click start ® All Programs ® Dell Printers ® Additional Color Laser Software ® Dell Supplies Management  
System.  
The Dell Supplies Management System window appears.  
2. Select your printer from the Select Printer Model list.  
3. If ordering from the Web:  
a. When you cannot get information from the printer automatically by two-way communication, a window that  
prompts you to type the Service Tag appears. Type your Dell printer Service Tag in the field provided.  
Your Service Tag is located inside the front cover of your printer.  
b. Select a URL from the Select Reorder URL list.  
c. Click Visit Dell printer supplies ordering web site.  
If ordering by phone, call the number that appears under the Order by Phone heading.  
 
Prepare Printer Hardware  
Removing Tape  
1. Remove the tape from the printer.  
2. Remove the instruction sheet from the printer.  
Refer to this sheet for setting up the drums and the toner cartridges.  
Removing the Drum Ribbons  
1. Open the front cover.  
2. Pull out the ribbons (8), then remove the packaging material from the front of the printer.  
     
Installing the Toner Cartridges  
CAUTION: Before performing any of the following procedures, read and follow the safety instructions in  
your Product Information Guide.  
1. Open the front cover.  
2. Ready the toner cartridges for installation.  
3. Shake the yellow cartridge 5 to 6 times to distribute the toner evenly.  
   
NOTE: Do not touch the area shown in the illustration when you shake the cartridge.  
4. Align the arrow on the cartridge with the arrow on the printer, and slide in the cartridge until it stops.  
5. Repeat Step 2 to Step 4 to install magenta, cyan, and black cartridges.  
6. Close the front cover.  
Loading Paper  
NOTE: To avoid paper jams, do not remove the tray while a printing is in progress.  
NOTE: Use only laser print media. Do not use ink jet paper in this printer.  
NOTE: For printing from the MPF or envelope printing, see "Loading Print Media."  
All trays are loaded the same way:  
1. Remove the paper tray from the printer.  
2. Adjust the width guides to the size of paper to be loaded.  
   
3. Adjust the length guide to the size of paper to be loaded.  
4. Before loading the paper, flex the sheets back and forth, and then fan them. Straighten the edges of the stack on a  
level surface.  
5. Load paper into the tray with the recommended print side facing up.  
NOTE: Do not exceed the maximum fill line in the tray. Overfilling the tray may cause paper jams.  
6. After confirming that the guides are securely adjusted, replace the paper tray into the printer.  
7. Select the paper type from the operator panel if any print media other than plain print media is loaded. If a user-  
specified print media is loaded in the standard 550-sheet tray, you must specify the paper size setting by using the  
operator panel.  
NOTE: For standard-size papers, adjust the guides first and then set papers.  
Install Optional Accessories (if applicable)  
You can make the printer more functional by installing the optional accessories. This chapter describes how to install  
printer accessories such as the 550-sheet feeder and wireless adapter.  
Installing a 550-Sheet Feeder  
CAUTION: If you are adding a 550-sheet feeder after setting up the printer, be sure to turn off the  
printer, unplug the power cable, and disconnect all cables from the back of the printer before  
completing these tasks.  
CAUTION: When lifting the 550-sheet feeder, grasp and lift the printer as instructed on the label of the  
feeder.  
1. Turn off the printer and unplug the power cable. Then, disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.  
2. Pull out the tray until it stops. Lift the front slightly and remove it.  
3. Lift the printer and align the three guide pins of the 550-sheet feeder with the holes at the bottom of the printer.  
Gently lower the printer onto the 550-sheet feeder.  
   
CAUTION: You need three people to lift the printer.  
CAUTION: Be careful not to catch your fingers between the printer and the sheet feeder.  
4. Tighten the two screws provided with the feeder using a coin or screw driver.  
5. Secure the printer and the 550-sheet feeder with a plastic clamp-lock and the long screw provided with the feeder.  
6. Insert the tray into the printer, and push it until it stops.  
7. Remove the tray from the 550-sheet feeder.  
8. Adjust the width guides to the size of paper to be loaded.  
9. Adjust the length guide to the size of paper to be loaded.  
10. Load paper into the tray with the recommended print side facing up.  
11. Replace the tray to the 550-sheet feeder.  
12. Connect the power cable to the printer and then to the power source.  
13. Fix the power cable on the printer with the plastic fastener.  
14. Turn on the printer.  
NOTE: If a message displays telling you to make initial setup on the operator panel, always do as instructed.  
NOTE: The printer will automatically detect the attached tray but will not detect the paper type.  
15. Print the printer settings page to verify if the 550-sheet feeder is installed correctly by following the instructions  
Printing Printer Settings Page  
 
When Using the Operator Panel  
a. Press Menu button.  
b. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button. Printer Setting is displayed.  
c. Press  
(Set) button.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
d. Verify 550-Sheet Feeder is listed in the printer settings under Printer Options.  
If the feeder is not listed, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the 550-sheet feeder.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
a. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
1) Open the web browser.  
2) Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
b. Select Printer Settings.  
c. Click the Printer Settings Report tab.  
d. Select Reports.  
e. Click Start on the Printer Settings.  
The printer settings report is printed.  
f. Verify if 550-Sheet Feeder is listed in the printer settings.  
If the feeder is not listed, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the 550-sheet feeder.  
16. After loading paper in the installed tray, specify the paper type using the printer operator panel:  
a. Press Menu button.  
b. Press  
c. Press  
button until Tray Settings is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until the installed tray is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
d. Ensure Paper Type is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
e. Press button until the paper type of the installed tray is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
f. Confirm that the selected paper type is marked with a bullet, and then press the Menu button.  
NOTE: If you installed the 550-sheet feeder after installing the printer driver, update your driver by following the  
instructions for each operating system. If the printer is on a network, update the driver for each client.  
To complete installation of the accessory, the printer driver must be updated to detect it.  
Updating Your Driver to Detect 550-Sheet Feeder  
When Using PCL/XPS Driver  
®
®
NOTE: XPS driver is supported on the following operating systems: Windows 7, Windows 7 x64, Windows Vista ,  
®
Windows Vista x64, Windows Server 2008 R2 x64, Windows Server 2008, and Windows Server 2008 x64.  
®
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
Windows 7/Windows 7  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Printer properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
®
x64/Windows Server 2008  
R2 x64  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable Bi-  
Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
®
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
Windows Vista /Vista x64  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable Bi-  
Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server  
2008 x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable Bi-  
Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows XP/XP x64/Server  
2003/Server 2003 x64  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
If the printer information is not updated automatically after clicking Get Information from Printer, follow these steps:  
1. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select any of the available trays from the Paper Tray  
Configuration.  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then remove the check mark from Enable Bi-Directional  
Communication check box.  
Select any of the available trays from the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the displayed active dialog box.  
When Using PS Driver  
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Printer  
properties from the displayed list.  
Windows 7/Windows 7  
x64/Server 2008 R2 x64  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
Windows Vista/Vista x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server  
2008 x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows XP/XP x64/Server  
2003/Server 2003 x64  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
®
1. Select the Print & Fax in System Preferences.  
2. Select the printer in Printers list, and click Options & Supplies.  
3. Select Driver, select the options that have been installed on the printers, and  
then click OK.  
Mac OS X 10.5.x  
Mac OS X 10.3.x/10.4.x  
1. Select the printer from the Printer List screen in Print Center (or Printer  
Setup Utility).  
2. Click Printers on the Print Center (or Printer Setup Utility) menu bar, and  
select Show Info.  
3. Select Installable Options, and select the options that have been installed on  
the printer, and then click Apply Changes.  
Mac OS 9  
1. Select a desktop printer related to the model.  
2. Click Printing on the System menu bar, and select Change Setup.  
3. Select Paper Tray Configuration on the Change menu.  
4. Select the option that has been installed on the printer on the To menu, and  
then click OK.  
Installing a 1100-Sheet Feeder  
1. Turn off the printer and unplug the power cable. Then, disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.  
2. Lock down the brakes of the two casters at the front of the optional 1100- sheet feeder.  
CAUTION: Failure to lock the brakes can cause the printer to move unexpectedly, resulting in personal  
injury.  
NOTE: For easier and safer locking, make the brakes of the two casters face forward by pushing the 1100-sheet  
feeder backward.  
3. Pull out the tray until it stops. Lift the front of the tray slightly and remove it.  
 
4. Lift the printer and align the three guide pins of the optional 1100-sheet feeder with the holes at the bottom of the  
printer. Gently lower the printer onto the 1100-sheet feeder.  
CAUTION: You need three people to lift the printer.  
CAUTION: Be careful not to catch your fingers between the printer and the sheet feeder.  
5. Tighten the two screws provided with the feeder using a coin or screw driver.  
6. Secure the printer and the 1100-sheet feeder with a plastic clamp-lock and the long screw provided with the  
feeder.  
7. Insert the tray into the printer, and push until it stops.  
8. Remove the tray from the 1100-sheet feeder.  
9. Adjust the width guides to the size of paper to be loaded.  
10. Adjust the length guide to the size of paper to be loaded.  
11. Load paper into the tray with the recommended print side facing up.  
12. Return the tray to the 1100-sheet feeder.  
13. Connect the power cable to the printer and then to the power source.  
14. Fix the power cable on the printer with the plastic fastener.  
15. Turn on the printer.  
NOTE: If a message displays telling you to make initial setup on the operator panel, always do as instructed.  
NOTE: The printer will automatically detect the attached tray(s) but will not detect the paper type.  
16. Print a printer settings page to verify the 1100-sheet feeder is installed correctly by following the instructions. See  
Printing Printer Settings Page  
When Using the Operator Panel  
a. Press Menu button.  
b. Ensure that Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button. Printer Setting is displayed.  
c. Press  
(Set) button.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
d. Verify 1100-Sheet Feeder is listed in the printer settings under Printer Options.  
If the feeder is not listed, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the 1100-sheet feeder.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
a. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
1) Open the web browser.  
2) Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
b. Select Printer Settings.  
c. Click the Printer Settings Report tab.  
d. Select Reports.  
e. Click Start on the Printer Settings.  
The printer settings report is printed.  
f. Verify 1100-Sheet Feeder is listed in the printer settings.  
If the feeder is not listed, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the 1100-sheet feeder.  
17. After loading paper in the installed tray, specify the paper type from the printer operator panel.  
a. Press Menu button.  
b. Press  
c. Press  
button until Tray Settings is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until the installed tray is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
d. Ensure that Paper Typeis highlighted, and then press  
e. Press button until the paper type for the installed tray is highlighted, and then press  
f. Confirm that the selected paper type is marked with a bullet, and then press Menu button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
 
NOTE: If you installed the 1100-sheet feeder after installing the printer driver, update your driver by  
following the instructions for each operating system. If the printer is on a network, update the driver for each  
client.  
To complete installation of the accessory, the printer driver must be updated to detect it.  
Updating Your Driver to Detect 1100-Sheet Feeder  
When Using PCL/XPS Driver  
NOTE: XPS driver is supported on the following operating systems: Windows 7, Windows 7 x64, Windows Vista,  
Windows Vista x64, Windows Server 2008 R2 x64, Windows Server 2008, and Windows Server 2008 x64.  
®
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
Windows 7/Windows 7  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Printer properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
®
x64/Windows Server 2008  
R2 x64  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable Bi-  
Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
®
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
Windows Vista /Vista x64  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable Bi-  
Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server  
2008 x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable Bi-  
Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows XP/XP x64/Server  
2003/Server 2003 x64  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If the printer information is not updated automatically after clicking Get Information from Printer, follow these steps:  
1. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select any of the available trays from the Paper Tray  
Configuration.  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then remove the check mark from Enable Bi-Directional  
Communication check box.  
Select any of the available trays from the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the displayed active dialog box.  
When Using PS Driver  
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Printer  
properties from the displayed list.  
Windows 7/Windows 7  
x64/Server 2008 R2 x64  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
Windows Vista/Vista x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server  
2008 x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows XP/XP x64/Server  
2003/Server 2003 x64  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
®
1. Select the Print & Fax in System Preferences.  
2. Select the printer in Printers list, and click Options & Supplies.  
3. Select Driver, select the options that have been installed on the printers, and  
then click OK.  
Mac OS X 10.5.x  
Mac OS X 10.3.x/10.4.x  
1. Select the printer from the Printer List screen in Print Center (or Printer  
Setup Utility).  
2. Click Printers on the Print Center (or Printer Setup Utility) menu bar, and  
select Show Info.  
3. Select Installable Options, and select the options that have been installed on  
the printer, and then click Apply Changes.  
Mac OS 9  
1. Select a desktop printer related to the model.  
2. Click Printing on the System menu bar, and select Change Setup.  
3. Select Paper Tray Configuration on the Change menu.  
4. Select the option that has been installed on the printer on the To menu, and  
then click OK.  
Installing both 550-Sheet Feeders and 1100-Sheet Feeder  
1. Turn off the printer and unplug the power cable. Then, disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.  
2. Lock down the brakes of the two casters at the front of optional 1100-sheet feeder.  
CAUTION: Failure to lock down the brakes can cause the printer to move unexpectedly, resulting in  
personal injury.  
NOTE: For easier and safer locking, make the brakes of the two casters face forward by pushing the 1100-sheet  
feeder backward.  
3. Pull out the tray until it stops. Lift the front slightly and remove it.  
4. Lift the 550-sheet feeder and align the three guide pins of the 1100-sheet feeder with the holes at the bottom of  
the 550-sheet feeder.  
When lifting the 550-sheet feeder, grasp it as shown in the illustration.  
   
CAUTION: When carrying the 550-sheet feeder, do not grasp the areas shown in the following  
illustration:  
5. Gently lower the 550-sheet feeder onto the 1100-sheet feeder.  
6. Tighten the two screws provided with the feeder using a coin or similar object.  
7. Lift the printer and align the three guide pins of the 550-sheet feeder with the holes at the bottom of the printer.  
Gently lower the printer onto the 550-sheet feeder.  
CAUTION: You need three people to lift the printer.  
CAUTION: Be careful not to catch your fingers between the printer and the 1100-sheet feeder.  
8. Pull out the tray from the printer until it stops. Lift the front slightly and remove it.  
9. Tighten the two screws provided with the feeder using a coin or similar object.  
10. Secure the printer and the 550-sheet feeder with a plastic clamp-locks and the longer screws provided with the  
feeder.  
NOTE: When you have two 550-sheet feeders, repeat Step 4 to Step 10.  
11. Insert the tray into the printer.  
12. Remove the trays from the 550-sheet feeder and the 1100-sheet feeder.  
13. Adjust the width guides to the size of paper to be loaded.  
14. Adjust the length guide to the size of paper to be loaded.  
15. Load paper into the trays with the recommended print side facing up.  
16. Return the trays loaded with paper to the feeders.  
17. Connect the power cable to the printer and then to the power source.  
18. Fix the power cable on the printer with the plastic fastener.  
19. Turn on the printer.  
 
NOTE: If a message displays telling you to make initial setup on the operator panel, always do as instructed.  
NOTE: The printer will automatically detect the attached tray(s) but will not detect the paper type.  
20. Print a printer settings page to verify the 550-sheet feeder and 1100-sheet feeder are installed correctly by  
following the instructions below. See "Printing Printer Settings Page."  
Printing Printer Settings Page  
When Using the Operator Panel  
a. Press Menu button.  
b. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button. Printer Setting is displayed.  
c. Press  
(Set) button.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
d. Verify 550-Sheet Feeder and 1100-Sheet Feeder are listed in the printer settings under Printer  
Options.  
If the feeder is not listed, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the 550-sheet feeder and  
the 1100-sheet feeder.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
a. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
1) Open the web browser.  
2) Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
b. Select Printer Settings.  
c. Click the Printer Settings Report tab.  
d. Select Reports.  
e. Click Start on the Printer Settings.  
The printer settings report is printed.  
f. Verify if 550-Sheet Feeder and 1100-Sheet Feeder are listed in the printer settings.  
If the feeders are not listed, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the 550-sheet feeder  
and the 1100-sheet feeder.  
21. After loading paper in the installed tray, specify the paper type from the printer operator panel.  
a. Press Menu button.  
b. Press  
c. Press  
button until Tray Settings is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until the installed tray is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
d. Ensure Paper Type is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
 
e. Press  
button until the paper type for the installed tray is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
f. Confirm that the selected paper type is marked with a bullet, and then press Menu button.  
NOTE: If you installed the 550-sheet feeder and the 1100-sheet feeder after installing the printer driver, update  
your driver by following the instructions for each operating system. If the printer is on a network, update the driver  
for each client.  
To complete installation of the accessory, the printer driver must be updated to detect it.  
Updating Your Driver to Detect 550-Sheet Feeders and 1100-Sheet  
Feeder  
When Using PCL/XPS Driver  
NOTE: XPS driver is supported on the following operating systems: Windows 7, Windows 7 x64, Windows Vista,  
Windows Vista x64, Windows Server 2008 R2 x64, Windows Server 2008, and Windows Server 2008 x64.  
®
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
Windows 7/Windows 7  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Printer properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
®
x64/Windows Server 2008  
R2 x64  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable Bi-  
Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
®
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
Windows Vista /Vista x64  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable Bi-  
Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server  
2008 x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable Bi-  
Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows XP/XP x64/Server  
2003/Server 2003 x64  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If the printer information is not updated automatically after clicking Get Information from Printer, follow these steps:  
1. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select any of the available trays from the Paper Tray  
Configuration.  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then remove the check mark from Enable Bi-Directional  
Communication check box.  
Select any of the available trays from the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the displayed active dialog box.  
When Using PS Driver  
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Printer  
properties from the displayed list.  
Windows 7/Windows 7  
x64/Server 2008 R2 x64  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
Windows Vista/Vista x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server  
2008 x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows XP/XP x64/Server  
2003/Server 2003 x64  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the paper tray configuration  
under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select any of the available trays from  
the Paper Tray Configuration.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
®
1. Select the Print & Fax in System Preferences.  
2. Select the printer in Printers list, and click Options & Supplies.  
3. Select Driver, select the options that have been installed on the printers, and  
then click OK.  
Mac OS X 10.5.x  
Mac OS X 10.3.x/10.4.x  
1. Select the printer from the Printer List screen in Print Center (or Printer  
Setup Utility).  
2. Click Printers on the Print Center (or Printer Setup Utility) menu bar, and  
select Show Info.  
3. Select Installable Options, and select the options that have been installed on  
the printer, and then click Apply Changes.  
Mac OS 9  
1. Select a desktop printer related to the model.  
2. Click Printing on the System menu bar, and select Change Setup.  
3. Select Paper Tray Configuration on the Change menu.  
4. Select the option that has been installed on the printer on the To menu, and  
then click OK.  
Installing an Output Expander  
CAUTION: If you install an output expander after setting up the printer, be sure to turn off the printer,  
unplug the power cable, and disconnect all cables from the back of the printer before completing these  
tasks.  
CAUTION: Always grasp and hold the output expander as instructed when moving the expander. Not  
doing so could cause you to drop the output expander, resulting in personal injury.  
CAUTION: After installing the output expander, visually check to ensure that the expander has been  
connected correctly. Improper installation could cause the output expander to detach and fall, causing  
personal injury.  
CAUTION: When moving the printer, disconnect the output expander from the printer. Not doing so  
could cause the output expander to detach and drop, resulting in personal injury.  
1. Turn off the printer and unplug the power cable. Then, disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.  
2. Remove all packing material from the output expander, except the cardboard cover. Do not remove the protective  
cardboard cover until installation is complete.  
 
3. Place the output expander on the left side of the printer.  
CAUTION: Always hold the positions shown below when lifting the output expander.  
4. Open the tray 1 slightly.  
5. Open the front cover.  
6. Grasp the tab of the upper panel to slightly pull it outwards, and then pull the panel forward to remove it from the  
printer. Repeat the procedure for the lower panel.  
7. Close the front cover of the printer.  
8. Insert the tray into the printer, and push until it stops.  
9. Press the claw to unlatch the center output tray and lift the tray to remove it from the printer.  
10. Place the H transport unit on the printer.  
11. Attach the bracket as shown in the illustration below.  
12. First, tighten the screw on the right side loosely for later adjustment.  
Then, tighten the other screw on the left side, and then tighten the right screw firmly.  
13. Attach the plastic fastener to the printer to secure the cables.  
14. Lift the output expander, align the hole on the expander with the bracket guide, and then hook the expander onto  
the bracket guide.  
To properly fit the expander to the printer, put pressure on the expander with your hands in the direction shown in  
the illustration.  
CAUTION: Always hold the marked positions when lifting the output expander.  
CAUTION: Check the space between the printer and output expander to confirm that the expander is  
connected properly.  
If the output expander does not fit in the printer, detach and install it again.  
15. Remove the protective cardboard cover from the output expander, and then attach the stacker tray to the output  
expander.  
First, align the attachment side of tray to the printer. Then slide the tray down until its two projections catch the  
holes on the metal panel as shown in the illustration.  
16. Attach the parts as shown in the illustration below.  
17. Remove the connector cover from the printer.  
18. Insert the connector in the socket, and then attach the plastic fastener to the printer to secure the cables.  
19. Attach the connector cover 2.  
NOTICE: Always keep the power cable away from cover closures.  
20. Insert the connector in the socket, and then attach the plastic fastener to the printer to secure the cables.  
21. Attach the connector cover 1.  
First, attach the left side of the connector cover 1 to the printer. Then close cover 1 as shown in the illustration.  
22. Connect the power cable of the output expander to the printer as shown in the illustration.  
23. Open the front door of the output expander.  
24. Remove the packing material from the stapler cartridge.  
NOTE: Ensure that the metal part is lowered as shown in the illustration below.  
25. Insert the stapler cartridge in the output expander.  
26. Close the front door of the output expander.  
27. Turn on the printer.  
NOTE: If a message displays telling you to make initial setup on the operator panel, always do as instructed.  
28. Print a printer settings page to verify the output expander is installed correctly by following the instructions below.  
Printing Printer Settings Page  
When Using the Operator Panel  
a. Press Menu button.  
b. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
c. Printer Setting is displayed. Press  
(Set) button.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
d. Verify Output Expander is listed in the printer settings under Printer Options.  
If the output expander is not listed, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the output  
expander.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
a. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
1) Open the web browser.  
2) Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
b. Select Printer Settings.  
c. Click the Printer Settings Report tab.  
d. Select Reports.  
e. Click the Start button on the Printer Settings.  
The printer settings report is printed.  
f. Verify Output Expander is listed in the printer settings.  
If the output expander is not listed, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the output  
expander.  
NOTE: If you installed the output expander after installing the PCL or PS printer driver, update your driver by  
following the instructions for each operating system. If the printer is on a network, update the driver for each client.  
To complete installation of the accessory, the printer driver must be updated to detect it.  
NOTE: Output expander can be specified on the printer driver only when optional hard disk or RAM disk is available  
on the printer driver.  
NOTE: When you use XPS driver, the following settings are not required.  
Updating Your Driver to Detect Output Expander  
When Using PCL Driver:  
®
®
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Printer properties.  
3. Click the Options tab, and then select Get Information  
Windows 7/Windows 7 x64/Windows Server  
2008 R2 x64  
 
from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
®
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound®  
Printers.  
Windows Vista /Vista x64  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Properties.  
3. Click the Options tab, and then select Get Information  
from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server 2008 x64  
Windows XP/XP x64/Server 2003/Server 2003 x64  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Properties.  
3. Click the Options tab, and then select Get Information  
from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. Click the Options tab, and then select Get Information  
from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. Click the Options tab, and then select Get Information  
from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If the printer information is not updated automatically after clicking Get Information from Printer, follow these steps:  
1. Click the Options tab, and then select Output Expander on the Items list box.  
2. Select Available for the output expander setting.  
3. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
4. Close the displayed active dialog box.  
When Using PS Driver  
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Printer  
properties from the displayed list.  
Windows 7/Windows 7  
x64/Server 2008 R2 x64  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm Output Expander is  
available under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select Available for the Output  
Expander under Installable Options.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
Windows Vista/Vista x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm Output Expander is  
available under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select Available for the Output  
Expander under Installable Options.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server  
2008 x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm Output Expander is  
available under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select Available for the Output  
Expander under Installable Options.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows XP/XP x64/Server  
2003/Server 2003 x64  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm Output Expander is  
available under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select Available for the Output  
Expander under Installable Options.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm Output Expander is  
available under Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select Available for the Output  
Expander under Installable Options.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
®
1. Select the Print & Fax in System Preferences.  
2. Select the printer in Printers list, and click Options & Supplies.  
3. Select Driver, select the options that have been installed on the printers, and  
then click OK.  
Mac OS X 10.5.x  
Mac OS X 10.3.x/10.4.x  
1. Select the printer from the Printer List screen in Print Center (or Printer  
Setup Utility).  
2. Click Printers on the Print Center (or Printer Setup Utility) menu bar, and  
select Show Info.  
3. Select Installable Options, and select the options that have been installed on  
the printer, and then click Apply Changes.  
Mac OS 9  
1. Select a desktop printer related to the model.  
2. Click Printing on the System menu bar, and select Change Setup.  
3. Select Output Expander on the Change menu.  
4. Select the option that has been installed on the printer on the To menu, and  
then click OK.  
Installing a Memory Module  
Your printer comes with 256 MB of memory installed. To increase memory, you can add an optional 1024 MB memory  
module on the control board.  
1. Ensure that the printer is turned off.  
2. Rotate the screw counterclockwise on the metal casing to open the cover.  
3. Remove the control board cover.  
4. Pay attention to the direction of the memory module to align the notches of the memory module with those of the  
slot. With the connector of the memory module toward the slot, insert the memory module vertically into the slot.  
Then press down evenly on both sides of the memory module until it stops.  
 
5. Check that the tabs are locked.  
6. Install the control board cover.  
7. Close the control board cover and rotate the screw clockwise.  
8. Turn on the printer.  
9. Print the printer settings page to verify that the memory is installed correctly by following the instructions below.  
Printing Printer Settings Page  
When Using the Operator Panel  
a. Press Menu button.  
b. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
c. Printer Setting is displayed. Press (Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
 
The printer settings page is printed.  
d. Verify Memory Capacity listed in the printer settings under General.  
If the memory capacity has not increased, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the  
memory module.  
When Using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool  
a. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
1) Open the web browser.  
2) Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
b. Select Printer Settings.  
c. Click the Printer Settings Report tab.  
d. Select Reports.  
e. Press the Start button in the Printer Settings.  
f. The printer settings report is printed.  
g. Verify Memory Capacity listed in the printer settings.  
If the memory capacity has not increased, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the  
memory module.  
NOTE: If you installed the memory module after installing the PCL or PS printer driver, update your driver by  
following the instructions for each operating system. If the printer is on a network, update the driver for each client.  
To complete installation of the accessory, the printer driver must be updated to detect it.  
NOTE: Memory module can be specified on the printer driver only when HDD or RAM disk is available on the printer  
driver.  
NOTE: When you use XPS driver, the following settings are not required.  
Updating Your Driver to Detect Memory Module  
When Using PCL/XPS Driver  
NOTE: XPS driver is supported on the following operating systems: Windows 7, Windows 7 x64, Windows Vista,  
Windows Vista x64, Windows Server 2008 R2 x64, Windows Server 2008, and Windows Server 2008 x64.  
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
Windows 7/Windows 7 x64/Server  
2008 R2 x64  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Printer properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable  
Bi-Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the  
check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
Windows Vista/Vista x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable  
Bi-Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the  
check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server  
2008 x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then ensure that Enable  
Bi-Directional Communication check box is checked. If not, check the  
check box.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows XP/XP x64/Windows  
Server 2003/Windows Server  
2003 x64  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select Get  
Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If the printer information is not updated automatically after clicking Get Information from Printer, follow these steps:  
1. When you use PCL driver, click the Options tab, and then select the total amount of the installed printer memory  
for the memory capacity setting in the Items list box.  
When you use XPS driver, click the Option tab, and then remove the check mark from Enable Bi-Directional  
Communication check box.  
Select the total amount of the installed printer memory for the memory capacity setting in the Items list box.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the displayed active dialog box.  
When Using PS Driver  
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Printer  
properties from the displayed list.  
Windows 7/Windows 7  
x64/Server 2008 R2 x64  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the memory capacity on the  
Installable Options.  
6. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select memory size from Memory  
Capacity under Installable Options.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
Windows Vista/Vista x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the memory capacity on the  
Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select memory size from Memory  
Capacity under Installable Options.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server  
2008 x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the memory capacity on the  
Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select memory size from Memory  
Capacity under Installable Options.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows XP/XP x64/Server  
2003/Server 2003 x64  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the memory capacity on the  
Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select memory size from Memory  
Capacity under Installable Options.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the memory capacity on the  
Installable Options.  
6. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select memory size from Memory  
Capacity under Installable Options.  
2. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
®
1. Select the Print & Fax in System Preferences.  
2. Select the printer in Printers list, and click Options & Supplies.  
3. Select Driver, select the options that have been installed on the printers, and  
then click OK.  
Mac OS X 10.5.x  
Mac OS X 10.3.x/10.4.x  
1. Select the printer from the Printer List screen in Print Center (or Printer  
Setup Utility).  
2. Click Printers on the Print Center (or Printer Setup Utility) menu bar, and  
select Show Info.  
3. Select Installable Options, and select the options that have been installed on  
the printer, and then click Apply Changes.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
Mac OS 9  
1. Select a desktop printer related to the model.  
2. Click Printing on the System menu bar, and select Change Setup.  
3. Select Memory Capacity on the Change menu.  
4. Select the option that has been installed on the printer on the To menu, and  
then click OK.  
Installing a Hard Disk  
1. Ensure that the printer is turned off.  
2. Rotate the screw counterclockwise on the metal casing to open the cover.  
3. Remove the control board cover.  
4. Insert the two plastic pins on the hard disk into the metal casing holes.  
 
5. Attach the left side spacer to the control board.  
6. Connect the hard disk cables to the connectors of the control board.  
7. Replace the control board cover.  
8. Close the control board cover and then rotate the screw clockwise.  
9. Turn on the printer.  
NOTE: If a message displays telling you to make initial setup on the operator panel, always do as instructed.  
10. Print the printer settings page to verify if the optional hard disk is installed correctly by following the instructions.  
Printing Printer Settings Page  
11. When Using the Operator Panel  
a. Press Menu button.  
b. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button. Printer Setting is displayed.  
c. Press  
(Set) button.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
d. Verify if Hard Disk is listed in the printer settings under Printer Options.  
If it is not listed, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the hard disk.  
When Using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool  
a. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
1) Open the web browser.  
2) Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
b. Select Printer Settings.  
 
c. Click the Printer Settings Report tab.  
d. Select Reports.  
e. Press the Start button in the Printer Settings.  
The printer settings report is printed.  
f. Verify if Hard Disk is listed in the printer settings under Printer Options.  
If it is not listed, turn off the printer, unplug the power cable, and reinstall the hard disk.  
NOTE: If you installed the hard disk after installing the PCL or PS printer driver, update your driver by following the  
instructions for each operating system. If the printer is on a network, update the driver for each client.  
To complete installation of the accessory, the printer driver must be updated to detect it.  
NOTE: Hard disk can be specified on the printer driver only when HDD or RAM disk is available on the printer  
driver.  
NOTE: When you use XPS driver, the following settings are not required.  
Updating Your Driver to Detect Hard Disk  
When Using PCL/XPS Driver  
NOTE: When you use XPS driver, the following settings are not required.  
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Printer properties.  
3. Click the Options tab, and then select Get Information from  
Printer.  
Windows 7/Windows 7 x64/Server 2008 R2  
x64  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
Windows Vista/Vista x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Properties.  
3. Click the Options tab, and then select Get Information from  
Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server 2008 x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Properties.  
3. Click the Options tab, and then select Get Information from  
Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows XP/XP x64/Server 2003/Server 2003  
x64  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. Click the Options tab, and then select Get Information from  
Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer and select Properties.  
3. Click the Options tab, and then select Get Information from  
Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Close the Printers dialog box.  
If the printer information is not updated automatically after clicking Get Information from Printer, follow these steps:  
1. Click the Options tab, and then select Hard Disk on the Items list box.  
2. Select Available for the hard disk setting.  
3. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
4. Close the displayed active dialog box.  
When Using PS Driver  
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Printer  
properties from the displayed list.  
Windows 7/Windows 7  
x64/Server 2008 R2 x64  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the storage device on the  
Installable Options.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select storage device from Storage  
Device under Installable Options.  
2. Click OK.  
3. Close the Devices and Printers dialog box.  
Windows Vista/Vista x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the storage device on the  
Installable Options.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select storage device from Storage  
Device under Installable Options.  
2. Click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows Server 2008/Server  
2008 x64  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the storage device on the  
Installable Options.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select storage device from Storage  
Device under Installable Options.  
2. Click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
Windows XP/XP x64/Server  
2003/Server 2003 x64  
1. Click Start® Printers and Faxes.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the storage device on the  
Installable Options.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select storage device from Storage  
Device under Installable Options.  
2. Click OK.  
3. Close the Printers and Faxes dialog box.  
Windows 2000  
1. Click Start® Settings® Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer that uses the PS driver, and then select Properties  
from the displayed list.  
3. Click the Configuration tab, and then select Get Information from Printer.  
4. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
5. Click the Device Settings tab, and then confirm the storage device on the  
Installable Options.  
If you cannot acquire the printer information using the Get Information from  
Printer automatically, try the following procedure:  
1. Click the Device Settings tab, and then select storage device from Storage  
Device under Installable Options.  
2. Click OK.  
3. Close the Printers dialog box.  
®
1. Select the Print & Fax in System Preferences.  
2. Select the printer in Printers list, and click Options & Supplies.  
3. Select Driver, select the options that have been installed on the printers, and  
then click OK.  
Mac OS X 10.5.x  
Mac OS X 10.3.x/10.4.x  
1. Select the printer from the Printer List screen in Print Center (or Printer  
Setup Utility).  
2. Click Printers on the Print Center (or Printer Setup Utility) menu bar, and  
select Show Info.  
3. Select Installable Options, and select the options that have been installed on  
the printer, and then click Apply Changes.  
Mac OS 9  
1. Select a desktop printer related to the model.  
2. Click Printing on the System menu bar, and select Change Setup.  
3. Select Storage Device on the Change menu.  
4. Select the option that has been installed on the printer on the To menu, and  
then click OK.  
Installing a Wireless Adapter  
The wireless adapter allows you to use the printer with wireless network connection.  
The specifications of wireless adapter are described below:  
Item  
Specification  
Connectivity  
Wireless  
Connectivity Standard  
Bandwidth  
IEEE802.11b/g/n compliant  
2.4 GHz  
Data Transfer Rate  
IEEE802.11b mode:11, 5.5, 2, 1 Mbps  
IEEE802.11g mode:54, 48, 36, 24, 18, 12, 9, 6 Mbps  
IEEE802.11n mode:65 Mbps  
Security  
64(40-bit key)/128(104-bit key) WEP,  
WPA-PSK(TKIP, AES), WPA2-PSK(AES),  
1
2
WPA-Enterprise(TKIP, AES)* , * ,  
1
2
WPA2-Enterprise(AES)* , *  
 
1
* : PEAPV0 MS-CHAPV2 only.  
2
* : This item is available only when the optional hard disk is installed.  
NOTE: When the Wireless Adapter is installed, you cannot use IEEE 802.1x authentication and /or the Ethernet port  
for a wired connection.  
Verifying the Contents of Box  
NOTE: To complete wireless setup you will require the Drivers and Utilities CD that comes with your printer. The  
configuration utility and drivers can also be downloaded from support.dell.com.  
Before Installing a Wireless Adapter  
To install the Dell Wireless Adapter, perform one of the following methods.  
1. Video instructions (Recommended)  
a. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD in your computer. The Easy Setup Navigator file launches automatically.  
b. Click the Wireless Configuration button on the Easy Setup Navigator window and follow the on-screen  
instructions until the Configure Your Wireless Printer screen appears.  
NOTE: For more information on configuring the Wireless Adapter see "Configuring a Wireless Adapter."  
2. Paper instructions  
Refer to Installing and Configuring the Wireless Adapter Guide provided with the wireless adapter.  
Installing a Wireless Adapter  
1. Ensure that the printer is turned off. Then unplug all cables including the power cable from the rear of the printer.  
 
2. Remove the cap from the wireless adapter socket.  
3. Align the connector and the three protrusions of the wireless adapter with the four holes and insert the adapter.  
NOTE: Ensure that the adapter is fully inserted and secured.  
4. Reconnect the power cable and turn on the printer.  
NOTE: If a message displays telling you to make initial setup on the operator panel, always do as instructed.  
5. Print the printer settings page to verify that the wireless adapter is installed correctly by following the instructions  
Printing Printer Settings Page  
When Using the Operator panel  
a. Press the Menu button.  
b. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press the  
c. Printer Settings is displayed. Press the (Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
 
The Printer Settings page is printed.  
6. Verify that the Network (Wireless) section exists.  
NOTE: For more information on configuring the Wireless Adapter see "Configuring a Wireless Adapter."  
Determining the Wireless Network Settings  
You need to know the wireless network settings to use your printer as a wireless device. For details of the settings,  
contact your network administrator.  
Wireless  
Settings  
SSID  
Specifies the name that identifies the wireless network. Up to 32  
alphanumeric characters.  
Network Specifies the network type from Ad-hoc or Infrastructure.  
Type  
Security  
Settings  
Security Selects the security method from No security, WEP, WPA-PSK TKIP and  
WPA2-PSK-AES/WPA-PSK-AES.  
Transmit Specifies the transmit key from the list.  
Key  
WEP Key Specified the WEP key set used through the wireless network only when  
WEP is selected for Security.  
Pass  
Phrase  
Specifies the pass phrase of alphanumeric characters from 8 to 63 bytes  
long only when WPA-PSK is selected for Encryption.  
Configuring a Wireless Adapter  
This section describes how to configure a wireless adapter through Easy Setup Navigator.  
You can select a method to configure a wireless adapter from the following:  
Wizard Setup through USB connection  
Ethernet connection  
1
Advanced Setup through  
2
USB connection  
1
®
* WPS-PIN (Wi-Fi Protected setup-Personal Identification Number) is a method to authenticate and register devices  
required for wireless configuration, by entering PIN assignments in the printer and computer. This setting, performed  
through access point, is available only when the access points of your wireless router supports WPS.  
 
2
* WPS-PBC (Wi-Fi Protected Setup-Push Button Configuration) is a method to authenticate and register devices required  
for wireless configuration, by pressing the button provided on the access point via wireless routers, and then performing  
WPS-PBC setting on the operator panel. This setting is available only when the access point supports WPS.  
NOTE: The optional wireless adapter must be installed on the printer.  
NOTE: For information on how to install a wireless adapter, see "Installing a Wireless Adapter."  
Using Wizard Setup to Configure a Wireless Adapter  
1. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with the printer in your computer. The Easy Setup Navigator file  
launches automatically.  
2. Click the Wireless Configuration button on the Easy Setup Navigator window.  
The Wireless Configuration window opens.  
3. Select Wizard and click Next.  
The instruction video starts.  
4. Follow on-screen instructions until the Wireless Setting Tool button appears.  
5. Click Wireless Setting Tool.  
The Wireless Setting Tool starts.  
6. Comments appear about connectivity. Click Next.  
NOTE: When the printer has already been connected, this screen does not appear. In addition, this screen will not  
change to the next screen until the printer is connected.  
7. In the list on the Select Printer screen, select the wireless printer you want to set up, and then click Next.  
NOTE: When only one printer is connected through the USB, the Select Printer screen does not appear.  
8. On the Enter Wireless Network Settings screen, enter your wireless settings, and then click Next.  
9. On the Select IP Mode screen, select the IP mode you want to set up, and then click Next.  
When IPv4 Only is selected:  
On the Enter IPv4 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Send to send the wireless  
settings to the printer.  
When IPv6 Only is selected:  
On the Enter IPv6 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Send to send the wireless  
settings to the printer.  
When Dual Stack (both IPv4 and IPv6) is selected:  
a. On the Enter IPv4 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Next.  
b. On the Enter IPv6 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Send to send the wireless  
settings to the printer.  
10. On the Complete Wireless Settings screen, click Next to complete the wireless setup and close the Wireless  
Setting Tool.  
Easy Setup Navigator restarts.  
11. Follow on-screen instructions to finish configuring the wireless adapter.  
Using Advanced Setup to Configure a Wireless Adapter  
Select Advanced Setup to configure your wireless adapter with one of the following:  
Ethernet  
Operator Panel  
Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool  
WPS-PIN  
WPS-PBC  
USB  
Ethernet  
1. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with the printer in your computer. The Easy Setup Navigator file  
launches automatically.  
2. Click the Wireless Configuration button on the Easy Setup Navigator window.  
The Wireless Configuration window opens.  
3. Select Advanced, and then click Next.  
4. Select Ethernet, and then click Next.  
The instruction video starts.  
5. Follow on-screen instructions until the Wireless Setting Tool button appears.  
6. Click Wireless Setting Tool to start wireless setup.  
The Wireless Setting Tool starts.  
7. If your printer is not listed on the Select Printer screen, click Refresh or Enter IP Address.  
On the Enter IP Address screen, enter the existing IP address for the printer.  
8. In the list on the Select Printer screen, select the wireless printer you want to setup, and then click Next.  
9. On the Enter Wireless Network Settings screen, select each wireless setting, and then click Next.  
10. On the Select IP Mode screen, select the IP mode you want, and then click Next.  
When IPv4 Only is selected:  
 
On the Enter IPv4 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Send to send the wireless  
settings to the printer.  
When IPv6 Only is selected:  
On the Enter IPv6 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Send to send the wireless  
settings to the printer.  
When Dual Stack (both IPv4 and IPv6) is selected:  
a. On the Enter IPv4 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Next.  
b. On the Enter IPv6 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Send to send the wireless  
settings to the printer.  
11. On the Complete Wireless Settings screen, click Next to complete the wireless setup and close the wireless  
setting tool.  
Easy Setup Navigator restarts.  
12. Follow on-screen instructions to finish configuring the wireless adapter.  
Operator Panel or Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with the printer in your computer. The Easy Setup Navigator file  
launches automatically.  
2. Click the Wireless Configuration button on the Easy Setup Navigator window.  
The Wireless Configuration window opens.  
3. Select Advanced, and then click Next.  
4. Select Operator Panel or Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, and then click Next.  
The instruction video starts.  
5. Follow on-screen instructions to finish configuring the wireless adapter.  
WPS-PIN  
NOTE: WPS-PIN (Wi-Fi Protected setup-Personal Identification Number) is a method to authenticate and register  
devices required for wireless configuration, by entering PIN assignments to a printer and computer. This setting,  
performed through access point, is available only when the access points of your wireless router supports WPS.  
1. Press the Menu button.  
2. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until Wireless Setup is highlighted, and then press  
button until WPS is highlighted, and then press (Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
3. Ensure Network is highlighted, and then press  
4. Press  
5. Press  
(Set) button.  
   
6. Press  
button until PIN Codeis highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
7. Write down the 8-digit PIN code displayed on the first line of the panel display or press  
button until Print PIN  
Codeis highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
The PIN code is printed.  
8. Ensure Start Configuration is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
9. Ensure the message Please wait Wireless Setting is displayed, and then enter the PIN code displayed on the  
Step 7 into the wireless LAN access point (Registrar).  
NOTE: For WPS operation on the wireless LAN access point, refer to the manual supplied with the wireless LAN  
access point.  
10. When the WPS operation is successful and the printer is rebooted, wireless LAN connection is completed.  
WPS-PBC  
NOTE: WPS-PBC (Wi-Fi Protected Setup-Push Button Configuration) is a method to authenticate and register  
devices required for wireless configuration, by pressing the button provided on the access point via wireless routers,  
and then performing WPS-PBC setting on the operator panel. This setting is available only when the access point  
supports WPS.  
1. Press the Menu button.  
2. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until Wireless Setup is highlighted, and then press  
button until WPS is highlighted, and then press (Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
3. Ensure Network is highlighted, and then press  
4. Press  
5. Press  
(Set) button.  
6. Ensure Push Button Control is highlighted, and then press  
7. Press  
8. Press  
button until PBC Start is highlighted, and then press  
button until Start is highlighted, and then press  
9. Ensure the message Please wait Wireless Setting is displayed, and then start the WPS-PBC on the wireless  
LAN access point (Registrar), within two minutes of the Step 8 operation.  
NOTE: For WPS operation on the wireless LAN access point, refer to the manual supplied with the wireless LAN  
access point.  
10. When the WPS operation is successful and the printer is rebooted, wireless LAN connection is completed.  
USB  
1. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with the printer in your computer. The Easy Setup Navigator file  
launches automatically.  
2. Click the Wireless Configuration button on the Easy Setup Navigator window.  
The Wireless Configuration window opens.  
       
3. Select Advanced, and then click Next.  
4. Select USB, and then click Next.  
The instruction video starts.  
5. Follow on-screen instructions until the Wireless Setting Tool button appears.  
6. Click Wireless Setting Tool to start wireless setup.  
The Wireless Setting Tool starts.  
7. Comments appear about connectivity. Click Next.  
NOTE: When the printer has already been connected, this screen does not appear. In addition, this screen will not  
change to the next screen until the printer is connected.  
8. In the list on the Select Printer screen, select the wireless printer you want to setup, and then click Next.  
NOTE: When only one printer is connected through the USB, the Select Printer screen does not appear.  
9. On the Enter Wireless Network Settings screen, select each wireless setting, and then click Next.  
10. On the Select IP Mode screen, select the IP mode you want, and then click Next.  
When IPv4 Only is selected:  
On the Enter IPv4 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Send to send the wireless  
settings to the printer.  
When IPv6 Only is selected:  
On the Enter IPv6 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Send to send the wireless  
settings to the printer.  
When Dual Stack (both IPv4 and IPv6) is selected:  
a. On the Enter IPv4 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Next.  
b. On the Enter IPv6 Address Settings screen, select each setting, and then click Send to send the wireless  
settings to the printer.  
11. On the Complete Wireless Settings screen, click Next to complete the wireless setup and close the wireless  
setting tool.  
Easy Setup Navigator restarts.  
12. Follow on-screen instructions to finish configuring the wireless adapter.  
Constructing a New Wireless Network Environment for Your  
Computer (When you need to setup your wireless connectivity with  
your computer)  
For DHCP network:  
1. Setting up your computer for wireless connectivity:  
NOTE: If your computer provides a wireless adapter tool, change the wireless settings using this tool. Or you can  
change the wireless settings using the tool provided with the operating system. See the instructions below.  
For Windows XP and Windows Server 2003:  
a. Select Network Connections from Control Panel.  
b. Right-click Wireless Network Connection and select Properties.  
c. Select the Wireless Networks tab.  
d. Ensure the check box for Use Windows to configure my wireless network settings is checked.  
NOTE: Be sure to write down the current wireless computer settings in Step e and Step g so that you can  
restore them later.  
e. Click the Advanced button.  
f. Select Computer to Computer (ad hoc) networks only and close the Advanced dialog box.  
g. Click the Add button to display Wireless network properties.  
h. Under the Association tab, enter the following information and click OK.  
Network name (SSID): dell_device  
Network Authentication: Open  
Data encryption: Disabled  
Ad hoc network: checked  
i. Click the Move up button to move the newly added SSID to the top of the list.  
j. Click OK to close the Property dialog box.  
NOTE: When your operating system is earlier than Windows 2000, select your settings according to the  
instructions in the manual of the wireless setting tool provided by your wireless device manufacturer.  
For Windows Vista:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Internet.  
c. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
d. Select Connect to a network.  
e. Select dell_device from the network items listed in Connect to a network.  
f. Select Connect Anyway in the warning dialog box indicating you are entering an unsecured area.  
g. Click Close in the dialog box after confirming the connection is a success.  
   
For Windows Server 2008:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
c. Select Connect to a network.  
d. Select dell_device from the network items listed in Connect to a network.  
e. Select Connect Anyway in the warning dialog box indicating you are entering an unsecured area.  
f. Click Close in the dialog box after confirming the connection is a success.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Internet.  
c. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
d. Select Connect to a network.  
e. Select dell_device from the network items listed in the available network list, and click Connect.  
2. Check the IP address assigned by AutoIP on the printer.  
a. Press Menu on the printer control panel.  
b. Scroll down and select Admin Menu.  
c. Scroll down and select Network.  
d. Scroll down and select TCP/IP.  
e. Scroll down and select IPv4.  
f. Scroll down and select IP Address.  
(Default IP address range: 169.254.xxx.yyy)  
IP Address  
169.254.000.041*  
3. Check that the IP address on your computer is assigned by DHCP.  
4. Open Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool using the WEB browser.  
5. Create wireless setting of the printer on Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
6. Reboot the printer.  
7. Restore the wireless settings on your computer.  
NOTE: If your computer provides a wireless adapter tool, change the wireless settings using this tool. Or you can  
change the wireless settings using the tool provided with the operating system. See the instructions below.  
For Windows XP and Windows Server 2003:  
a. Select Network Connections from Control Panel.  
b. Right-click Wireless Network Connection and select Properties.  
c. Select Wireless Network tab.  
d. Ensure the check box for Use Windows to configure my wireless network settings is checked.  
e. Click Advanced.  
f. Do either of the following:  
When wireless ad-hoc mode is set to the printer:  
Select Computer to Computer (ad hoc) networks only and close the Advanced dialog box.  
When wireless infrastructure mode is set to the printer:  
Select Access point (Infrastructure) networks only and close the Advanced dialog box.  
g. Click Add to display Wireless network properties.  
h. Enter the setting that you will send to the printer and click OK.  
i. Click Move up to move the setting to the top of the list.  
j. Click OK to close the Property dialog box.  
NOTE: When your operating system is earlier than Windows 2000, select your settings according to the  
instructions in the manual of the wireless settings tool provided by your wireless device manufacturer.  
For Windows Vista:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Internet.  
c. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
d. Select Connect to a network.  
e. Select the setting you send to the printer from the network items listed in Connect to a network.  
f. Select Connect Anyway in the warning dialog box indicating you are entering an unsecured area.  
g. Click Close in the dialog box after confirming the connection is a success.  
For Windows Server 2008:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
c. Select Connect to a network.  
d. Select the setting you send to the printer from the network items listed in Connect to a network.  
e. Select Connect Anyway in the warning dialog box indicating you are entering an unsecured area.  
f. Click Close in the dialog box after confirming the connection is a success.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Internet.  
c. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
d. Select Connect to a network.  
e. Select the setting you send to the printer from the network items listed in the available network list, and  
click Connect.  
f. Enter the Security key and click OK, if necessary.  
For Fixed IP networks:  
1. Setting up your computer for wireless connectivity:  
NOTE: If your computer provides a wireless adapter tool, change the wireless settings using this tool. Or you can  
change the wireless settings using the tool provided with the operating system. See the instructions below.  
For Windows XP and Windows Server 2003:  
a. Select Network Connections from Control Panel.  
b. Right-click Wireless Network Connection and select Properties.  
c. Select the Wireless Networks tab.  
d. Ensure the check box for Use Windows to configure my wireless network settings is checked.  
NOTE: Be sure to write down the current wireless computer settings in Step d and Step f so that you can  
restore them later.  
e. Click the Advanced button.  
f. Select Computer to Computer (ad hoc) networks only and close the Advanced dialog box.  
g. Click the Add button to display Wireless network properties.  
h. Under the Association tab, enter the following information and click OK.  
   
Network name (SSID): dell_device  
Network Authentication: Open  
Data encryption: Disabled  
Ad hoc network: checked  
i. Click the Move up button to move the newly added SSID to the top of the list.  
j. Click OK to close the Property dialog box.  
NOTE: When your operating system is earlier than Windows 2000, select your settings according to the  
instructions in the manual of the wireless settings tool provided by your wireless device manufacturer.  
For Windows Vista:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Internet.  
c. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
d. Select Connect to a network.  
e. Select dell_device from the network items listed in Connect to a network.  
f. Select Connect Anyway in the warning dialog box indicating you are entering an unsecured area.  
g. Click Close in the dialog box after confirming the connection is a success.  
For Windows Server 2008:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
c. Select Connect to a network.  
d. Select dell_device from the network items listed in Connect to a network.  
e. Select Connect Anyway in the warning dialog box indicating you are entering an unsecured area.  
f. Click Close in the dialog box after confirming the connection is a success.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Internet.  
c. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
d. Select Connect to a network.  
e. Select dell_device from the network items listed in the available network list, and click Connect.  
2. Check the IP address on your computer.  
3. Set the IP address on the printer.  
a. Press Menu button.  
b. Scroll to Admin menu.  
c. Select Network.  
d. Select TCP/IP.  
e. Select Get IP Address.  
f. Select Panel.  
g. Scroll back to IP Address.  
h. Manually enter the IP address using the directional buttons on the control panel and press enter button.  
IP Address  
172.031.000.041*  
4. Open Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool using the WEB browser.  
5. Change the wireless setting of the printer on Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
6. Reboot the printer.  
7. Restore the wireless settings on your computer.  
NOTE: If your computer provides a wireless adapter tool, change the wireless settings using this tool. Or you can  
change the wireless settings using the tool provided with the operating system. See the instructions below.  
For Windows XP and Windows Server 2003:  
a. Select Network Connections from Control Panel.  
b. Right-click Wireless Network Connection and select Properties.  
c. Select Wireless Network tab.  
d. Ensure the check box for Use Windows to configure my wireless network settings is checked.  
e. Click Advanced.  
f. Do either of the following:  
When wireless ad-hoc mode is set to the printer:  
Select Computer to Computer (ad hoc) networks only and close the Advanced dialog box.  
When wireless infrastructure mode is set to the printer:  
Select Access point (Infrastructure) networks only and close the Advanced dialog box.  
g. Click Add to display Wireless network properties.  
h. Enter the setting that you will send to the printer and click OK.  
i. Click Move up to move the setting to the top of the list.  
j. Click OK to close the Property dialog box.  
NOTE: When your operating system is earlier than Windows 2000, select your settings according to the  
instructions in the manual of the wireless settings tool provided by your wireless device manufacturer.  
For Windows Vista:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Internet.  
c. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
d. Select Connect to a network.  
e. Select the setting you send to the printer from the network items listed in Connect to a network.  
f. Select Connect Anyway in the warning dialog box indicating you are entering an unsecured area.  
g. Click Close in the dialog box after confirming the connection is a success.  
For Windows Server 2008:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
c. Select Connect to a network.  
d. Select the setting you send to the printer from the network items listed in Connect to a network.  
e. Select Connect Anyway in the warning dialog box indicating you are entering an unsecured area.  
f. Click Close in the dialog box after confirming the connection is a success.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7:  
a. Open Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Internet.  
c. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
d. Select Connect to a network.  
e. Select the setting you send to the printer from the network items listed in the available network list, and  
click Connect.  
f. Enter the Security key and click OK, if necessary.  
Connect Printer to Computer or Network  
Your Dell™ 5130cdn Color Laser Printer interconnection cable must meet the following requirements:  
Connection type Connection specifications  
Ethernet  
Wireless  
USB  
10 Base-T/100 Base-TX/1000 Base-T  
IEEE802.11b/802.11g/802.11n  
USB 2.0  
Parallel  
IEEE 1284  
1 Ethernet Port  
2 Wireless Adapter Socket  
3 USB Port  
4 Parallel Port  
Connect Printer to Computer or Network  
Direct Connection  
A local printer is a printer attached to your computer using a USB or parallel cable. If your printer is attached to a  
network instead of your computer, skip this section and go to "Network Connection."  
   
USB Cable  
®
®
®
Microsoft Windows 2000, Windows XP, Windows XP 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2003, Windows Server 2003 x64  
Edition, Windows Server 2008, Windows Server 2008 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008 R2 64-bit Edition, Windows  
®
®
Vista , Windows Vista 64-bit Edition, Windows 7, Windows 7 64-bit Edition and Mac OS X or later operating systems  
®
support USB connections. Some UNIX and Linux computers also support USB connections. See your computer operating  
system documentation to see if your system supports USB.  
To attach the printer to a computer:  
1. Ensure that the printer, computer, and any other attached devices are turned off and unplugged from the power  
source/outlet.  
2. Connect the smaller USB connector into the USB port on the back of the printer.  
3. Ensure that you match the USB symbol on the cable to the USB symbol on the printer.  
4. Connect the other end of the cable into a USB port of the computer.  
NOTICE: Do not connect a USB cable for printers into the USB keyboard.  
Parallel Cable  
A parallel port requires a parallel cable.  
To attach the printer to a computer:  
1. Ensure that the printer, computer, and any other attached devices are turned off and unplugged from the power  
source/outlet.  
2. Connect the parallel connector into the parallel cable port on the back of the printer.  
3. Ensure that you match the parallel symbol on the cable to the parallel symbol on the printer.  
4. Secure the fastening clips of the parallel cable.  
5. Plug the other end of the cable into a parallel port on the back of the computer.  
Network Connection  
To attach the printer to a network:  
1. Ensure that the printer, computer and any other connected devices have been turned off and all cables have been  
disconnected.  
2. Connect the network cable or wireless adaptor.  
1 Ethernet Port  
2 Wireless Adapter Socket  
NOTE: To use the wireless adapter, be sure to disconnect the network cable.  
To connect the printer to the network, plug one end of an Ethernet cable into the Ethernet port on the back of the printer,  
and the other end into a LAN drop or hub. For a wireless connection, insert the wireless adapter into the wireless adapter  
socket on the back of the printer.  
For a wireless connection, refer to "Installing a Wireless Adapter."  
Print and Check the Printer Settings Page  
Print the printer settings page.  
When Using the Operator Panel  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
3. Printer Setting is displayed. Press  
(Set) button.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
4. If the IP address shows anything other than 0.0.0.0 (the factory default) or 169.254.xx.xx, the printer has an IP  
address assigned and stored. Go to "Verify the IP Settings."  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Enter the IP address of your printer into the web browser.  
If you do not know how to launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, see "Dell Printer Configuration Web  
Tool."  
The Dell Printer Configuration Tool opens.  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Settings Report tab.  
   
4. Select Reports.  
5. Click the Start button in the Printer Settings.  
The printer settings report is printed.  
Assign an IP Address  
NOTE: When you assign an IP address manually in IPv6 Mode, use the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. To  
open the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, use the link local address. (To check a link local address, see  
An IP address is a unique number that consists of four sections that are delimited by a period and can include up to three  
digits in each section, for example, 111.222.33.44.  
Assigning an IP address already in use can cause network performance issues.  
NOTE: Assigning an IP address is considered as an advanced function and is normally done by a system  
administrator.  
NOTE: Depending on the address class, the range of the IP address assigned may be different. On Class A, for  
example, an IP address in the range from 0.0.0.0 to 127.255.255.255 will be assigned. For assignment of IP  
addresses, contact your system administrator.  
When Using the Operator Panel  
For more information on using your operator panel, see "Operator Panel."  
1. Turn on the printer.  
The Ready to Print appears.  
2. Press Menu button.  
3. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until TCP/IP appears, and then press (Set) button.  
button until IPv4is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
4. Ensure Network is highlighted, and then press  
5. Press  
6. Press  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
button until Panel is highlighted, and then press (Set) button.  
7. Ensure Get IP Address is highlighted, and then press  
8. Press  
9. Press  
button until IP Address is highlighted, and then press  
or  
(Set) button.  
10. The first digit of the IP address is highlighted. Press  
11. Press button.  
button to enter the numbers for the IP address.  
The next digit is highlighted.  
12. Repeat Step 8 and Step 9 to enter all of the digits in the IP address, and then press  
13. Press button until Subnet Maskis highlighted, and then press (Set) button.  
14. Repeat Step 8 to Step 9 to set Subnet Mask, and then press (Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
     
15. Press  
button until Gateway Address is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
16. Repeat Step 8 to Step 9 to set Gateway Address, and then press  
17. Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again.  
(Set) button.  
When Using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool (for IPv4 Mode)  
1. Enter the IP address of your printer into the web browser.  
If you do not know how to launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, see "Dell Printer Configuration Web  
Tool."  
The Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool opens.  
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Print Server Reports tab.  
TCP/IP Settings page opens.  
4. Select mode from IP Mode.  
5. Select IP Address Mode.  
6. Enter the addresses in IP Address, Manual Subnet Mask, and Manual Gateway Address.  
When Using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool (for IPv6 Mode)  
1. Enter the IP address of your printer into the web browser.  
If you do not know how to launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, see "Dell Printer Configuration Web  
Tool."  
The Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool opens.  
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Print Server Reports tab.  
TCP/IP Settings page opens.  
4. Enter the IP addresses.  
When enabling the Stateless addresses:  
Select the check box for Enable Stateless Address to automatically configure IP addresses.  
When entering the addresses manually:  
Select the check box for Use Manual Address, and then enter the addresses in Manual Address and  
Manual Gateway Address respectively.  
You can also assign the IP address to the printer when installing the printer drivers with installer. When you use the  
Network Installation feature, and the Get IP Address is set to AutoIP on the operator panel menu, you can set the IP  
address from 0.0.0.0 to the desired IP address on the printer selection window.  
Verify the IP Settings  
1. Print another printer settings page.  
2. Look under the TCP/IP heading on the printer settings page to ensure that the IP address, subnet mask, and  
gateway are what you expected.  
or  
Ping the printer and verify that it responds. For example, at a command prompt on a network computer, type ping  
followed by the new IP address (for example, 192.168.0.11):  
ping 192.168.0.11  
 
If the printer is active on the network, you will receive a reply.  
Using the Reset Button  
Your printer is supplied with an electric leakage detector, which prevents electric shock or fire due to electric leakage by  
automatically cutting circuits inside the printer.  
When electric leakage is detected, the RESET button is tripped. In this case, press the RESET button to turn the printer  
back on. If the RESET button trips again after pressing the RESET button, contact Dell.  
Check whether or not the electric leakage detector is functioning at least once a month by following the steps below:  
1. Turn on the printer, and then press the TEST button.  
If the RESET button is tripped and the printer is turned off, the electric leakage detector functions correctly.  
Press the RESET button to turn the printer back on.  
If the RESET button is not tripped, contact Dell. Do not continue to use the printer if the electric leakage  
detector is not functioning.  
 
Perform Initial Settings  
Turning On the Printer  
The connection port for the power cable is at the lower left on the back of the printer.  
1. Connect the power cable to the printer. Then, fix the power cable on the printer with the plastic fastener.  
CAUTION: Do not use extension cords or power strips.  
CAUTION: The printer should not be plugged into a UPS system.  
2. Connect the other end of the cable to the power source.  
3. Turn on the printer.  
4. Follow the on-screen instructions in the operator panel to configure the initial settings of your printer.  
Set Initial Settings on the Operator Panel  
You need to set the printer language, clock date, and time when you turn on printer for the first time.  
When you turn the printer on, the wizard screen to perform the initial setup appears on the operator panel. Follow the  
steps below to set the initial settings.  
NOTE: If you do not start configuring the initial settings, Ready to Print appears on the operator panel in three  
minutes. After that, you can set the following initial setup by enabling Power on Wizard on the operator panel or  
Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool if needed.  
For more information on operator panel, see "Understanding the Printer Menus."  
For more information on Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, see "Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool."  
1. Ensure Panel Language is highlighted, and then press  
operator panel, and then press (Set) button.  
(Set) button. Determine the language of the text on the  
English  
Français  
Italiano  
     
Deutsch  
Español  
Dansk  
Nederlands  
Norsk  
Svenska  
2. Set Time Zone appears. Specify the time zone, and then press  
(Set) button.  
Select a time zone from the drop-down list:  
UTC -  
12:00  
-
UTC -  
11:00  
UNITED STATES  
UTC -  
10:00  
UNITED STATES  
UTC -  
09:00  
UNITED STATES  
UTC -  
08:00  
CANADA, UNITED STATES, MEXICO  
CANADA, UNITED STATES, MEXICO  
CANADA, UNITED STATES, MEXICO  
BRAZIL, CANADA, UNITED STATES, COLOMBIA  
BRAZIL, CANADA, PURETO RICO, TRINIDAD AND TOBAGO  
BRAZIL, CANADA  
UTC -  
07:00  
UTC -  
06:00  
UTC -  
05:00  
UTC -  
04:00  
UTC -  
03:30  
UTC -  
03:00  
BRAZIL  
UTC -  
02:00  
BRAZIL  
UTC -  
01:00  
ALGERIA, AUSTRIA, BELGIUM, DENMARK  
UTC  
ICELAND, IRELAND, MOROCCO, PORTUGAL, UNITED KINGDOM, IVORY COAST  
00:00  
UTC  
DENMARK, CZECH REPUBLIC, FRANCE, GERMANY, HUNGARY, ITALY, LIECHTENSTEIN,  
+01:00 LUXEMBOURG, MALTA, NETHERLANDS, NORWAY, POLAND, SLOVAKIA, SLOVENIA,  
SPAIN, SWEDEN, SWITZERLAND, TUNISIA,  
UTC  
BULGARIA, CYPRUS, EGYPT, ESTONIA, FINLAND, GREECE, ISRAEL, JORDAN, LATVIA,  
+02:00 LEBANON, LITHUANIA, ROMANIA, SOUTH AFRICA, TURKEY, RUSSIAN FEDERATION  
UTC  
+03:00  
KUWAIT, QATAR, SAUDI ARABIA, TURKEY, BAHRAIN, IRAQ, RUSSIAN FEDERATION  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION  
UTC  
+03:30  
UTC  
+04:00  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION, OMAN, UNITED ARAB EMIRATES  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION, AFGHANISTAN  
UTC  
+04:30  
UTC  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION  
+05:00  
UTC  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION  
+05:30  
UTC  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION  
+05:45  
UTC  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION  
+06:00  
UTC  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION  
+06:30  
UTC  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION  
+07:00  
UTC  
+08:00  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION, PHILIPPINES, SINGAPORE, AUSTRALIA  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION, JAPAN, SOUTH KOREA  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION, AUSTRALIA  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION, AUSTRALIA  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION  
UTC  
+09:00  
UTC  
+09:30  
UTC  
+10:00  
UTC  
+11:00  
UTC  
+12:00  
RUSSIAN FEDERATION, NEW ZEALAND  
-
UTC  
+13:00  
3. Date Format appears. Specify the date format, and then press  
4. Time Format appears. Specify the time format, and then press  
5. Set Date appears. Specify the current date, and then press  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
6. Set Time appears. Specify the current time, and then press  
7. Exit Menu appears. Select Start to exit initial settings menu.  
The printer automatically restarts after resetting your regional clock.  
Install Printer Drivers on the Windows Computers  
Identify Printer Driver Pre-install Status  
Before installing the printer driver on your computer, print the printer settings page to check your printer's IP address.  
When Using the Operator Panel  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
3. Printer Settings is displayed, and then Press  
(Set) button.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
4. Look under the TCP/IP heading on the printer settings page.  
If the IP address is 0.0.0.0, wait for a few minutes to resolve the IP address automatically, and then print the printer settings page again.  
If the IP address is not resolved automatically, refer to "Assign an IP Address."  
®
®
®
Disable Microsoft Windows XP, Windows Server 2008, Windows Server 2008 R2, Windows  
®
Vista , or Windows 7 Firewall Before Installing Printer Software  
NOTE: This step is necessary if you have Windows XP Service Pack 2 or 3 installed.  
If your printer is connected directly to a network and the Windows 7, Windows Vista, Windows Server 2008 R2, Windows Server 2008, or Windows XP firewall is enabled,  
you cannot view your networked printer(s) when you run the Dell™ printer installation software. To prevent this situation, disable the Windows 7, Windows Vista, Windows  
Server 2008 R2, Windows Server 2008, or Windows XP firewall before you install the Dell printer software. To disable or enable your Windows 7, Windows Vista, Windows  
Server 2008 R2, Windows Server 2008, or Windows XP firewall, perform the following steps.  
NOTICE: It is recommended that you enable your Windows 7, Windows Vista, Windows Server 2008 R2, Windows Server 2008, or Windows XP firewall after you  
install the printer software. Enabling the Windows 7, Windows Vista, Windows Server 2008 R2, Windows Server 2008, or Windows XP firewall after you install the  
printer software does not limit the use of your printer.  
1. Click the start button and click Help and Support.  
NOTE: For Windows Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7, if you use Online Help, switch to Offline Help on Windows Help and Support window.  
2. In the Search box, type firewall and then press Enter.  
In the list, click Turn Windows Firewall on or off and then follow the instructions on the screen.  
Insert the Drivers and Utility CD  
1. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD into your computer to start Easy Setup Navigator.  
NOTE: If the CD does not automatically launch, click start® All Programs (for Windows Vista and Windows 7)® Accessories (for Windows Vista and Windows  
7)® Run, and then type D:\setup_assist.exe(where D is the drive letter of your CD), and then click OK.  
Direct Connection Setup  
For installing PS and PCL printer driver  
1. Click Software Installation to launch the installation software.  
2. Select Personal Installation, and then click Next.  
3. Follow the on-screen instructions to connect the computer and the printer with a USB cable, and then turn the printer on.  
The Plug and Play installation starts and the installation software proceeds to the next page automatically.  
         
NOTE: If the installation software does not automatically proceed to the next page, click Install.  
4. Select either Typical Installation or Custom Installation from the installation wizard, and then click Install. If you select Custom Installation, you can select  
the specific software you want to install.  
5. Click Finish to exit the wizard when the Congratulations! screen appears.  
If necessary, click Print Test Page to print a test page.  
USB Printing  
A personal printer is a printer attached to your computer or a print server using a USB. If your printer is attached to a network and not your computer, see "Network  
For installing XPS printer driver  
NOTE: XPS driver is supported on the following operating systems: Windows 7, Windows 7 x64, Windows Vista, Windows Vista x64, Windows Server 2008 R2 x64,  
Windows Server 2008, and Windows Server 2008 x64.  
1. Uncompress the following folder on the desktop, etc.  
D:\Drivers\XPS\Win_VistaXP2K\XPS_5130.zip(where D is the drive letter of your CD)  
2. Click start ® Control Panel ® Hardware and Sound (only for Windows Vista) ® Printers.  
3. Click Add a printer to launch the Add Printer wizard.  
4. Click Add a local printer.  
5. Select the port connected to this product and click Next.  
6. Specify the printer model. Click Have Disk to display the Install From Disk dialog box.  
7. Select the folder uncompressed in step 1.  
8. A dialog box to specify printer name is displayed. To change the printer name, enter the printer name in the Printer name box. To use this printer as the default  
printer, check on the check box displayed under the Printer name.  
9. Installation starts. If the User Account Control Continue dialog box appears asking whether to continue the installation in the middle of installation, click  
Continue.  
NOTE: Depending on User's right, which you logged in with, Administrator name and password may be required. In that case, enter the Administrator name and  
password.  
10. The driver installation is completed. If necessary, click Print Test Page to print a test page.  
Network Connection Setup  
NOTE: To use this printer in a UNIX or Linux environment, you need to install a UX Filter or Linux Driver. For more information on how to install and use these, see  
NOTE: When using a CD drive in a Linux environment, you need to mount the CD according to your system environment. The command strings are  
mount/media/cdrom.  
Network Printer Setup on a Local Network  
For installing PS and PCL printer driver  
1. Click Software Installation to launch the installation software.  
2. Select Network Installation, and then click Next.  
3. Select Local Installation, and then click Next.  
4. Select the printer you want to install from the printer list, and then click Next. If the target printer is not displayed on the list, click Refresh to refresh the list or click  
Add Printer to add a printer to the list manually. You may specify the IP address and port name at this point.  
If you have installed this printer on the server computer, select the I am setting up this printer on a server check box.  
NOTE: When using AutoIP, 0.0.0.0 is displayed in the installer. Before you can continue, you must enter a valid IP address.  
NOTE: In some cases, Windows Security Alert is displayed in this step when you use Windows Vista, Windows Vista 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008,  
Windows Server 2008 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008 R2 64-bit Edition, Windows 7, or Windows 7 64-bit Edition. In this case, select Unblock (Allow  
access for Windows Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7), and then continue the procedure.  
5. Specify the printer settings, and then click Next.  
a. Enter the printer name.  
b. If you want other users on the network to access this printer, select Share this printer with other computers on the network, and then enter a share  
name that users will easily identify.  
c. If you want to set a printer as the default, select the Set this printer as default check box.  
d. If you want to restrict color printing, select the appropriate Dell ColorTrack option. Enter the password when Color-Password Enabled is selected for Dell  
ColorTrack.  
 
e. If you want to install the PostScript driver, select the PostScript Driver check box.  
6. Select the software and documentation you want to install, and then click Next. You can specify folders in which to install the Dell software and documentation. To  
change the folders, click Browse.  
7. Click Finish to exit the wizard when the Congratulations! screen appears. If necessary, click Print Test Page to print a test page.  
For installing XPS printer driver  
NOTE: XPS driver is supported on the following operating systems: Windows 7, Windows 7 x64, Windows Vista, Windows Vista x64, Windows Server 2008 R2 x64,  
Windows Server 2008, and Windows Server 2008 x64.  
1. Uncompress the following folder on the desktop, etc.  
D:\Drivers\XPS\Win_VistaXP2K\XPS_5130.zip (where D is the drive letter of your CD)  
2. Click start ® Control Panel ® Hardware and Sound (only for Windows Vista) ® Printers.  
3. Click Add a printer to launch the Add Printer wizard.  
4. Click Add a network, wireless or Bluetooth printer.  
5. Specify the printer name. Select printer or click The printer that I want isn't listed and enter the name of the printer to be connected.  
6. Select Add a printer using a TCP/IP address or Hostname, and then select Standard TCP/IP Port from Create a new port. Click Next.  
7. Enter the IP address for the printer into Hostname or IP address and click Next.  
8. Specify the printer model. Click Have Disk to display the Install From Disk dialog box.  
9. Select the folder uncompressed in step 1.  
10. A dialog box to specify printer name is displayed. To change the printer name, enter the printer name in the Printer name box. To use this printer as the default  
printer, check on the check box displayed under the Printer name.  
11. Installation starts. If the User Account Control Continue dialog box appears asking whether to continue the installation in the middle of installation, click  
Continue.  
NOTE: Depending on User's right, which you logged in with, Administrator name and password may be required. In that case, enter the Administrator name and  
password.  
12. The driver installation is completed. If necessary, click Print Test Page to print a test page.  
Use the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool to monitor the status of your network printer without leaving your desk. You can view and/or change the printer  
configuration settings, monitor toner level, and when it is time to order replacement consumables, just click the Dell supplies link right from your web browser.  
NOTE: The Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool is not available when the printer is locally attached to a computer or a print server.  
To launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, type the printer's IP address in your web browser, and the printer configuration appears on the screen.  
You can set up the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool to send you an e-mail when the printer needs supplies or intervention.  
To set up e-mail alerts:  
1. Launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
2. Click E-Mail Alert link.  
3. Under Setup E-Mail Lists and Alerts, enter the Primary SMTP Gateway, the Reply Address, and enter your e-mail address or the key operator's e- mail address  
in the e-mail list box.  
4. Click Apply New Settings.  
NOTE: The SMTP server will display Connection in Progress until an error occurs.  
Network Printer Setup on a Remote Network  
Before Installation  
Before you start remote installation, perform the following procedures.  
Allow Print Spooler to Accept Client Connections  
NOTE: This step is required for Windows Vista, Windows Vista 64-bit Edition, Windows XP, Windows XP 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2003, Windows Server 2003  
x64 Edition, Windows Server 2008, Windows Server 2008 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008 R2 64-bit Edition, Windows 7, and Windows 7 64-bit Edition.  
For Windows XP, Windows Vista, Windows Server 2003, and Windows Server 2008:  
1. Click start® All Programs (for Windows Vista only)® Accessories (for Windows Vista only)® Run.  
2. Type gpedit.msc, and then click OK.  
3. Click Computer Configuration® Administrative Templates® Printers.  
4. Right-click Allow Print Spooler to accept client connections and select Properties.  
5. From the Setting tab, select Enabled, and then click OK.  
6. Restart the computer.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7:  
1. Click Start® All Programs (for Windows 7 only)® Accessories (for Windows 7 only)® Run.  
2. Type gpedit.msc, and then click OK.  
3. Click Computer Configuration® Administrative Templates® Printers.  
4. Right-click Allow Print Spooler to accept client connections and select Edit.  
5. Select Enabled, and then click OK.  
6. Restart the computer.  
Share the Firewall File and Printer  
NOTE: This step is required for Windows Vista, Windows Vista 64-bit Edition, Windows XP, Windows XP 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008, Windows Server 2008  
64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008 R2 64-bit Edition, Windows 7, and Windows 7 64-bit Edition.  
For Windows Vista:  
1. Click start® Control Panel.  
2. Select Security.  
3. Click Windows Firewall.  
4. Click Change settings.  
5. Click Continue.  
6. From the Exceptions tab, check the File and Printer Sharing check box, and then click OK.  
For Windows Server 2008:  
1. Click start® Control Panel.  
2. Double-Click Windows Firewall.  
3. Click Change settings.  
4. From the Exceptions tab, check the File and Printer Sharing check box, and then click OK.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7:  
1. Click Start® Control Panel.  
2. Select System and Security.  
3. Click Windows Firewall.  
4. Click Allow a program or feature through Windows Firewall.  
5. If the check boxes under Allowed programs and features: are dimmed, click Change settings.  
6. Check the File and Printer Sharing check box. Home/Work (Private) or Public check box is automatically selected according to your settings.  
If File and Printer Sharing Properties dialog box appears, click OK.  
7. Click OK.  
For Windows XP:  
1. Click start® Control Panel.  
2. Select Security Center.  
3. Click Windows Firewall.  
4. From the Exceptions tab, check the File and Printer Sharing check box, and then click OK.  
Start Remote Registry  
NOTE: This step is required for Windows Vista, Windows Vista 64-bit Edition, Windows 7, and Windows 7 64-bit Edition.  
1. Click Start® Control Panel.  
2. Select System and Maintenance (System and Security for Windows 7).  
3. Click Administrative Tools.  
4. Double-click Services.  
5. Click Continue (for Windows Vista only).  
6. Right-click Remote Registry and select Start.  
7. Right-click Remote Registry and select Properties.  
8. Change Startup type: to Automatic, and then click OK.  
Disable User Account Control  
NOTICE: Disabling the User Account Control might leave the system vulnerable to virus attacks.  
NOTE: This step is required for Windows Vista, Windows Vista 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008, Windows Server 2008 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008 R2  
64-bit Edition, Windows 7, and Windows 7 64-bit Edition.  
For Windows Vista:  
1. Click start® Control Panel.  
2. Select User Accounts and Family Safety.  
3. Click User Accounts.  
4. Click Turn User Account Control on or off.  
5. Click Continue.  
6. Clear the Use User Account Control (UAC) to help protect your computer check box.  
7. Restart the computer.  
For Windows Server 2008:  
1. Click start® Control Panel.  
2. Double-Click User Accounts.  
3. Click Turn User Account Control on or off.  
4. Clear the Use User Account Control (UAC) to help protect your computer check box.  
5. Click OK.  
6. Restart the computer.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2:  
1. Click Start® Control Panel.  
2. Select User Accounts.  
3. Click User Accounts.  
4. Click Change User Account Control Settings.  
5. Move the slider to the bottom, and then click OK.  
6. Restart the computer.  
For Windows 7:  
1. Click Start® Control Panel.  
2. Select User Accounts and Family Safety.  
3. Click User Accounts.  
4. Click Change User Account Control Settings.  
5. Move the slider to the bottom, and then click OK.  
6. Click Yes in User Account Control dialog box.  
7. Restart the computer.  
Enable Network Discovery and File Sharing for all Public Networks  
You can skip "Disable User Account Control" for this procedure.  
NOTE: This step is required when you use Windows Vista, Windows Vista 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008, Windows Server 2008 64-bit Edition, Windows Server  
2008 R2 64-bit Edition, Windows 7, and Windows 7 64-bit Edition for the server computer.  
1. Click Start® Network (Start® your user name® Network for Windows 7).  
2. Click Network discovery and file sharing are turned off. Network computers and devices are not visible. Click to change.  
3. Click Turn on network discovery and file sharing.  
4. Click Yes, turn on network discovery and file sharing for all public networks.  
Disable Simple File Sharing  
NOTE: This step is required for Windows XP, and Windows XP 64-bit Edition.  
1. Click start® Control Panel.  
2. Select Appearance and Themes.  
 
3. Select Folder Options.  
4. From the View tab, clear the Use simple file sharing (Recommended) check box, and then click OK.  
5. Click start® Control Panel.  
6. Select Performance and Maintenance.  
7. Select Administrative Tools.  
8. Click Local Security Policy.  
9. Click Local Policies® Security Options.  
10. Right-click Network access: Sharing and security model for local accounts and select Properties.  
11. Ensure Classic - local users authenticate as themselves is selected.  
Installing the Printer Driver  
NOTE: Installation on Windows XP Home Edition, Windows Vista Home Basic, Windows Vista Home Premium, Windows Vista x64 Home Basic, Windows Vista x64  
Home Premium, Windows 7 Starter, Windows 7 Home Basic, Windows 7 Home Premium, Windows 7 x64 Home Basic, and Windows 7 x64 Home Premium is not  
supported.  
1. Press Software Installation to launch the installation software.  
2. Select Network Installation, and then click Next.  
3. Select Remote Installation, and then click Next.  
a. Enter the computer name, user ID, and password. Then, click Add.  
b. Click Next.  
NOTE: In some cases, Windows Security Alert is displayed in this step when you use Windows Vista, Windows Vista 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008,  
Windows Server 2008 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008 R2 64-bit Edition, Windows 7, or Windows 7 64-bit Edition. In this case, select Unblock (Allow  
access for Windows Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7), and then continue the procedure.  
4. Select the printer you want to install from the printer list, and then click Next. If the target printer is not displayed on the list, click Refresh to refresh the list or click  
Add Printer to add a printer to the list manually. You may specify the IP address and port name at this point.  
NOTE: When using AutoIP, 0.0.0.0 is displayed in the installer. Before you can continue, you must enter a valid IP address.  
5. Specify the printer settings, and then click Next.  
a. Enter the printer name.  
b. If you want other users on the network to access this printer, select Share this printer with other computers on the network, and then enter a share  
name that users will easily identify.  
c. If you want to set a printer as the default, select the Set this printer as default check box.  
d. If you want to restrict color printing, select the appropriate Dell ColorTrack option. Enter the password when Color-Password Enabled is selected for Dell  
ColorTrack.  
6. Select the software and documentation you want to install, and then click Next. You can specify folders in which to install the Dell software and documentation. To  
change the folders, click Input.  
7. Click Finish to exit the wizard when the Congratulations! screen appears.  
Use the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool to monitor the status of your network printer without leaving your desk. You can view and/or change the printer  
configuration settings, monitor toner level, and when it is time to order replacement consumables, just click the Dell supplies link right from your web browser.  
NOTE: The Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool is not available when the printer is locally attached to a computer or a print server.  
To launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, type the printer's IP address in your web browser, and the printer configuration appears on the screen.  
You can set up the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool to send you an e-mail when the printer needs supplies or intervention.  
To set up e-mail alerts:  
1. Launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
2. Click E-Mail Alert link.  
3. Under E-Mail Server Settings, enter the Primary SMTP Gateway, the Reply Address, and enter your e-mail address or the key operator's e-mail address in the  
e-mail list box.  
4. Click Apply New Settings.  
NOTE: The SMTP server will display Connection pending until printer sends an alert until an error occurs.  
Setting Up for Shared Printing  
®
You can share your new printer on the network using the Drivers and Utilities CD that shipped with your printer, or using Microsoft point and print or peer-to-peer method.  
However, if you use one of the Microsoft methods, you will not have all the features, such as the status monitor and other printer utilities, that are installed with the Drivers  
and Utilities CD.  
To share a locally-attached printer on the network, you need to share the printer, and then install the shared printer on network clients:  
 
NOTE: The following are options you need to buy separately for shared printing.  
Ethernet cable  
®
®
Windows XP, Windows XP 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2003, Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition, Windows 2000  
1. Click start® Printers and Faxes (Printers for Windows 2000).  
2. Right-click this printer icon and select Properties.  
3. From the Sharing tab, check the Share this printer (Share as for Windows 2000) check box, and then type a name in the Share name (Share as for Windows  
2000) text box.  
4. Click Additional Drivers and select the operating systems of all network clients printing to this printer.  
5. Click OK.  
If you are missing files, you will be prompted to insert the server operating system CD.  
®
Windows Vista , Windows Vista 64-bit Edition  
1. Click start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Right-click this printer icon and select Sharing.  
3. Click Change sharing options button.  
4. The dialog box displaying "Windows needs your permission to continue" appears.  
5. Click Continue button.  
6. Check the Share this printer check box, and then type a name in the Share name text box.  
7. Click Additional Drivers and select the operating systems of all network clients printing to this printer.  
8. Click OK.  
Windows Server 2008, Windows Server 2008 64-bit Edition  
1. Click start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Right-click this printer icon and select Sharing.  
3. Click Change Sharing Options button if exists.  
Check the Share this printer check box, and then type a name in the Share name text box.  
4. Click Additional Drivers and select the operating systems of all network clients printing to this printer.  
5. Click OK.  
Windows 7, Windows 7 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008 R2 64-bit Edition  
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
2. Right-click the printer icon and select Printer properties.  
3. From the Sharing tab, click Change Sharing Options button if exists.  
Check the Share this printer check box, and then type a name in the Share name text box.  
4. Click Additional Drivers and select the operating systems of all network clients printing to this printer.  
5. Click Apply, and then click OK.  
To check that the printer is successfully shared:  
Ensure that the printer object in the Printers, Printers and Faxes, or Devices and Printers folder is shared. A icon of sharing is shown underneath the printer  
icon.  
Browse Network or My Network Places. Find the host name of the server and look for the shared name you assigned to the printer.  
Now that the printer is shared, you can install the printer on network clients using the point and print method or the peer-to-peer method.  
Point and Print  
This method is usually the best use of system resources. The server handles driver modifications and print job processing. This lets network clients return to their programs  
much faster.  
If you use the point and print method, a subset of driver information is copied from the server to the client computer. This is just enough information to send a print job to  
the printer.  
Windows XP, Windows XP 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2003, Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition, Windows 2000  
1. On the Windows desktop of the client computer, double-click My Network Places.  
2. Locate the host name of the server computer, and then double-click the host name.  
3. Right-click the shared printer name, and then click Connect.  
Wait for the driver information to copy from the server computer to the client computer, and for a new printer object to be added to the Printers and Faxes  
(Printers for Windows 2000) folder. The copy time varies, based on network traffic and other factors.  
Close My Network Places.  
4. Print a test page to verify installation.  
a. Click start® Printers and Faxes (Printers for Windows 2000).  
b. Select the printer you just created.  
c. Click File® Properties.  
d. From the General tab, click Print Test Page.  
When a test page prints successfully, installation is complete.  
Windows Vista, Windows Vista 64-bit Edition  
1. On the Windows desktop of the client computer, click start® Network.  
2. Locate the host name of the server computer, and then double-click the host name.  
3. Right-click the shared printer name, and then click Connect.  
4. Click Install driver.  
5. Click Continue in User Account Control dialog.  
6. Wait for the driver information to copy from the server computer to the client computer, and for a new printer object to be added to the Printers folder. The time  
this takes varies, based on network traffic and other factors.  
7. Print a test page to verify installation.  
a. Click start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound.  
b. Select Printers.  
c. Right-click the printer you just created and select Properties.  
d. From the General tab, click Print Test Page.  
When a test page prints successfully, installation is complete.  
Windows Server 2008, Windows Server 2008 64-bit Edition  
1. On the Windows desktop of the client computer, click start® Network.  
2. Locate the host name of the server computer, and then double-click the host name.  
3. Right-click the shared printer name, and then click Connect.  
4. Click Install driver.  
5. Wait for the driver information to copy from the server computer to the client computer, and for a new printer object to be added to the Printers folder. The time  
this takes varies, based on network traffic and other factors.  
6. Print a test page to verify installation.  
a. Click start® Control Panel.  
b. Select Printers.  
c. Right-click the printer you just created and select Properties.  
d. From the General tab, click Print Test Page.  
When a test page prints successfully, installation is complete.  
Windows 7, Windows 7 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008 R2 64-bit Edition  
1. On the Windows desktop of the client computer, click Start® your user name® Network (Start® Network for Windows Server 2008 R2).  
2. Locate the host name of the server computer, and then double-click the host name.  
3. Right-click the shared printer name, and then click Connect.  
4. Click Install driver.  
5. Wait for the driver information to copy from the server computer to the client computer, and for a new printer object to be added to the Devices and Printers  
folder. The time this takes varies, based on network traffic and other factors.  
6. Print a test page to verify installation.  
a. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
b. Right-click the printer you just created and select Printer properties.  
c. From the General tab, click Print Test Page.  
When a test page prints successfully, installation is complete.  
Peer-to-Peer  
If you use the peer-to-peer method, the printer driver is fully installed on each client computer. Network clients retain control of driver modifications. The client computer  
handles the print job processing.  
Windows XP, Windows XP 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2003, Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition, Windows 2000  
1. Click start® Printers and Faxes (Printers for Windows 2000).  
2. Click Add a Printer to launch the Add Printer wizard.  
3. Click Next.  
4. Select A network printer, or a printer attached to another computer, and then click Next (For Windows 2000, select the network printer from the Shared  
printers list). If the printer is not listed, type in the path of the printer in the text box.  
The server host name is the name of the server computer that identifies it to the network. The shared printer name is the name assigned during the server installation  
process.  
5. Click Browse for a printer, and then click Next (For Windows 2000, click OK).  
If this is a new printer, you may be prompted to install a printer driver. If no system driver is available, then you will need to provide a path to available drivers.  
6. Select whether you want this printer to be the default printer for the client, click Next, and then click Finish (For Windows 2000, click Finish).  
7. Print a test page to verify installation:  
a. Click start® Settings® Printers and Faxes (Printers for Windows 2000).  
b. Select the printer you just created.  
c. Click File® Properties.  
d. From the General tab, click Print Test Page.  
When a test page prints successfully, installation is complete.  
Windows Vista, Windows Vista 64-bit Edition  
1. Click start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers.  
2. Click Add a Printer to launch the Add Printer wizard.  
3. Select Add a network, wireless or Bluetooth printer, and then click Next. If the printer is listed, select the printer and click Next, or select The printer that I  
want isn't listed and type in the path of the printer in the Select a shared printer by name text box and click Next.  
The server host name is the name of the server computer that identifies it to the network. The shared printer name is the name assigned during the server installation  
process.  
4. If this is a new printer, you may be prompted to install a printer driver. If no system driver is available, then you will need to provide a path to available drivers.  
5. Select whether you want this printer to be the default printer for the client, click Next.  
6. If you want to verify installation then click Print a test page.  
7. Click Finish.  
When a test page prints successfully, installation is complete.  
Windows Server 2008, Windows Server 2008 64-bit Edition  
1. Click start® Control Panel® Printers.  
2. Click Add a Printer to launch the Add Printer wizard.  
3. Select Add a network, wireless or Bluetooth printer, and then click Next. If the printer is listed, select the printer and click Next, or select The printer that I  
want isn't listed and type in the path of the printer in the Select a shared printer by name text box and click Next.  
For example: \\<server host name>\<shared printer name>  
The server host name is the name of the server computer that identifies it to the network. The shared printer name is the name assigned during the server installation  
process.  
4. If this is a new printer, you may be prompted to install a printer driver. If no system driver is available, then you will need to provide a path to available drivers.  
5. Select whether you want this printer to be the default printer for the client, click Next.  
6. If you want to verify installation then click Print a test page.  
7. Click Finish.  
When a test page prints successfully, installation is complete.  
Windows 7, Windows 7 64-bit Edition, Windows Server 2008 R2 64-bit Edition  
1. Click Start® Devices and Printers.  
2. Click Add a Printer to launch the Add Printer wizard.  
3. Select Add a network, wireless or Bluetooth printer. If the printer is listed, select the printer and click Next, or select The printer that I want isn't listed.  
Click Select a shared printer by name and type in the path of the printer in the text box, and then click Next.  
For example: \\<server host name>\<shared printer name>  
The server host name is the name of the server computer that identifies it to the network. The shared printer name is the name assigned during the server installation  
process.  
4. If this is a new printer, you may be prompted to install a printer driver. If no system driver is available, then you will need to provide the path to the available drivers.  
5. Confirm the printer name, and then click Next.  
6. Select whether you want this printer to be the default printer for the client.  
7. If you want to verify installation then click Print a test page.  
8. Click Finish.  
When a test page prints successfully, installation is complete.  
Setup Security  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
button until Panel Settings is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until Enable is highlighted, and then press  
6. Enter the new password, and then press (Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
3. Press  
(Set) button.  
4. Panel Lockis displayed. Press  
5. Press  
(Set) button.  
7. Re-enter the password to confirm the password that you entered, and then press  
The password has been changed.  
(Set) button.  
NOTE: If you forget your password, turn off the printer. Then, while holding Menu button, turn on the printer. Perform steps 2 to 7 to reset the password. This will  
recover the factory default panel password.  
NOTE: If you change the password while Panel Lock is Enable, follow the following steps. Perform steps 1 and 2. Press  
highlighted, and then press (Set) button. Perform steps 6 and 7 to change the password. This will change the password.  
NOTE: If Panel Lock is Enable, the factory-default panel password is 0000.  
button until Change Password is  
Disable*  
Enable  
Does not lock Admin Menuwith a password.  
Panel Lock  
Locks Admin Menuwith a password.  
0000*  
Change Password  
Sets or changes the password required to access Admin Menu.  
0000-9999  
Troubleshooting Instructions  
Resetting Defaults  
After executing this function and rebooting the printer, all the menu parameters, except the parameters for the network, are reset to their default values.  
When Using the Operator Panel  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
3. Press  
4. Press  
5. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
button until Maintenance is highlighted, and then press  
until Reset Defaults is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
until Start is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
6. Turn off the printer to apply the settings.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
   
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Maintenance tab.  
4. Select Reset Defaults from the list at the left side of the page.  
The Reset Defaults page is displayed.  
5. Click Start.  
The printer is turned off automatically to apply the settings.  
Install the PPD File on Macintosh Computers  
The PPD (PostScript Printer Description) file describes print features and capabilities (such as paper sources, paper sizes,  
and duplexing) of a particular printer. To print data on Macintosh computers, the PostScript driver uses this data to  
command the printer properly.  
Installing the PPD File  
1. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD into your computer.  
2. Launch the Drivers and Utilities CD.  
3. Double-click the Mac OS X folder, and then double-click the Dell 5130cdn Installer icon.  
4. Type the administrator's name and password, and then click OK.  
5. Read the Dell software license agreement, and then click Continue.  
6. Click Agree.  
7. Select Easy Install, and then click Install.  
8. Click Quit.  
Installation is complete.  
9. Go to the next section to continue.  
Adding a Printer on Mac OS X 10.5 or Later Version(s)  
When Using a USB Connection  
1. Turn on the printer.  
2. Connect the USB cable between the printer and the Macintosh computer.  
3. Start System Preferences.  
4. Click Print and Fax, and then click +.  
5. Click Default and select the printer that is connected via USB connection. Then, click Add.  
When Using IP Printing  
NOTE: A network printer adapter must be installed to select IP. Refer to the User's Guide available on the Drivers  
and Utilities CD or support.dell.com for installation instructions.  
1. Turn on the printer.  
2. Connect the LAN cable between the printer and the network.  
NOTE: The Macintosh computer must be connected to the network in advance.  
3. Start Systems Preferences.  
   
4. Click Print and Fax, and then click +.  
5. Select IP from the menu.  
6. Type the IP address of the printer being used in the Address area and select Line Printer Daemon - LPD from  
Protocol.  
7. Select Select a driver to use... from Print Using and select Dell 5130cdn Color Laser from the list.  
NOTE: When printing is set up using IP printing, the queue name is displayed as blank. You do not need to  
specify it.  
8. Click Add.  
9. Specify the options that have been installed on the printer, and then click Continue.  
10. Confirm that the printer is displayed in the Print & Fax dialog box.  
When Using Bonjour  
NOTE: A network protocol adapter must be installed and the IP addresses for the Macintosh computer and the  
printer must have the same segment to use Bonjour.  
1. Turn on the printer.  
2. Connect the LAN cable between the printer and the network.  
NOTE: The Macintosh computer must be connected to the network in advance.  
3. Start Systems Preferences.  
4. Click Print and Fax, and then click +.  
5. Click Default and select the printer that is connected via the Bonjour connection. Then, click Add.  
6. Specify the options that have been installed on the printer, and then click Continue.  
7. Confirm that the printer is displayed in the Print & Fax dialog box.  
Adding a Printer on Mac OS X 10.4  
When Using a USB Connection  
1. Turn on the printer.  
2. Connect the USB cable between the printer and the Macintosh computer.  
3. Start the Printer Setup Utility, and then click Add from the Printer List dialog box.  
4. Click Default Browser and select your printer from the Printer List.  
5. Your printer model is automatically selected for Printer Model.  
6. Select USB from the menu, and then select your printer from the list.  
7. Click Add.  
When Using IP Printing  
1. Click IP Printer on the Printer Browser dialog box, and select Line Printer Daemon - LPD from the Protocol  
menu.  
2. Type the IP address for the printer being used to Address in the Protocol menu.  
3. Select Dell from Print Using, and confirm Dell 5130cdn Color Laser is selected for the Model Name.  
NOTE: When printing is set up using IP printing, the queue name is displayed as blank. You do not need to  
specify it.  
4. Click Add.  
When Using Bonjour  
NOTE: A network protocol adapter must be installed and the IP addresses for the Macintosh computer and the  
printer must have the same segment to use Bonjour.  
1. Turn on the printer.  
2. Connect the LAN cable between the printer and the network.  
NOTE: The Macintosh computer must be connected to the network in advance.  
3. Start the Printer Setup Utility, and click Add from the Printer List dialog box.  
4. Click Default Browser on the Printer Browser dialog box and select the printer that is connected via the Bonjour  
connection. Then, click Add.  
5. Specify the options to have been installed to the printer, and then click Continue.  
6. Confirm that the printer is displayed on the Printer List dialog box.  
Adding a Printer on Mac OS X 10.3 or Earlier Version(s)  
1. Turn on the printer.  
2. If you use the USB port, connect the USB cable between the printer and the Macintosh computer.  
3. Start Printer Setup Utility. The Printer List screen appears.  
NOTE: When using Mac OS X 10.3 or later, you can find the Printer Setup Utility in the Utilities folder in  
Applications.  
4. Click Add.  
When Using USB  
1. Select USB from the menu, and then select your printer from the list.  
2. For Mac OS X 10.3 or later, your printer model is automatically selected for Printer Model.  
3. Click Add.  
When Using IP Printing  
1. Select IP Printing from the menu, and type the IP address for the printer being used in Printer Address.  
2. Select Printer Type from the menu, and select LPD/LPR.  
3. Select Dell from Printer Model, and confirm Dell 5130cdn Color Laser is selected for the Model Name. If it is  
not selected, select it.  
NOTE: When printing is set up using IP printing, the queue name is displayed as blank. You do not need to  
specify it.  
4. Click Add.  
When Using Rendezvous  
NOTE: A network protocol adapter must be installed and the IP addresses for the Macintosh computer and the  
printer must have the same segment to use Rendezvous.  
1. Turn on the printer.  
2. Connect the LAN cable between the printer and the network.  
NOTE: The Macintosh computer must be connected to the network in advance.  
3. Start the Printer Setup Utility, and click Add from the Printer List dialog box.  
4. Select Rendezvous from the menu, and select your printer from the list.  
5. Select Dell from Printer Model, and select Dell 5130cdn Color Laser.  
Then click Add.  
6. Confirm that the printer is displayed on the Printer List dialog box.  
Configure Settings  
All the optional accessories are verified as installed.  
Mac OS X 10.5 or Later Version(s)  
1. Select the Print & Fax in System Preferences.  
2. Select the printer in Printers list, and click Options & Supplies.  
3. Select Driver, and select the options that have been installed in the printers, and then click OK.  
Mac OS X 10.3 or 10.4  
1. Start the Printer Setup Utility.  
2. On the Printer List dialog box, select the printer to be configured.  
3. Click Show Info.  
4. Select Installable Options, and select the options that have been installed on the printer, then click Apply  
Changes.  
NOTE: You must configure the print queue that was automatically created on a non-English version of Mac OS X  
10.3 when a USB cable is connected to your computer.  
Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool  
Overview  
NOTE: This web tool is not available unless the printer is connected to a network using a network cable or the  
wireless adapter.  
One of the features of the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool is E-Mail Alert Setup, which sends an e-mail to you or  
the key operator when the printer needs supplies or intervention.  
To fill out printer inventory reports requiring the asset tag number of all the printers in your area, use the Printer  
Information feature in the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. Just enter the IP address of each printer on the  
network to display the asset tag number.  
The Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool feature also allows you to change the printer settings and keep track of  
printing trends. If you are a network administrator, you can easily copy the printer settings to one or all printers on the  
network using your web browser.  
To launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, type your printer's IP address in your web browser.  
If you do not know the IP address of your printer, print the printer settings page or display the TCP/IP settings page,  
which lists the IP address.  
When Using the Operator Panel  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
3. Printer Settings is displayed. Press (Set) button.  
   
The printer settings page is printed.  
If the IP address shows 0.0.0.0 (the factory default), an IP address has not been assigned. To assign one for your  
printer, see "Assign an IP Address."  
Using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool  
Use the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool for:  
Printer Status  
Use the Printer Status menu to get immediate feedback on the printer supply status. When a toner cartridge is running  
low, click the order supplies link on the first screen to order an additional toner cartridge.  
Printer Jobs  
Use the Printer Jobs menu to contain information on the Job List page and Completed Jobs page.  
These pages show the details of the status regarding each protocol or job.  
Printer Settings  
Use the Printer Settings menu to change printer settings and view the settings in the operator panel remotely.  
Print Server Settings  
Using the Print Server Settings menu, you can change the type of printer interface and necessary conditions for  
communications.  
Copy Printer Settings  
Use the Copy Printer Settings menu to copy the printer settings and the ColorTrack settings to another printer or  
printers on the network just by typing each printer's IP address.  
NOTE: You must log in as an administrator to use this feature.  
Print Volume  
Use the Print Volume option to check the histories of printing, such as paper usage and types of jobs being printed, and  
limit which users use the color mode and the maximum number of pages they can print by setting the internal or external  
certification.  
Printer Information  
Use the Printer Information menu to get the information on service calls, inventory reports, or the status of current  
memory and engine code levels.  
Tray Settings  
Use the Tray Settings menu to get the information about the paper type and size for each tray.  
E-Mail Alert  
 
Use the E-Mail Alert menu to receive an e-mail when the printer needs supplies or intervention. Type your name or the  
key operator's name in the  
e-mail list box to be notified.  
Set Password  
Use the Set Password menu to lock the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool with a password so that other users do  
not inadvertently change the printer settings you selected.  
NOTE: You must log in as an administrator to use this feature.  
Online Help  
Click Online Help to visit the Dell Support website.  
Order Supplies at:  
Contact Dell Support at:  
Setting Up the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool  
Ensure that you activate JavaScript in your browser before using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
It is recommended that you configure the environment settings of your web browser before using the Dell Printer  
Configuration Web Tool.  
NOTE: The Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool pages may be displayed unreadable if the pages were  
configured by the language different from your web browser's.  
Setting Up From Web Browser  
It is recommended that you configure both the environment settings of your web browser and the operator panel before  
using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
®
For Internet Explorer 6.0, Internet Explorer 7.0, Internet Explorer 8.0  
Setting Up the Display Language  
1. Select Internet Options from Tools on the menu bar.  
2. Select Languages in the General tab.  
3. Specify the display language in order of preference in the Language list.  
For example:  
Italian (Italy) [it-IT]  
Spanish (Traditional Sort) [es-ES tradnl]  
 
German (Germany) [de-DE]  
French (France) [fr-FR]  
English (United States) [en-us]  
Danish [da-DK]  
Dutch (Netherlands) [nl-NL]  
Norwegian (Bokmal) [no]  
Swedish [sv-SE]  
Setting the Printer's IP Address to Non-Proxy  
1. Select Internet Options from the Tools menu.  
2. Click LAN Settings under Local Area Network (LAN) Settings in the Connections tab.  
3. Do either of the following:  
Clear the Use a proxy server for your LAN check box under Proxy server.  
Click Advanced, and then specify the printer's IP address in the Do not use proxy server for addresses  
beginning with field under Exceptions.  
After setting the language and proxy, type <http://nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn/> (the printer's IP address) in the URL entry field  
of the browser to activate the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
For Firefox 2.0 or Later  
Setting Up the Display Language  
1. Select Options from the Tools menu.  
2. Click Advanced.  
3. When you use Firefox 2.0, click Choose in the General tab. When you use Firefox 3.0, click Choose in the  
Content tab.  
4. Specify the display language in order of preference in the Languages in order of preference list.  
For example:  
English [en] or English/United States [en-us]  
Italian [it]  
Spanish [es]  
German [de]  
French [fr]  
Dutch [nl]  
Norwegian [no]  
Swedish [sv]  
Danish [da]  
Setting the Printer's IP Address to Non-Proxy  
1. Select Options from the Tools menu.  
2. Click Advanced tab.  
3. Click Network on the Options dialog box.  
4. Click Connection ® Settings.  
5. When you use Firefox 2.0, do one of the following:  
Select the Direct connection to the Internet check box.  
Select the Auto-detect proxy settings for this network check box.  
Select the Manual proxy configuration check box, and then enter the printer's IP address in the No Proxy  
for edit box.  
Select the Automatic proxy configuration URL check box.  
When you use Firefox 3.0, do the following:  
Select the No Proxy check box, if you don't want to use a proxy.  
Select the Auto-detect proxy settings for this network check box.  
Select the Manual proxy configuration check box, and then enter a hostname and a port number if you  
have a list of one or more proxy servers. If you have an IP address that will not be proxied, enter the  
printer's IP address in the No Proxy for edit box.  
Select the Automatic proxy configuration URL check box.  
After setting the language and proxy, type <http://nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn/> (the printer's IP address) in the URL entry field  
of the browser to activate the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
Setting Up From Operator Panel  
You can launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool only when EWS is set to Enable (the factory default) on the  
operator panel. Confirm the operator panel setting if you cannot launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. For  
more information, see "Understanding the Printer Menus".  
Page Display Format  
The layout of the page is divided into three sections mentioned below:  
Top Frame  
The Top Frame is located at the top of all pages. When Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool is activated, the current  
status and specifications of the printer are displayed in the Top Frame on every page.  
The following items are displayed in the Top Frame.  
 
Dell 5130cdn  
Color Laser  
1
Displays the printer's product name.  
Displays the printer's IP address.  
2 IP Address  
3 Location  
Displays the printer's location. The location can be changed in Basic Information on the Print  
Server Settings page.  
Displays the name of the printer's administrator. The name can be changed in the Basic  
Information on the Print Server Settings page.  
4 Contact Person  
5 Event Panel  
Displays the condition of the printer. If the error occurs, the message is indicated as "error  
code"+":"+"message". For example, 077-090:Paper jam. Open...  
Shows the bitmap image of the printer. The Printer Status menu appears in the Right Frame  
when you click the image.  
6 Printer Bitmap  
Left Frame  
The Left Frame is located at the left side of all pages. The menu titles displayed in the Left Frame are linked to  
corresponding menus and pages. You can go to the corresponding page by clicking their characters.  
The following menus are displayed in the Left Frame.  
1
2
Printer Status  
Printer Jobs  
Links to the Printer Status menu.  
Links to the Printer Jobs menu.  
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Printer Settings  
Print Server Settings  
Copy Printer Settings  
Print Volume  
Links to the Printer Settings Report menu.  
Links to the Print Server Reports menu.  
Links to the Copy Printer Settings menu.  
Links to the Print Volume menu.  
Links to the Printer Status menu.  
Links to the Tray Settings menu.  
Links to the Print Server Settings menu.  
Links to the Security menu.  
Printer Information  
Tray Settings  
E-Mail Alert  
10 Set Password  
11 Online Help  
Links to the Dell Support website.  
Links to the Dell web page.  
12 Order Supplies at:  
13 Contact Dell Support at: Links to the Dell support page web address: support.dell.com/  
Right Frame  
The Right Frame is located at the right side of all pages. The contents of the Right Frame correspond to the menu that  
you select in the Left Frame. For details on the items displayed in the Right Frame, see "Details of the Menu Items."  
Buttons in the Right Frame  
1 Refresh Button  
Receives the current printer configuration and updates the latest information in the Right Frame.  
Apply New  
2
Submits new settings made on the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool to the printer. The  
old printer settings will be replaced by the new settings.  
Settings Button  
Restore Settings Restores the old settings from before changes made. New settings will not be submitted to the  
3
Button  
printer.  
Changing the Settings of the Menu Items  
Some menus allow you to change the printer settings through the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. When you are  
accessing these menus, the authentication dialog appears on the screen. Type a user name and password for the printer's  
administrator by following the prompts displayed in the dialog box.  
The default user name is admin, and the default password is left blank (NULL). You can change only the password in the  
 
"SSL/TLS"  
"IPsec"  
3
1
* This item is available only when the RAM disk is on or the optional hard disk is installed.  
2
* This item is available only when connecting the printer with a wireless network.  
3
* This item is available only when connecting the printer with a wired network.  
Printer Status  
Use the Printer Status menu to check the status of consumables, hardware, and specifications of the printer.  
The following pages are displayed in the Printer Status menu.  
Printer Status  
Purpose:  
To check the status of the consumables and trays.  
Values:  
Cyan Toner Cartridge  
Level  
Magenta Toner  
Cartridge Level  
Displays the percent of toner remaining in each toner cartridge. When a cartridge is empty,  
a message appears. The text Call or Order is linked to the Dell Printer Supplies website.  
Yellow Toner Cartridge  
Level  
Black Toner Cartridge  
Level  
Indicates that the status of the drum cartridge, staple cartridge and/or waste toner box is  
OK for use.  
OK  
Indicates that the status of the drum cartridge, staple cartridge and/or waste toner box  
needs to be replaced soon. The text Call or Order is linked to the Dell Printer Supplies  
website.  
Replace  
Soon  
Consumables  
Status  
Indicates that the status of the drum cartridge, staple cartridge and/or waste toner box  
needs to be replaced now. The text Call or Order is linked to the Dell Printer Supplies  
website.  
Replace  
Now  
???  
Indicates that the non-Dell toner cartridges are installed.  
-
Indicates that the drum cartridge or staple cartridge is not installed.  
   
OK  
Indicates that there is some paper in the tray but the quantity is unknown.  
Indicates that paper is running low in the tray.  
Paper  
Status Low  
Paper  
Trays  
Add  
Paper  
Indicates that there is no paper in the tray.  
Capacity  
Displays the maximum capacity of the paper tray.  
Displays the size of paper in the tray.  
Size  
OK  
Indicates that the tray is available.  
Status  
Output  
Tray  
Full  
Indicates that the tray is not available.  
Displays the maximum capacity of the paper tray.  
Indicates that the cover is closed.  
Capacity  
Closed  
Cover  
Status  
Open  
Indicates that the cover is open.  
Printer Type  
Displays the type of the printer. Color Laser is displayed normally.  
Displays the printer's printing speed.  
Printing Speed  
Printer Events  
Purpose:  
When faults such as Out of Paper or Front Cover is Open occur, the details of all alerts or indications of faults are  
displayed in the Printer Events page.  
Values:  
Location Displays the location where the error occurred.  
Details  
Displays the details of the error.  
Printer Information  
Purpose:  
To verify the printer details such as the hardware configuration and software version. This page can also be displayed by  
clicking Printer Information in the Left Frame.  
Values:  
Dell Service Tag Number  
Asset Tag Number  
Displays Dell's service tag number.  
Displays the printer's asset tag number.  
Displays the printer's serial number.  
Displays the memory capacity.  
Printer Serial Number  
Memory Capacity  
1
Displays information on the printer's hard disk.  
Hard Disk*  
Processor Speed  
Displays the processing speed.  
Firmware Version  
Displays the revision date (revision level).  
Printer Revision Levels  
Network Firmware Version Displays the revision date (revision level).  
1
* This item is available only when the optional hard disk drive is installed.  
Printer Jobs  
The Printer Jobs menu contains information on the Job List and Completed Jobs pages. These pages show the details  
of the status regarding each protocol or the print jobs.  
       
Job List  
Purpose:  
To confirm the print jobs that are being processed. Click the Refresh button to update the screen.  
Values:  
ID  
Displays the job ID.  
Job Name  
Owner  
Displays the file name of the job being printed.  
Displays the job owner's name.  
Host Name  
Job Status  
Host I/F  
Displays the name of the host computer.  
Displays the status of the job being printed.  
Displays the status of the host interface.  
Job Submitted Time Displays the date the print job was submitted.  
Completed Jobs  
Purpose:  
To check the completed jobs. Maximum of last 22 print jobs are displayed. Click the Refresh button to update the screen.  
Values:  
ID  
Displays the job ID.  
Job Name  
Owner  
Displays the file name of the job.  
Displays the job owner's name.  
Displays the name of the host computer.  
Displays the status of the job.  
Host Name  
Output Result  
Impression Number Displays the job's total number of job pages.  
No. of Sheets  
Host I/F  
Displays the job's total job sheets.  
Displays the status of the host interface.  
Job Submitted Time Displays the date the job was submitted.  
Printer Settings  
Use the Printer Settings menu to display the Printer Settings Report and to configure the printer settings.  
The following tabbed pages are displayed at the top of the Right Frame.  
Printer Settings Report  
The Printer Settings Report tab includes the Menu Settings and Reports pages.  
Menu Settings  
Purpose:  
To display the current settings of the operator panel menus.  
Values:  
       
Power Saver  
Time-Sleep  
Displays the time for transition to the power saver mode (Sleep).  
Displays the time for transition to the power saver mode (Deep Sleep).  
Power Saver  
Time-Deep  
Sleep  
Control Panel  
Tone  
Displays whether to emit the tone when the operator panel input is correct. Off  
indicates that the tone is disabled.  
Invalid Key  
Tone  
Displays whether to emit the tone when the operator panel input is incorrect. Off  
indicates that the tone is disabled.  
Machine Ready Displays whether to emit the tone when the printer becomes ready. Off indicates  
Tone that the tone is disabled.  
Job Completed Displays whether to emit the tone when a print job is complete. Off indicates that  
System  
Settings  
Tone  
the tone is disabled.  
Displays whether to emit the tone when a job ends abnormally. Off indicates that  
the tone is disabled.  
Fault Tone  
Displays whether to emit the tone when a problem occurs. Off indicates that the  
tone is disabled.  
Alert Tone  
Out of Paper  
Alert Tone  
Displays whether to emit the tone when the printer runs out of paper. Off indicates  
that the tone is disabled.  
Low Toner  
Alert Tone  
Displays whether to emit the tone when toner or some other consumable is low. Off  
indicates that the tone is disabled.  
Displays whether to emit the tone when the operator panel screen is returned to  
the default by scrolling the loop menu. Off indicates that the tone is disabled.  
Base Tone  
Fault Time-Out Displays the amount of time the printer cancels for a job stops abnormally.  
Job Time-Out  
Displays the amount of time the printer waits for data to arrive from the computer.  
Displays the language used on the operator panel screen.  
Panel  
Language  
Auto Log Print Displays whether to automatically output a log of completed jobs.  
Print ID  
Displays where to print a user ID on the output paper.  
Displays whether the printer outputs PDL (Page Description Language) data, which  
is not supported by the printer, as text when the printer receives it.  
Print Text  
Banner Sheet  
Insert Position  
Displays where to insert a banner sheet.  
Banner Sheet  
Specify Tray  
Displays which input tray to use to insert a banner sheet.  
Displays the amount of memory allocated for the file system, Secure Print and Proof  
Print features.  
1
RAM Disk*  
Displays whether to use another size paper when the paper that is loaded in the  
specified tray does not match the paper size settings for the current job.  
Substitute Tray  
mm / inch  
Displays the measurement unit used on the operator panel screen.  
Displays whether to duplex print for letter head paper.  
Letterhead  
Duplex Mode  
Low Toner  
Alert Msg  
Displays whether to show the message when the toner is short.  
Displays whether to offset the position of the output paper.  
2
Job Offset*  
Banner Sheet  
Displays whether to insert the banner sheet per offset output paper.  
Displays whether to staple per offset output paper.  
2
Offset*  
Job Offset of  
2
Staple*  
Stapler Cart.  
Displays whether to continue the print job when the stapler cartridge is empty.  
Displays whether the parallel interface is enabled.  
2
Empty*  
Parallel Port  
Parallel  
Settings  
ECP  
Displays the ECP communication mode of the parallel interface.  
Displays PostScript communication protocol for each interface.  
Adobe™  
Protocol  
Network  
Settings  
Adobe Protocol Displays PostScript communication protocol for each interface.  
USB Port  
Displays whether the USB interface is enabled.  
USB Settings  
Adobe Protocol Displays PostScript communication protocol for each interface.  
Paper Tray  
Paper Size  
Displays the paper tray setting.  
Displays the paper size setting.  
Custom Size -  
Y
Displays the length of custom size paper.  
Displays the width of custom size paper.  
Custom Size -  
X
Orientation  
2 Sided  
Displays how text and graphics are oriented on the page.  
Displays whether to do duplexing as the default for all print jobs.  
Displays the selected font from the list of registered fonts.  
Displays a symbol set for the specified font.  
Font  
Symbol Set  
Font Size  
Font Pitch  
Form Line  
Quantity  
PCL Settings  
Displays the font size for scalable typographic fonts.  
Displays the font pitch for scalable monospaced fonts.  
Displays the number of characters in a line.  
Displays the number of copies to print.  
Image  
Enhancement  
Displays whether the Image Enhancement feature is enabled.  
Hex Dump  
Draft Mode  
Displays whether the Hex Dump feature is enabled.  
Displays whether to print in the draft mode.  
Line  
Termination  
Displays whether to set the line termination.  
Default Color  
Displays the color mode setting.  
PS Error  
Report  
Displays whether the printer outputs error contents for a PostScript error.  
PS Job Time-  
Out  
Displays the execution time for one PostScript job.  
PS Settings  
Paper Select  
Mode  
Displays the tray that is selected in the PostScript printing.  
Displays the color mode setting.  
Default Color  
Panel Lock Set Displays whether to lock Admin Menu with a password.  
Login Error-  
Attempts  
Displays the maximum number that the administrator fails to log in.  
Encryption  
Displays whether to encrypt the data.  
Set Available  
Time  
Displays whether to set the time period when printing is available.  
Start Time  
End Time  
Displays the start time of the time period when printing is available.  
Displays the end time of the time period when printing is available.  
Displays the day of the week to repeat the setting.  
Recurrence  
HDD Overwrite  
Secure  
Settings  
Displays whether to overwrite the hard disk drive.  
3
Mode*  
Expiration  
Displays whether to set the date to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the  
RAM disk or the hard disk drive.  
4
Mode*  
Expiration  
Displays the time to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the  
hard disk drive.  
4
Time*  
4
Displays the period to repeat the setting.  
Recurrence*  
Weekly  
Displays the day of the week to repeat the setting.  
4
Settings*  
Monthly  
Displays the day of the month to repeat the setting.  
4
Settings*  
Plain  
Label  
Plain  
Displays the paper density of plain paper.  
Displays the paper density of labels.  
Paper Density  
Displays the voltage setting of the transfer roller (from -6 to 6) for plain paper.  
(60 to 90 gsm)  
Plain Thick  
(80/90 to 105  
gsm)  
Displays the voltage setting of the transfer roller (from -6 to 6) for thick plain  
paper.  
Transparency  
Displays the voltage setting of the transfer roller (from -6 to 6) for transparencies.  
Displays the voltage setting of the transfer roller (from -6 to 6) for cover paper.  
Covers  
(106 to 163  
gsm)  
Covers Thick  
(164 to 216  
gsm)  
Displays the voltage setting of the transfer roller (from -6 to 6) for thick cover  
paper.  
Adjust BTR  
Label  
Displays the voltage setting of the transfer roller (from -6 to 6) for labels.  
Displays the voltage setting of the transfer roller (from -6 to 6) for coated paper.  
Coated  
(106 to 163  
gsm)  
Coated Thick  
(164 to 216  
gsm)  
Displays the voltage setting of the transfer roller (from -6 to 6) for thick coated  
paper.  
Envelope  
Recycled  
Displays the voltage setting of the transfer roller (from -6 to 6) for envelopes.  
Displays the voltage setting of the transfer roller (from -6 to 6) for recycled paper.  
Plain  
(60 to 90 gsm)  
Displays the temperature setting of the fuser (from -6 to 6) for plain paper.  
Plain Thick  
(80/90 to 105  
gsm)  
Displays the temperature setting of the fuser (from -6 to 6) for thick plain paper.  
Displays the temperature setting of the fuser (from -6 to 6) for transparency.  
Displays the temperature setting of the fuser (from -6 to 6) for cover paper.  
Transparency  
Covers  
(106 to 163  
gsm)  
Covers Thick  
(164 to 216  
gsm)  
Displays the temperature setting of the fuser (from -6 to 6) for thick cover paper.  
Displays the temperature setting of the fuser (from -6 to 6) for labels.  
Displays the temperature setting of the fuser (from -6 to 6) for coated paper.  
Adjust Fuser  
Label  
Coated  
(106 to 163  
gsm)  
Coated Thick  
(164 to 216  
gsm)  
Displays the temperature setting of the fuser (from -6 to 6) for thick coated paper.  
Envelope  
Recycled  
Displays the temperature setting of the fuser (from -6 to 6) for envelopes.  
Displays the temperature setting of the fuser (from -6 to 6) for recycled paper.  
Displays whether to automatically perform color registration adjustment.  
Displays the altitude of where the printer is located.  
Auto Registration Adjustment  
Adjust Altitude  
Non-Dell Toner  
Displays whether or not to use another manufacturer's toner cartridge.  
Displays the default date format.  
Date Format  
Time Format  
Displays the default time format; 12 Hour Clock or 24 Hour Clock.  
Displays the default time zone.  
Clock Settings Time Zone  
Set Date  
Displays the date setting.  
Set Time  
Displays the time setting.  
Select Reorder Displays a link used for ordering consumables, which can be accessed from Order  
URL  
Supplies at: in the Left Frame.  
Web Link  
Customization  
Displays the regular URL (http://accessories.us.dell.com/sna) that can be  
linked to Order Supplies at:.  
Regular  
Displays the premier URL (http://premier.dell.com) that can be linked to Order  
Supplies at:.  
Premier  
ColorTrack  
Mode  
Displays whether to enable the ColorTrack.  
Dell  
ColorTrack  
No Account  
User Print  
Displays whether to permit the printing of data with no authentication information.  
Displays whether to print the error report on the ColorTrack mode.  
Displays the paper type setting of the first tray from the top.  
Displays the paper size setting of the first tray from the top.  
ColorTrack  
Error Report  
Tray 1 Paper  
Type  
Tray 1 Paper  
Size  
Tray 1 Custom  
Size - Y  
Displays the length of custom size paper loaded in the first tray from the top.  
Displays the width of custom size paper loaded in the first tray from the top.  
Tray 1 Custom  
Size - X  
Tray 2 Paper  
Displays the paper type setting of the second tray from the top.  
5
Type*  
Tray 2 Paper  
Displays the paper size setting of the second tray from the top.  
5
Size*  
Tray 2 Custom  
Displays the length of custom size paper loaded in the second tray from the top.  
Displays the width of custom size paper loaded in the second tray from the top.  
Displays the paper type setting of the third tray from the top.  
5
Size - Y*  
Tray 2 Custom  
5
Size - X*  
Tray Settings  
Tray 3 Paper  
5
Type*  
Tray 3 Paper  
Displays the paper size setting of the third tray from the top.  
5
Size*  
Tray 3 Custom  
Displays the length of custom size paper loaded in the third tray from the top.  
Displays the width of custom size paper loaded in the third tray from the top.  
Displays the paper type setting of the fourth tray from the top.  
5
Size - Y*  
Tray 3 Custom  
5
Size - X*  
Tray 4 Paper  
6
Type*  
Tray 4 Paper  
Displays the paper size setting of the fourth tray from the top.  
6
Size*  
Tray 4 Custom  
Displays the length of custom size paper loaded in the fourth tray from the top.  
Displays the width of custom size paper loaded in the fourth tray from the top.  
6
Size - Y*  
Tray 4 Custom  
6
Size - X*  
Tray 5 Paper  
Displays the paper type setting of the fifth tray from the top.  
6
Type*  
Tray 5 Paper  
Displays the paper size setting of the fifth tray from the top.  
6
Size*  
Tray 5 Custom  
Displays the length of custom size paper loaded in the fifth tray from the top.  
Displays the width of custom size paper loaded in the fifth tray from the top.  
6
Size - Y*  
Tray 5 Custom  
6
Size - X*  
Displays the paper size and type when paper is loaded in the multipurpose feeder  
(MPF).  
MPF Mode  
Tray Settings  
Display  
Displays a popup menu that prompts to set the paper size and type when paper is  
loaded in the MPF.  
7
Popup*  
MPF Paper  
Displays the paper type setting of the MPF.  
7
Type*  
MPF Paper  
Displays the paper size setting of the MPF.  
7
Size*  
MPF Custom  
Displays the length of custom size paper loaded in the MPF.  
Displays the width of custom size paper loaded in the MPF.  
7
Size - Y*  
MPF Custom  
7
Size - X*  
1
* This item is available only when the optional memory module is installed, and also when the optional hard disk is not  
installed.  
2
* This item is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
3
* This item is available only when the optional hard disk is installed.  
4
* This item is available only when the RAM disk is on or the optional hard disk is installed.  
5
* This item is available only when the optional 550-sheet feeder or 1100-sheet feeder is installed.  
6
* This item is available only when the optional 1100-sheet feeder is installed.  
7
* This item is displayed only when Panel Specified is selected for MPF Mode.  
Reports  
Purpose:  
To print various types of reports and lists.  
Values:  
Printer Settings  
Panel Settings  
PCL Fonts List  
PCL Macro List  
Job History  
Click the Start button to print the printer settings page.  
Click the Start button to print the panel settings page.  
Click the Start button to print the PCL (Hewlett-Packard Printer Control Language) Fonts List.  
Click the Start button to print the PCL Macro List.  
Click the Start button to print the Job History report.  
Click the Start button to print the Error History report.  
Click the Start button to print the PS Fonts List.  
Error History  
PS Fonts List  
Print Meter  
Click the Start button to print the Print Meter report.  
Click the Start button to print the Color Test Page.  
Color Test Page  
1
Click the Start button to print the Stored Document list.  
Stored Document*  
 
1
* This item is available only when the RAM disk is on or the optional hard disk is installed.  
Printer Settings  
The Printer Settings tab includes System Settings, Parallel Settings, Network Settings, USB Settings, PCL  
Settings, PS Settings, and Secure Settings pages.  
System Settings  
Purpose:  
To configure the basic printer settings.  
Values:  
Power Saver  
Time-Sleep  
Sets the time for transition to the power saver mode (Sleep).  
Power Saver  
Time-Deep Sleep  
Sets the time for transition to the power saver mode (Deep Sleep).  
Control Panel  
Tone  
Specifies whether to enable the tone that is emitted when the operator panel input is correct.  
Invalid Key Tone  
Specifies whether to enable the tone that is emitted when the operator panel input is incorrect.  
Specifies whether to enable the tone that is emitted when the printer becomes ready.  
Machine Ready  
Tone  
Job Completed  
Tone  
Specifies whether to enable the tone that is emitted when a print job is complete.  
Fault Tone  
Alert Tone  
Specifies whether to enable the tone that is emitted when a job ends abnormally.  
Specifies whether to enable the tone that is emitted when a problem occurs.  
Out of Paper  
Alert Tone  
Specifies whether to enable the tone that is emitted when the printer runs out of paper.  
Low Toner Alert  
Tone  
Specifies whether to enable the tone that is emitted when toner or some other consumable is low.  
Specifies whether to enable the tone that is emitted when the operator panel screen returns to the  
default by scrolling the loop menu.  
Base Tone  
Specifies in seconds the amount of time the printer should cancel for a job stops abnormally. The  
print job is cancelled if the time-out time is exceeded.  
Fault Time-Out  
Job Time-Out  
Specifies in seconds the amount of time the printer should wait for data to arrive from the  
computer. The print job is cancelled if the time-out time is exceeded.  
Panel Language  
Auto Log Print  
Print ID  
Sets the language to be used on the operator panel.  
Specifies whether to automatically print a log of completed jobs after every 20 jobs.  
Specifies where to print the user ID on the output paper.  
Specifies whether the printer outputs PDL data, which is not supported by the printer, as text  
when the printer receives it.  
Print Text  
Banner Sheet  
Insert Position  
Specifies where to insert a banner sheet.  
Banner Sheet  
Specify Tray  
Specifies which input tray to use to insert a banner sheet.  
Specifies the amount of memory allocated for the file system, Secure Print and Proof Print  
features.  
1
RAM Disk*  
Specifies whether or not to use another size paper when the paper that is loaded in the specified  
tray does not match the paper size settings for the current job.  
Substitute Tray  
mm / inch  
Letterhead  
Specifies the measurement unit to be used on the operator panel screen as either mm or inches.  
Specifies that duplex printing is selected for two-sided letterhead media.  
   
Duplex Mode  
Low Toner Alert  
Msg  
Specifies whether to show the message when the toner is short.  
Specifies whether to offset the position of the output paper.  
2
Job Offset*  
Banner Sheet  
Specifies whether to put the banner sheet per offset print.  
Specifies whether to staple the offset print.  
2
Offset*  
Job Offset of  
2
Staple*  
Stapler Cart.  
Specifies whether to continue the print job when the stapler cartridge is empty.  
2
Empty*  
1
* This item is available only when the optional memory module is installed, and also when the optional hard disk is not  
installed.  
2
* This item is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
Parallel Settings  
Purpose:  
To configure the parallel interface.  
Values:  
Parallel Port  
ECP  
Specifies whether to enable the parallel interface.  
Specifies whether to enable the ECP communication mode of the parallel interface.  
Adobe Protocol Specifies PostScript communication protocol for each interface.  
Network Settings  
Purpose:  
To Specify the PostScript communication protocol for this printer.  
Values:  
Adobe Protocol Specifies PostScript communication protocol for each interface.  
USB Settings  
Purpose:  
To change printer settings affecting a USB port.  
Values:  
USB Port  
Specifies whether to enable the USB interface.  
Adobe Protocol Specifies PostScript communication protocol for each interface.  
PCL Settings  
Purpose:  
To change the printer settings that only affect jobs using the PCL emulation printer language.  
Values:  
       
Paper Tray  
Paper Size  
Specifies the input tray.  
Specifies the paper size.  
Custom Size  
- Y  
Specifies the length of custom size paper.  
Custom Size  
- X  
Specifies the width of custom size paper.  
Orientation  
2 Sided  
Specifies how text and graphics are oriented on the page.  
Sets duplexing as the default for all print jobs. This item is available only when the duplexer is  
installed.  
Font  
Specifies the font from the list of registered fonts.  
Specifies a symbol set for the specified font.  
Specifies the font size for scalable typographic fonts.  
Specifies the font pitch for scalable monospaced fonts.  
Specifies the number of characters in a line.  
Sets the number of copies to print.  
Symbol Set  
Font Size  
Font Pitch  
Form Line  
Quantity  
Image  
Enhancement  
Specifies whether to enable the Image Enhancement feature.  
Specifies whether to help isolate the source of a print job problem. With Hex Dump selected, all data  
sent to the printer is printed in hexadecimal and character representation. Control codes are not  
executed.  
Hex Dump  
Draft Mode  
Specifies whether to print in the draft mode.  
Specifies how to handle line terminations.  
Line  
Termination  
Specifies the print color mode to Color or Black. This setting is used for print jobs without a specified  
color print mode.  
Default Color  
PS Settings  
Purpose:  
To change printer settings that only affect jobs using the PostScript emulation printer language.  
Values:  
PS Error Report  
PS Job Time-Out  
Specifies whether the printer outputs error contents for a PostScript error.  
Specifies the execution time for one PostScript job.  
Paper Select Mode Specifies the way to select the tray for the PostScript mode.  
Default Color  
Specifies the default color mode for the PostScript mode.  
Secure Settings  
Panel Lock  
Purpose:  
To set whether to lock Admin Menuwith a password, and to set or change the password.  
Values:  
Panel Lock Set  
Sets whether to lock Admin Menuwith a password.  
Sets a password that is required to access Admin Menu.  
Enter the new password again to confirm.  
New Password  
Re-enter Password  
Login Error - Attempts Sets the maximum number that the administrator fails to log in.  
 
NOTE: This menu sets a password to lock the operator panel. When changing the password for the Dell Printer  
Configuration Web Tool, click Set Password on the Left Frame and set the password.  
Data Encryption  
Purpose:  
To set whether to encrypt the data.  
Values:  
Encryption  
Sets whether to encrypt the data.  
Data Encryption Encryption Key  
Sets a key that is required to encrypt.  
Re-enter Encryption Key Enter the new key again to confirm.  
NOTE: You can enter only characters from 0 to 9, a to z, A to Z, and NULL values for encryption key.  
Set Available Time  
Purpose:  
To set the time to enable the secure setting.  
Values:  
Set Available Time Specifies whether to set the time period when printing is available.  
Start Time  
End Time  
Specifies the start time of the time period when printing is available.  
Specifies the end time of the time period when printing is available.  
Specifies the day of the week to repeat the setting.  
Recurrence  
HDD Overwrite Mode  
Purpose:  
To set whether to overwrite the hard disk drive.  
Values:  
HDD Overwrite Mode Sets whether to overwrite the hard disk drive.  
Secure Job Expiration  
Purpose:  
To set the date and time to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk drive.  
Values:  
Expiration  
Mode  
Sets whether to set the date to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard  
disk drive.  
Expiration  
Time  
Sets the time to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk drive.  
Sets the period to repeat the setting.  
Recurrence  
Weekly  
Settings  
Sets the day of the week to repeat the setting.  
Monthly  
Settings  
Sets the day of the month to repeat the setting.  
Printer Maintenance  
The Printer Maintenance tab includes Paper Density, Adjust BTR, Adjust Fuser, Auto Registration Adjustment,  
Color Registration Adjustments, Adjust Altitude, Reset Defaults, Storage, Non-Dell Toner, Initialize  
 
PrintMeter, Clock Settings, and Web Link Customization pages.  
Paper Density  
Purpose:  
To specify the paper density.  
Values:  
Plain Sets the density of plain paper to Light or Normal.  
Label Sets the density of labels to Light or Normal.  
Adjust BTR  
Purpose:  
To specify the optimum voltage settings for printing for the transfer roller (BTR). To lower the voltage, set negative  
values. To increase, set positive values.  
The default settings may not give the best output on all paper types. If you see mottles on the print output, try to  
increase the voltage. If you see white spots on the print output, try to decrease the voltage.  
NOTICE: The print quality changes depending on the setting values you select for this item.  
Values:  
Plain  
(60 to 90 gsm)  
Sets the reference voltage setting for the transfer roller for plain paper within the range of -6 to  
6.  
Plain Thick  
(80/90 to 105  
gsm)  
Sets the reference voltage setting for the transfer roller for thick plain paper within the range of -  
6 to 6.  
Sets the reference voltage setting for the transfer roller for transparencies within the range of -6  
to 6.  
Transparency  
Covers  
Sets the reference voltage setting for the transfer roller for cover paper within the range of -6 to  
(106 to 163 gsm) 6.  
Covers Thick  
Sets the reference voltage setting for the transfer roller for thick cover paper within the range of -  
(164 to 216 gsm) 6 to 6.  
Label  
Sets the reference voltage setting for the transfer roller for labels within the range of -6 to 6.  
Sets the reference voltage setting for the transfer roller for coated paper within the range of -6 to  
Coated  
(106 to 163 gsm) 6.  
Coated Thick  
Sets the reference voltage setting for the transfer roller for thick coated paper within the range of  
(164 to 216 gsm) -6 to 6.  
Envelope  
Recycled  
Sets the reference voltage setting for the transfer roller for envelopes within the range of -6 to 6.  
Sets the reference voltage setting for the transfer roller for recycled paper within the range of -6  
to 6.  
Adjust Fuser  
Purpose:  
To specify the optimum temperature settings for printing for the fuser. To lower the temperature, set negative values. To  
increase, set positive values.  
The default settings may not give the best output on all paper types. When the printed paper has curled, try to lower the  
temperature. When the toner does not fuse on the paper properly, try to increase the temperature.  
NOTE: The print quality changes depending on the setting values you select for this item.  
     
Values:  
Plain  
(60 to 90 gsm)  
Sets the temperature settings for the fuser for plain paper within the range of -6 to 6.  
Plain Thick  
(80/90 to 105 gsm)  
Sets the temperature settings for the fuser for thick plain paper within the range of -6 to 6.  
Sets the temperature settings for the fuser for transparencies within the range of -6 to 6.  
Sets the temperature settings for the fuser for cover paper within the range of -6 to 6.  
Transparency  
Covers  
(106 to 163 gsm)  
Covers Thick  
(164 to 216 gsm)  
Sets the temperature settings for the fuser for thick cover paper within the range of -6 to 6.  
Sets the temperature settings for the fuser for labels within the range of -6 to 6.  
Sets the temperature settings for the fuser for coated paper within the range of -6 to 6.  
Label  
Coated  
(106 to 163 gsm)  
Coated Thick  
(164 to 216 gsm)  
Sets the temperature settings for the fuser for thick coated paper within the range of -6 to 6.  
Envelope  
Recycled  
Sets the temperature settings for the fuser for envelopes within the range of -6 to 6.  
Sets the temperature settings for the fuser for recycled paper within the range of -6 to 6.  
Auto Registration Adjustment  
Purpose:  
To specify whether to automatically perform color registration adjustment.  
Color Registration Adjustments  
Purpose:  
To specify whether to manually perform color registration adjustment.  
Manual Color Registration Adjustments are required such as when the printer is initially installed and after the printer is  
moved.  
NOTE: The Color Registration Adjustments feature can be configured when Auto Registration Adjustment is  
set to Off.  
Values:  
Auto  
Correct  
Click Start to Automatically performs color registration correction.  
Click Start to print a color registration chart. The color registration chart prints a lattice pattern of yellow,  
Color  
Regi  
Chart  
magenta, and cyan lines. On the chart, find the values on the right side that are next to the straightest lines  
for each of the three colors. If the value for the straightest line is 0, color registration adjustment is not  
required. If the value for the straightest line is any value other than 0, specify the adjustment values under  
Color Registration Adjustments.  
Enter  
Specifies lateral (perpendicular to paper feed direction) color adjustment values individually for LeftYellow,  
Number LeftMagenta, LeftCyan, RightYellow, RightMagenta and RightCyan.  
Adjust Altitude  
Purpose:  
To specify the altitude of where the printer is located because it affects print quality.  
The discharge phenomenon for charging the photo conductor varies with barometric pressure. Adjustments are performed  
by specifying the altitude of the location where the printer is being used.  
       
Reset Defaults  
Purpose:  
To initialize the NV (non-volatile) memory. After executing this function to automatically restart the printer and rebooting  
the printer, all the menu parameters are reset to their default values.  
Values:  
Reset Defaults and restart printer Click Start to reset the default setting and restart the printer.  
Power On Wizard  
Click Start to start the power on wizard and perform initial setup.  
Storage  
Purpose:  
To clear all files stored in the RAM disk or the optional hard disk, or format the optional hard disk.  
Values:  
Click Start to clear all files that are stored as Secure Print and Proof Print in the RAM disk  
or the optional hard disk.  
All Clear  
Clear  
Secure  
Document  
Click Start to clear all files that are stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the optional  
hard disk.  
1
Storage*  
Stored  
Document  
Click Start to clear all files that are stored in the RAM disk or the optional hard disk.  
Format  
Click Start to format the optional hard disk. All fonts, forms and files for Secure Print and Proof Print  
stored in the optional hard disk are cleared.  
2
HDD*  
1
* This item is available only when the RAM disk is on or the optional hard disk is installed.  
2
* This item is available only when the optional hard disk is installed.  
Non-Dell Toner  
Purpose:  
To specify whether or not to use another manufacturer's tone cartridge.  
NOTE: Before you use another manufacture's toner cartridge, be sure to restart the printer.  
NOTICE: Use of a non-Dell toner cartridge may result in some of the printer's functions to be unavailable, a  
reduction in print quality, or deterioration of printer's reliability. Use of a new Dell brand toner cartridge is  
recommended for your printer. The Dell warranty does not cover any problems caused by the use of any accessory,  
part, or component that is not supplied by Dell.  
Initialize PrintMeter  
Purpose:  
To initialize the print meter of the printer. When the print meter is initialized, the meter count is reset to 0.  
Clock Settings  
To specify the clock settings.  
Values:  
Date Format Specifies the date format; yy/mm/dd, mm/dd/yy, or dd/mm/yy.  
Time Format Specifies the time format; 12 Hour Clock or 24 Hour Clock.  
       
Time Zone  
Set Date  
Set Time  
Specifies the time zone.  
Specifies the current date.  
Specifies the current time.  
Web Link Customization  
Purpose:  
To specify a link used for ordering consumables, which can be accessed from Order Supplies at: in the Left Frame.  
Values:  
Select Reorder  
URL  
Select the Regular or Premier URL to be linked to Order Supplies at:.  
Displays the regular URL (http://accessories.us.dell.com/sna) that can be linked to Order  
Supplies at:.  
Regular  
Premier  
Displays the premier URL (http://premier.dell.com) that can be linked to Order Supplies at:.  
Print Server Settings  
Use the Print Server Settings menu to set the type of printer interface and necessary conditions for communications.  
The following tabbed pages are displayed in the top of the Right Frame.  
Print Server Reports  
The Print Server Reports tab includes Print Server Setup Page, NetWare Setup Page, and E-Mail Alert Setup  
Page.  
Print Server Setup Page  
Purpose:  
To verify the current settings of TCP/IP (Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol) and printing ports. On this page,  
you can only verify the settings of items. If you want to change the settings, go to the pages in the Print Server  
Settings tab.  
Values:  
Displays the current settings of Ethernet transmission rate and the duplex  
settings.  
Ethernet Settings  
1
Current Ethernet  
Settings  
Ethernet*  
Displays the current Ethernet settings.  
MAC Address  
SSID  
Displays the printer's MAC address.  
Displays the name that identifies the network.  
Displays the network type from either the Ad-Hoc or Infrastructure mode.  
Displays the MAC address of the wireless adapter.  
Displays the channel number of the connection.  
Displays the quality of the connection.  
Network Type  
MAC Address  
Link Channel  
Link Quality  
IP Mode  
Wireless  
2
Settings*  
Displays the IP mode.  
Host Name  
Displays the host name.  
IP Address Mode Displays the IP address mode.  
IP Address  
Displays the IP address.  
       
3
IPv4*  
Subnet Mask  
Displays the subnet mask.  
Gateway  
Address  
Displays the gateway address.  
Enable Stateless  
Address  
Displays whether to enable the stateless address.  
Displays whether to set the IP address manually.  
Use Manual  
Address  
TCP/IP  
Settings  
Manual  
Displays the IP address.  
5
Address*  
Stateless  
Displays the stateless addresses.  
Displays the link local address.  
Displays the gateway address.  
6
4
Address 1-3*  
IPv6*  
Link Local  
6
Address*  
Manual Gateway  
5
Address*  
Auto Configure  
Gateway  
Displays the gateway address.  
6
Address*  
Get DNS Server  
Address from  
DHCP  
Displays whether to automatically get a DNS (Domain Name  
System) server address from the DHCP (Dynamic Host  
Configuration Protocol) server.  
3
4
IPv4*  
Current DNS  
Server Address  
Displays the DNS server address.  
Get DNS Server  
Address from  
DHCPv6-lite  
Displays whether to automatically get a DNS server address  
from the DHCPv6-lite server.  
IPv6*  
Current DNS  
Server Address  
Displays the DNS server address.  
DNS Dynamic  
Update (IPv4)  
Displays the status of the DNS Dynamic Update feature.  
Displays the status of the DNS Dynamic Update feature.  
Displays whether to automatically generate a search list.  
DNS  
DNS Dynamic  
Update (IPv6)  
Auto Generate  
Search List  
Search Domain  
Name  
Displays the search domain name.  
Displays the time-out period.  
Time-out  
Priority to IPv6  
DNS Name  
Displays whether to use the DNS Name Resolution feature.  
7
Resolution*  
Port Status  
Displays the port status.  
LPD  
Connection Time-  
Out  
Displays the connection time-out period.  
Port Status  
Displays the port status.  
Displays the port number.  
Port Number  
Port9100  
Connection Time-  
Out  
Displays the connection time-out period.  
Port Status  
Printer URI  
Displays the port status.  
Displays the printer URI.  
Connection Time-  
Out  
Displays the connection time-out period.  
Displays the port number.  
IPP  
Port Number  
Maximum  
Sessions  
Displays the maximum number of connections received simultaneously by the  
client.  
Port Status  
Displays the WSD port status.  
Displays the WSD port number.  
Port Number  
Receive Time-  
Out  
Displays the receive time-out period.  
Displays the notification time-out period.  
Displays the maximum number of TTLs.  
Notification  
Time-Out  
WSD  
Maximum  
Number of TTL  
Maximum  
Number of  
Notification  
Displays the maximum number of notifications.  
Port Status  
Displays the port status.  
FTP  
Connection Time-  
Out  
Displays the connection time-out period.  
Port Status  
Displays the port status.  
Displays the port number.  
Port Number  
Simultaneous  
Connections  
HTTP  
Displays the number of connections received simultaneously by the client.  
Displays the connection time-out period.  
Connection Time-  
Out  
Port Status  
Host Name  
Printer Name  
Port Status  
Displays the port status.  
Displays the host name.  
Displays the printer name.  
Displays the port status.  
Bonjour  
(mDNS)  
Telnet  
SNMP  
Connection Time-  
Out  
Displays the connection time-out period.  
Displays the port status.  
Port Status  
Enable SNMP  
v1/v2c Protocol  
Displays the status of the SNMP v1/v2c feature.  
Enable SNMP v3  
Protocol  
Displays the status of the SNMP v3 feature.  
Displays the authentication method.  
Authentication Authentication  
System  
System Settings  
HTTP-SSL/TLS  
Communication  
Displays the status of the HTTP - SSL/TLS Communication.  
HTTP-SSL/TLS  
Communication  
Port Number  
Displays HTTP - SSL/TLS Communication Port Number.  
SSL/TLS  
LDAP-SSL/TLS  
Displays the status of the LDAP - SSL/TLS Communication.  
8
Communication*  
Verify Remote  
Server  
Displays the status of the Verify Remote Server Certificate.  
8
Certificate*  
Protocol  
IKE  
Displays the protocol status.  
Displays IKE authentication.  
IPsec Settings  
Enable IEEE  
802.1x  
Displays the status of IEEE 802.1x.  
1
802.1x*  
Authentication  
Method  
Displays the setting of authentication method for IEEE 802.1x.  
Displays the list of IP addresses that are permitted or denied access to the  
Address  
printer.  
IP Filter  
Displays the list of subnet mask that are permitted or denied access to the  
printer.  
9
Address Mask  
Active Mode  
(IPv4)*  
Displays whether to be permitted or denied access to the printer.  
1
* This item is available only when connecting the printer with a wired network.  
2
* This item is available only when connecting the printer with a wireless network.  
3
* This item is displayed when IPv4 Mode is selected.  
4
* This item is displayed when IPv6 Mode is selected.  
5
* This item is displayed only when Use Manual Address is Enable.  
6
* This item is displayed only when an IP address has been assigned.  
7
* This item is available only when using IPv6 dual mode.  
8
* This item is displayed only when the optional hard disk is installed and is set to On for encryption.  
9
* This item is only available for LPD or Port9100.  
NetWare Setup Page  
Purpose:  
To verify the current settings of NetWare. In this page, you can only verify the settings of items. If you want to change  
the settings, go to the pages in the Print Server Settings tab.  
Values:  
Displays the port status. When NetWare is implemented, the status of TCP/IP is also  
displayed.  
Port Status  
Device Name  
Active Mode  
Tree Name  
Displays the printer name.  
Displays the current mode for Active Mode.  
Displays the tree name.  
NetWare  
Context Name  
Displays the context name of the Print Server Object.  
Displays the time interval from when print data enters the print queue until printing  
starts.  
Polling Interval  
Status  
Information  
Displays messages according to the conditions of the printer.  
SLP  
Active Discovery Displays whether active discovery is enabled.  
E-Mail Alert Setup Page  
Purpose:  
To verify the current settings of SMTP/POP (Simple Mail Transfer Protocol/Post Office Protocol) used for the e-mail feature  
and E-Mail Alerts feature. In this page, you can only verify the settings of items. If you want to change the settings, go to  
the pages in the Print Server Settings tab.  
Values:  
Port Status  
Displays the port status.  
Primary SMTP  
Gateway  
Displays the primary SMTP (Simple Mail Transfer Protocol) gateway.  
SMTP Port Number Displays the SMTP port number.  
E-Mail Send  
   
Displays the authentication method for outgoing e-mail.  
Displays the POP3 (Post Office Protocol 3) server address.  
Authentication  
E-Mail Server  
Settings  
POP3 Server  
Address  
POP3 Port Number Displays the POP3 port number.  
Reply Address  
Designates the reply e-mail address sent with each E-mail Alert.  
SMTP Server  
Connection  
Displays the status of the SMTP server connection.  
Displays the acceptable e-mail addresses for the E-Mail Alert feature  
specified in E-mail List 1.  
E-Mail List 1  
Displays the status, and whether to receive an E-Mail  
Alert, for consumables.  
Supplies Alerts  
Select Alerts for  
List 1  
Paper Handling Displays the status, and whether to receive an E-Mail  
Alerts  
Alert, for paper handling.  
Displays the status, and whether to receive an E-Mail  
Alert, for Service Calls.  
Service Call  
E-Mail Alert  
Settings  
Displays the acceptable e-mail addresses for the E-Mail Alert feature  
specified in E-mail List 2.  
E-Mail List 2  
Displays the status, and whether to receive an E-Mail  
Alert, for consumables.  
Supplies Alerts  
Select Alerts for  
List 2  
Paper Handling Displays the status, and whether to receive an E-Mail  
Alerts  
Alert, for paper handling.  
Displays the status, and whether to receive an E-Mail  
Alert, for Service Calls.  
Service Call  
Print Server Settings  
The Print Server Settings tab includes Basic Information, Port Settings, TCP/IP, NetWare, E-Mail Alert,  
Bonjour(mDNS), SNMP, Wireless LAN, and Reset Print Server pages.  
Basic Information  
Purpose:  
To configure the printer's basic information.  
Values:  
Printer Name  
Location  
Specifies the name of the printer using up to 31 alphanumeric characters.  
Specifies the location of the printer using up to 63 alphanumeric characters.  
Specifies the contact name, number, and other information of the printer's administrator  
and service center using up to 63 alphanumeric characters.  
Contact Person  
System  
Settings  
Administrator E- Specifies the contact address of the printer's administrator and service center using up  
Mail Address  
to 64 alphanumeric characters.  
Asset Tag  
Number  
Enter the asset tag number for the printer.  
Auto Refresh  
Sets whether or not to automatically refresh the contents of the status display pages.  
EWS  
Settings  
Auto Refresh  
Interval  
Sets the time interval for refreshing the contents of the status display pages  
automatically from 15 to 600 seconds.  
NOTE: The Auto Refresh feature is effective for the contents of the Top Frame, Printer Status page, Job List  
page, and Completed Jobs page.  
Port Settings  
     
Purpose:  
To specify whether to enable or disable printing ports and management protocol features.  
Values:  
Detects Ethernet transmission rate and the duplex settings  
automatically.  
Auto  
10Base-T  
Half-Duplex  
Selects 10Base-T Half-Duplex as the default value.  
10Base-T  
Full-Duplex  
Selects 10Base-T Full-Duplex as the default value.  
Selects 100Base-TX Half-Duplex as the default value.  
Selects 100Base-TX Full-Duplex as the default value.  
Ethernet  
Settings  
100Base-TX Half-  
Duplex  
1
Ethernet*  
100Base-TX Full-  
Duplex  
1000Base-T Full-  
Duplex  
Selects 1000Base-T Full-Duplex as the default value.  
Displays the current settings of Ethernet.  
Current Ethernet Settings  
MAC  
Displays the printer's MAC address.  
Address  
LPD  
Select the check box to enable LPD.  
Port9100 Select the check box to enable Port9100.  
IPP  
Select the check box to enable the IPP port.  
Select the check box to enable the WSD port.  
Select the check box to enable FTP.  
WSD  
FTP  
Select the check box to enable the NetWare port. You can also configure the transport protocol  
to be used. TCP/IP can be selected simultaneously as the transport protocol.  
NetWare  
Port  
Status  
Bonjour  
(mDNS)  
Select the check box to enable the Bonjour(mDNS) feature.  
E-Mail  
Alert  
Select the check box to enable the E-Mail Alert feature.  
Telnet  
Select the check box to enable Telnet.  
Select the check box to enable the SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol).  
You can also configure the transport protocol to be used. UDP and IPX can be selected  
simultaneously as the transport protocol.  
SNMP  
1
* This item is available only when connecting the printer with a wired network.  
NOTE: The settings in the Port Settings page will be valid only when the printer is rebooted. When you change or  
configure the settings, click the Apply New settings button to apply new settings.  
TCP/IP  
Purpose:  
To configure the IP address, subnet mask, and gateway address of the printer.  
Values:  
IP Mode  
Specifies the IP mode.  
Specifies the host name.  
Host Name  
IP Address Mode  
Selects the IP address mode.  
Manual IP  
Address  
Sets the IP address.  
IPv4  
Manual Subnet  
Sets the subnet mask.  
 
Mask  
Manual Gateway  
Address  
Sets the gateway address.  
TCP/IP  
Settings  
Enable Stateless  
Address  
Select the check box to enable the slateless address.  
Select the check box to set the IP address manually.  
Use Manual  
Address  
IPv6  
Sets the IP address. To specify an IPv6 address, enter the address  
followed by a slash (/) and then "64". For details, consult your  
system administrator.  
Manual Address  
Manual Gateway  
Address  
Sets the gateway address.  
Specifies the domain name of the domain name server. Up to 255 alphanumeric  
characters, periods, and hyphens can be used. If you need to specify more than one  
domain name, separate them using a comma or semicolon.  
DNS Domain  
Name  
Get DNS Server  
Address from  
from the DHCP server.  
DHCP  
Select the check box to get the DNS server address automatically  
IPv4  
IPv6  
Manual DNS  
Sets the DNS server address.  
Server Address  
Get DNS Server  
Select the check box to get the DNS server address automatically  
Address from  
from the DHCPv6-lite server.  
DHCPv6-lite  
Manual DNS  
Sets the DNS server address.  
Server Address  
DNS  
DNS Dynamic  
Update (IPv4)  
Select the check box to enable dynamic updates to DNS.  
Select the check box to enable dynamic updates to DNS.  
Select the check box to automatically generate the search list.  
DNS Dynamic  
Update (IPv6)  
Auto Generate  
Search List  
Specifies the search domain name. Up to 255 alphanumeric characters, periods, and  
hyphens can be used. If you need to specify more than one domain name, separate them  
using a comma or semicolon.  
Search  
Domain Name  
Time-out  
Specifies the time-out period between 1 and 60 seconds.  
Priority to  
IPv6 DNS  
Name  
Select the check box to enable the DNS Name Resolution feature.  
Resolution  
Connection  
Time-Out  
Sets the connection time-out period from 1 to 1000 seconds.  
LPD  
IP Filter  
(IPv4)  
To set the IP Filter settings, click IP Filter (IPv4). The IP Filter (IPv4) page is displayed.  
Sets the port number from 9000 to 9999.  
Port Number  
Connection  
Sets the connection time-out period between 1 and 1000 seconds.  
Port9100 Time-Out  
IP Filter  
(IPv4)  
To set the IP Filter settings, click IP Filter (IPv4). The IP Filter (IPv4) page is displayed.  
Displays the printer URI.  
Printer URI  
Connection  
Sets the connection time-out period from 1 to 1000 seconds.  
Displays the port number for receiving requests from the client.  
Displays the maximum number of connections received simultaneously by the client.  
Sets the port number to 80 or from 8000 to 9999.  
Time-Out  
IPP  
Port Number  
Maximum  
Sessions  
Port Number  
Receive  
Time-Out  
Sets the receive time-out period from 1 to 65,535 seconds.  
Sets the notification time-out period from 1 to 60 seconds.  
Notification  
Time-Out  
WSD  
Maximum  
Number of  
TTL  
Sets the maximum number of TTL from 1 to 10.  
Maximum  
Number of  
Notification  
Sets the maximum number of notifications from 10 to 20.  
Password  
Sets the password for FTP.  
Re-enter  
Password  
Enter the password again to confirm it.  
FTP  
Connection  
Time-Out  
Sets the connection time-out period from 1 to 1000 seconds.  
Sets the port number to 80 or from 8000 to 9999.  
Port Number  
Simultaneous  
Connections  
Displays the maximum number of connections received simultaneously by the client.  
HTTP  
Telnet  
Connection  
Time-Out  
Sets the connection time-out period from 1 to 255 seconds.  
Sets the password for Telnet.  
Password  
Re-enter  
Password  
Enter the password again to confirm it.  
Connection  
Time-Out  
Sets the connection time-out period from 1 to 1000 seconds.  
NetWare  
Purpose:  
To configure detailed settings for NetWare.  
Values:  
Specifies the printer name up to 47 alphanumeric characters.  
For PServer Mode, set the Print Server Name (Print Server Object Name). The original setting  
remains valid if no input is made.  
Device  
Name  
Directory: PServer Mode Selects this option when using in Directory: PServer Mode.  
Active Mode  
Tree Name  
Bindery: PServer Mode  
Selects this option when using in Bindery: PServer Mode.  
Specifies the tree name up to 32 alphanumeric characters. Configure this item only when  
Directory: PServer Mode is selected.  
Context  
Name  
Specifies the context name of the Print Server Object up to 255 alphanumeric characters.  
Configure this item only when Directory: PServer Mode is selected.  
NetWare  
Sets the time interval from when print data enters the print queue until printing starts. The  
setting range is from 1 to 1000 seconds. The original setting remains valid if no input is  
made. Configure this item only when Bindery: PServer Mode or Directory: PServer Mode  
is selected.  
Polling  
Interval  
Sets the print server password up to 32 alphanumeric characters. Configure this item only  
when Bindery: PServer Mode or Directory: PServer Mode is selected.  
Password  
Re-enter  
Password  
Enter the password again.  
Status  
Information  
Displays the status of NetWare.  
Active  
Discovery  
SLP  
Select the check box to enable Active Discovery.  
 
NOTE: The settings in the NetWare page will be valid only when NetWare or the printer is rebooted. Click the  
Apply New settings button to apply new settings.  
E-Mail Alert  
Purpose:  
To configure detailed settings for E-Mail Alert. This page can also be displayed by clicking E-Mail Alert in the Left Frame.  
Values:  
Primary SMTP  
Sets the primary SMTP gateway.  
Gateway  
SMTP Port  
Number  
Specifies the SMTP port number. This must be 25, 587 or between 5,000 and 65,535.  
E-Mail Send  
Authentication  
Specifies the authentication method for outgoing e-mail.  
Specifies the SMTP login user. Up to 63 alphanumeric characters, periods, hyphens, under  
bars, and at symbols (@) can be used. If specifying more than one address, separate  
them using commas.  
SMTP Login  
User  
SMTP Login  
Password  
Specifies the SMTP account password using up to 31 alphanumeric characters.  
Re-enter  
SMTP Login  
Password  
Enter the SMTP account password again to confirm it.  
E-Mail  
Server  
Settings  
POP3 Server  
Specifies the POP3 server address in IP address format of "aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd" or as a DNS  
host name using up to 63 characters.  
1
Address*  
POP3 Port  
Specifies the POP3 server port number. This must be 110 or between 5,000 and 65,535.  
Specifies the POP3 account user name.  
1
Number*  
POP User  
1
Up to 63 alphanumeric characters, periods, hyphens, under bars, and at symbols (@) can  
be used. If specifying more than one address, separate them using commas.  
Name*  
POP User  
Specifies the POP3 account password using up to 31 alphanumeric characters.  
Enter the POP3 account password again to confirm it.  
1
Password*  
Re-enter POP  
User  
1
Password*  
Reply Address Designates the reply e-mail address sent with each E-mail Alert.  
SMTP Server  
Connection  
Displays the status of the SMTP server connection.  
Sets acceptable e-mail addresses for the E-Mail Alert feature using up to 255  
alphanumeric characters.  
E-Mail List 1  
Supplies Alerts  
Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for consumables.  
Select Alerts  
for List 1  
Paper Handling  
Alerts  
Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for paper  
handling.  
E-Mail  
Alert  
Settings  
Service Call  
Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for Service Calls.  
Sets acceptable e-mail addresses for the E-Mail Alert feature using up to 255  
alphanumeric characters.  
E-Mail List 2  
Supplies Alerts  
Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for consumables.  
Select Alerts  
for List 2  
Paper Handling  
Alerts  
Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for paper  
handling.  
Service Call  
Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for Service Calls.  
1
* This item is available only when POP before SMTP for E-Mail Send Authentication is selected.  
   
Bonjour (mDNS)  
Purpose:  
To configure the detailed settings for Bonjour.  
Values:  
Host  
Name  
Specifies the host name up to 63 alphanumeric characters and "-" (dash). The original setting will remain  
valid if no input is made.  
Printer  
Name  
Specifies the printer name up to 63 alphanumeric characters and symbol sets. The original setting will  
remain valid if no input is made.  
SNMP  
Purpose:  
To configure the detailed settings of SNMP.  
Values:  
Enable SNMP v1/v2c  
Protocol  
Select the check box to enable the SNMP v1/v2c protocol.  
Edit SNMP v1/v2c  
Properties  
Click to display SNMP v1/v2c page and to edit the setting of SNMP v1/v2c protocol  
from the page.  
Enable SNMP v3 Protocol  
Select the check box to enable the SNMP v3 protocol.  
Click to display SNMP v3 page and to edit the setting of SNMP v3 protocol from the  
page.  
Edit SNMP v3 Properties  
Without SSL communication is enabled, you cannot click this item.  
SNMP v1/v2c  
Purpose:  
To edit the detailed settings of SNMP v1/v2c protocol.  
To enter this page, click Edit SNMP v1/v2c Properties in the SNMP page.  
Values:  
Community  
Name (Read  
Specifies the community name to access (read only) data using up to 31 alphanumeric characters.  
The original setting will remain valid if no input is made. Characters entered for community name in  
the previous settings will not be displayed on the screen. The default Read Community is public.  
1
only)*  
Re-enter  
Community  
Name (Read  
Enter the community name to access (read only) data again to confirm it.  
1
only)*  
Specifies the community name to access (read and write) data using up to 31 alphanumeric  
characters.  
The original setting will remain valid if no input is made. Characters entered for community name in  
the previous settings will not be displayed on the screen. The default Read/Write Community is  
private.  
Community  
Name  
1
1
(Read/Write)*  
Re-enter  
Community  
Name  
Enter the community name to access (read and write) data again to confirm it.  
(Read/Write)*  
Specifies the community name used for trap up to 31 alphanumeric characters.  
The original settings will remain valid if no input is made. Characters entered for Community Name  
(Trap) in the previous settings will not be displayed on the screen. The default Trap Community is " "  
(NULL).  
Community  
1
Name (Trap)*  
 
Re-enter  
Community  
Enter the community name used for trap again to confirm it.  
1
Name (Trap)*  
Select the check boxes to notify trap occurrence. In this case, specify the IP address and IP socket in  
the following format:  
IPv4  
Specify the IP address and IP socket in the nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn:mmmmm format. Each section of "nnn"  
is a variable value between 0 and 255. Note that values 127 and 224-254 are not valid for the first  
Trap  
Notification 1-4 three-digits only. IP socket mmmmm is a variable value between 0 and 65,535.  
IPv6  
Specify the IP address and IP socket in the xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:mmmmm  
format. Each section of "xxxx" is a hexadecimal variable value between 0 and ffff. IP socket  
mmmmm is a variable value between 0 and 65,535.  
Authenticate  
Error Trap  
Select the check box to notify Authenticate Error Trap.  
1
* The default value of each items can be changed by using Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
SNMP v3  
Purpose:  
To edit the detailed settings of SNMP v3 protocol.  
To enter this page, click Enable SNMP v3 Protocol in the SNMP page.  
Values:  
Account Enabled  
User Name  
Select the check box to enable the administrator account.  
Enter the user name of the administrator account.  
Authentication  
Password  
Specifies the authentication password of the administrator account  
using 8 to 32 alphanumeric characters.  
Re-enter  
Authentication  
Password  
Enter the authentication password of the administrator account  
again to confirm it.  
Administrator Account  
Specifies the privacy password of the administrator account using 8  
to 32 alphanumeric characters.  
Privacy Password  
Re-enter Privacy  
Password  
Enter the privacy password of the administrator account again to  
confirm it.  
Select the check box to enable the print drivers and remote client  
account.  
Account Enabled  
Print Drivers / Remote  
Client Account  
Reset to default  
Password  
Click to reset the password for the print drivers and remote client  
account to default.  
Wireless LAN  
Purpose:  
To configure the detailed setting for the wireless network.  
To use the wireless adapter, be sure to disconnect the network cable.  
NOTE: Once wireless LAN is activated, wired LAN protocol will be disabled.  
Values:  
SSID  
Specifies the name that identifies the wireless network. Up to 32 alphanumeric characters.  
 
Network  
Type  
Specifies the network type from either Ad-Hoc or Infrastructure.  
Displays the MAC address of the printer's wireless network adapter.  
Displays the channel number of the printer's wireless connection.  
MAC  
Address  
Wireless  
Settings  
Link  
Channel  
Link  
Quality  
Displays the quality of the printer's wireless network connection.  
Select the security method from the list.  
Specifies No Security to configure the wireless setting without  
specifying a security method from WEP, WPA-PSK, and WPA-  
Enterprise.  
No Security  
WEP  
Specifies the WEP to use through the wireless network.  
Specifies the WPA-PSK to use through the wireless network.  
Security  
Settings  
Encryption  
WPA-PSK(WPA2-  
1, 2  
PSK)*  
WPA-  
Enterprise(WPA2-  
Specifies the WPA-Enterprise to use through the wireless network.  
2, 3, 4  
Enterprise)*  
Encryption Select the WEP key code from either Hex or Ascii.  
WEP Key  
1
Specifies the WEP key set used through the wireless network only when WEP 128bit or  
WEP 64bit is selected for Encryption.  
Re-enter  
WEP Key  
1
Enter the WEP key 1 again to confirm it.  
WEP Key  
2
Specifies the WEP key set used through the wireless network only when WEP 128bit or  
WEP 64bit is selected for Encryption.  
Re-enter  
WEP Key  
2
Enter the WEP key 2 again to confirm it.  
WEP  
WEP Key  
3
Specifies the WEP key set used through the wireless network only when WEP 128bit or  
WEP 64bit is selected for Encryption.  
Re-enter  
WEP Key  
3
Enter the WEP key 3 again to confirm it.  
WEP Key  
4
Specifies the WEP key set used through the wireless network only when WEP 128bit or  
WEP 64bit is selected for Encryption.  
Re-enter  
WEP Key  
4
Enter the WEP key 4 again to confirm it.  
Transmit  
Key  
Specifies the transmit key type from the list.  
Specifies the pass phrase.  
Pass  
Phrase  
WPA-PSK  
Re-enter  
Pass  
Enter the pass phrase again to confirm it.  
Phrase  
Encryption  
Method  
Shows the encryption method.  
Login  
Name  
Specifies the login name for the authentication.  
Specifies the EAP-Identity for the authentication.  
WPA-  
4,  
EAP-  
Identity  
Enterprise*  
5
Password Specifies the password.  
Re-enter  
Password  
Enter the password again to confirm it.  
1
* For encryption, AES or TKIP method is used.  
2
* This item is available only when the Infrastructure mode is selected for Network Type.  
3
* For authentication and encryption by digital certificate, AES or TKIP method is used.  
4
* This item is displayed only when the optional hard disk is installed and is set to On for encryption.  
5
* To activate the setting, import a certificate which supports wireless LAN (server) on the SSL/TLS pages, and enable  
the relevant certificate in advance.  
NOTE: This item is available only when connecting the printer with a wireless network.  
NOTE: The optional wireless adapter supports WEP, WPA-PSK-TKIP, WPA-PSK-AES, and WPA-PSK-AES.  
Reset Print Server  
Purpose:  
To initialize non-volatile RAM (NVRAM) for the network feature and reboot the printer. You can also initialize the printer's  
NVRAM from Reset Defaults in the Printer Settings menu.  
Values:  
Initialize NIC NVRAM Memory Click the Start button to initialize NVRAM. Network settings will revert to the factory  
and restart printer  
default settings and reboot the network capability.  
Restart Printer  
Click the Start button to reboot the printer.  
Security  
The Security tab includes Set Password, Authentication System, Kerberos Server, LDAP Server, LDAP  
Authentication, SSL/TLS, IPsec, 802.1x and IP Filter(IPv4).  
Set Password  
Purpose:  
To set or change the password that is required to access the printer's setup parameters from the Dell Printer  
Configuration Web Tool.  
Set the password of the operator panel from Panel Lock in the Printer Settings. This page can also be displayed by  
clicking Set Password in the Left Frame.  
NOTE: To restore the password to the default (NULL), initialize the non-volatile memory (NVM).  
Values:  
Administrator  
Password  
Sets the password using up to 10 alphanumeric characters. The password will appear as  
asterisks (*) in the field when it is entered.  
Re-enter  
Administrator  
Password  
Enter the password again to confirm.  
Access denial by the  
authentication  
failure of the  
Specifies the amount of time the administrator should wait for the access to the printer's setup  
from Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. Sets the time period from 5 up to 255 seconds. The  
access is denied if the time-out time is exceeded. If you set 0, this mode is disabled.  
Administrator  
Authentication System  
Purpose:  
       
To specify the server authentication type, the server response time-out, or the search time-out.  
Values:  
Authentication  
Select the authentication system from the list.  
System Settings  
Server Response  
Time-Out  
Specifies the amount of time the printer should wait for response from the server. Sets the  
time period from 1 up to 75 seconds.  
Specifies the amount of time the printer should wait for searching for the server. Sets the  
time period from 5 up to 120 seconds.  
Search Time-Out  
Kerberos Server  
Purpose:  
To specify the settings for the Kerberos Server.  
Values:  
Primary Server Name / IP  
Address & Port  
Sets the primary server name or IP address, and the port address. The port  
address must be 88 or between 5,000 and 65,535.  
Secondary Server Name /  
IP Address & Port  
Sets the secondary server name or IP address, and the port address. The port  
address must be 88 or between 5,000 and 65,535.  
Domain Name  
Enter the domain name.  
LDAP Server  
Purpose:  
To specify the settings of the LDAP server.  
Values:  
IP Address / Host  
Name & Port  
Sets IP address or the host name, and the port address. The port address must  
be 389, 636 or between 5,000 and 65,535.  
Server  
Information  
Backup IP Address / Sets backup IP address or the host name, and the port address. The port  
Host Name & Port  
address must be 389, 636 or between 5,000 and 65,535.  
LDAP Server  
Displays the current software information of the LDAP server.  
Search Directory  
Root  
Enter the search directory root.  
Login Name  
Enter the login name of the administrator.  
Operation  
Information  
Enter the administrator password using 1 to 127 alphanumeric characters. If  
the password is left blank (NULL), you cannot log in to a server.  
Password  
Re-enter-Password  
Enter the administrator password again to confirm it.  
Search  
Time-Out  
Select Wait LDAP Server Limit and the specified wait time. The specified wait  
time must be between 5 and 120 seconds.  
LDAP Authentication  
Purpose:  
To specify the LDAP server authentication method.  
Values:  
Authentication Method  
Use Added Text String  
Shows the authentication method.  
Select whether to use the added text string from the list.  
     
Text String Added to User Name Enter the added text string.  
SSL/TLS  
Purpose:  
To specify the settings for the SSL encryption communication to the printer, and set/delete the certificate used for IPsec,  
LDAPS, or Wireless LAN.  
Values:  
HTTP-SSL/TLS  
Select the check box to enable the HTTP-SSL/TLS Communication.  
1
Communication*  
HTTP-SSL/TLS  
Specifies the port number, which is not identical with that of HTTP for SSL/TLS. This must be  
Communication  
443 or between 8000 and 9999.  
Port Number  
LDAP-SSL/TLS  
Select the check box to enable the LDAP, and access is established using SSL/TLS  
1,  
Communication*  
communication.  
2
Verify Remote  
Server  
Select the check box to enable the Verify Remote Server Certificate function.  
2
Certificate*  
Click to display Generate Self-Signed Certificate page and to create a security certification  
from the page. The Generate Self-Signed Certificate button is available only when the self-signed  
certificate is not generated.  
Size of Public  
Select the size of public key.  
Key  
Generate Self-  
Signed  
3
Certificate*  
Issuer  
Specifies the issuer of SSL self-signed certificate.  
Generate  
Signed  
Click to generate the SSL self-signed certificate.  
Certificate  
Click to display Upload Signed Certificate page and to upload the certificate file to the device  
from the page.  
Password  
Enter the password to upload the certificate file.  
Enter the password again for confirmation.  
Upload Signed  
Re-enter  
Password  
3, 4  
Certificate*  
Search  
Directory Root  
Click the Browse button, browse the file name to upload to the device.  
Import  
Click the Import button to upload the certificate file to the device.  
Click to display Certificate Management page and to manage a security certification from the  
page.  
Category  
Select the device to certificate.  
Certificate  
Certificate  
Purpose  
Select the connection to certificate.  
Management  
3, 4  
*
Certificate  
Order  
Select the order to certificate.  
Display the  
List  
Click to display the Certificate List page.  
Category  
Displays the device to certificate selected at Certificate Management page.  
Certificate  
Purpose  
Select the connection to certificate selected at Certificate Management  
page.  
3
Issued To  
Validity  
Displays the list of certificate order.  
Certificate List*  
Displays whether certificate is valid or not.  
Certificate  
Details  
Display the Certificate Details page. The Certificate Management page is  
displayed when no item in the Issued to column is selected.  
 
Displays the device to certificate selected at Certificate Management page  
or SSL/TLS page.  
Category  
Issued To  
Issuer  
Displays the device to certificate.  
Displays the issuer to certificate.  
Serial Number Displays the serial number of the device.  
Size of Public  
Display Size of Public Key.  
Key  
Valid From  
Valid Until  
Status  
Displays the time the certificate is valid.  
Displays the time the certificate is invalid.  
Displays whether certificate is valid or not.  
Certificate  
3
Details*  
Certificate  
Purpose  
Displays the purpose of certificate.  
Certificate  
Selection  
Status  
Displays the type of device certificate you selected.  
E-mail Address Displayed only when an e-mail address is specified in the certificate.  
Use This  
Click to apply this certificate to the device.  
2
Certificate*  
Delete  
Click to delete this certificate.  
Export This  
Click to export the certificate to the other device.  
2
Certificate*  
1
* This item is available only when the self-signed certificate has been generated.  
2
* This item is displayed only when the optional hard disk is installed and is set to On for encryption.  
3
* This item is effective only when connected via SSL/TLS (https). Only the administrator is allowed to display the  
pages.  
4
* This item is displayed only when the optional hard disk is installed and is set to On for encryption. If not, "Certificate  
Details" is displayed.  
IPsec  
Purpose:  
To specify the Security Architecture settings for Internet Protocol (IPsec) for encrypted communication to the printer.  
Values:  
Protocol  
IKE  
Select the check box to enable the protocol.  
Select IKE authentication. Digital Signature is displayed on the list only when an effective digital  
signature is set up.  
Specifies a shared key when Pre-Shared Key is selected for the IKE setting. Up to 255  
alphanumeric characters, periods, and hyphens can be used.  
1
Pre-Shared Key*  
Re-enter Pre-Shared  
Key  
Enter the shared key again to confirm it.  
Displays the device certificate.  
1
Device Certificate*  
IKE SA Lifetime  
IPsec SA Lifetime  
DH Group  
Sets the lifetime for IKE SA from 5 to 28,800 minutes.  
Sets the lifetime for IPsec SA from 5 to 2,880 minutes.  
Selects the DH group.  
PFS  
Selects the check box to enable the PFS setting.  
Remote peers IPv4  
address  
Specifies the IP address to connect to.  
 
Remote peers IPv6  
address  
Specifies the IP address to connect to.  
Non IPsec  
communication  
policy  
Selects whether or not to communicate with a device which does not support IPsec.  
1
* This item is effective only when the optional hard disk is installed and is set to On for encryption.  
NOTE: If IPsec is enabled with incorrect settings, you must disable it using the Reset IPsec menu on the operator  
panel.  
802.1x  
Purpose:  
To specify the settings for IEEE 802.1x authentication for encrypted communication to the printer.  
Values:  
Enable IEEE 802.1x  
Select the check box to enable IEEE 802.1x authentication.  
EAP-MD5  
EAP-MS-CHAPv2  
Authentication Method  
Select the authentication method to use for IEEE 802.1x authentication.  
PEAP/MS-  
CHAPv2  
Login Name: (Device  
Name)  
Specifies the login name (device name) for IEEE 802.1x authentication using up to 128  
alphanumeric characters.  
Specifies the login password for IEEE 802.1x authentication using up to 128 alphanumeric  
characters.  
Password  
Re-enter Password  
Enter the login password again to confirm it.  
IP Filter  
Purpose:  
To specify the IP address and subnet mask to be permitted or denied access to the printer.  
Values:  
Specifies the IP addresses that are permitted or denied access to the printer. Enter a numeric value  
between 0 and 255 in each field.  
Address  
Address  
Mask  
Specifies the subnet mask that are permitted or denied access to the printer. Enter a numeric value  
between 0 and 255 in each field.  
Reject  
Rejects printing from specified network address.  
Permits printing from specified network address.  
Disables the IP Filter feature for the specified IP address.  
Active  
Mode  
Permit  
Disabled  
Copy Printer Settings  
The Copy Printer Settings menu includes the Copy Printer Settings and Copy Printer Settings Report pages.  
Copy Printer Settings  
Purpose:  
To copy the printer settings and ColorTrack (Internal Setting) to one or more of the same model of the printer.  
       
To copy the settings to another printer, specify the IP address and password of the printer to which the settings are  
copied in the IP Address text box and Password text box. Then, click the Copy the settings to the Host in the  
above list button. Copying the settings is complete. The connection time-out period is 60 seconds. After that, you can  
check whether the settings were copied to this page. And you need to click the Copy the settings to the Host in the  
above list and reboot the machine button of the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool in the destination printer to  
verify if the settings were actually copied or not.  
If the settings can be copied but printer configuration is different, the settings of only the same items are copied. Printer  
settings are simultaneously copied to printer of up to 10 IP addresses.  
Copy Printer Settings Report  
Purpose:  
To verify the histories of copying.  
NOTE: The print history is cleared when you turn off the printer.  
Print Volume  
The Print Volume menu includes the Print Volume and Dell ColorTrack pages.  
Print Volume  
Purpose:  
To verify the number of printed pages. This page can also be displayed by clicking Print Volume in the Left Frame.  
Values:  
Printer Page Count Displays the total number of pages printed since the printer was shipped from the factory.  
Paper Used  
Displays the number of pages printed for each paper size.  
Dell ColorTrack  
Purpose:  
To specify which users have access to color printing and to limit print volume per user.  
Values:  
Off  
Enables to print the data with no authentication information.  
Restricts printing based on the print user information registered in  
the internal server.  
Internal Mode  
ColorTrack Mode  
Restricts printing based on the print user information registered in  
the external server.  
External Mode  
No Account User  
Print  
Specifies whether to permit the printing of data with no authentication information. To permit  
the printing for non-account user, set to On.  
ColorTrack Error  
Report  
Specifies whether to automatically print error-related information if printing using ColorTrack  
results in an error.  
No-account User  
Specifies the password to be used for non-account user using 1 to 127 alphanumeric  
characters. If the password is left blank (NULL), you cannot log in to a server.  
1
Password*  
Re-enter No-account  
Enter the password again to confirm it.  
1
User Password*  
Click Edit User Registration to display the Edit Print User Registration page.  
To register a user, click Create to open the Print User Settings page.  
       
To delete a user, click Delete to open the Delete User page. Clicking the Back button  
returns the screen to the status prior to deleting the user.  
To confirm or change the registered user, click Confirm/Change to open the Print  
User Settings page.  
Displays the user registration number. The Delete User button is  
displayed when the user is already registered.  
User Registration No.  
User Name  
Specifies the user name.  
2
User Registration*  
Password  
Specifies the user password using 4 to 12 alphanumeric characters.  
Enter the password again to confirm it.  
Re-enter password  
Color Mode Limitation Specifies whether to limit color printing.  
Upper Limit for Color  
Print  
Specifies the maximum number of pages allowed for color printing.  
Cumulative Color  
Page Count  
Displays the cumulative number of pages printed for color printing.  
Upper Limit for  
Monochrome Print  
Specifies the maximum number of pages allowed for monochrome  
printing.  
Cumulative  
Monochrome Page  
Count  
Displays the cumulative number of pages printed for monochrome  
printing.  
Setup Remote  
Click to display Authentication System page.  
3
Authentication*  
1
* The password must be set when External Mode is selected for ColorTrack Mode and No Account User Print is set to  
on.  
2
* This item is displayed only when ColorTrack Mode is Internal Mode.  
3
* This item is displayed only when ColorTrack Mode is External Mode.  
Tray Settings  
Use the Tray Settings menu to set the paper size and type of paper loaded in the trays.  
Values:  
Tray 1 Paper Type  
Tray 1 Paper Size  
Sets the type of paper loaded in the first tray from the top.  
Sets the size of paper loaded in the first tray from the top.  
Tray 1 Custom Size  
- Y  
Sets the length of custom size paper loaded in the first tray from the top.  
Sets the width of custom size paper loaded in the first tray from the top.  
Tray 1 Custom Size  
- X  
Tray 2 Paper  
Sets the type of paper loaded in the second tray from the top.  
Sets the size of paper loaded in the second tray from the top.  
Sets the length of custom size paper loaded in the second tray from the top.  
Sets the width of custom size paper loaded in the second tray from the top.  
Sets the type of paper loaded in the third tray from the top.  
Sets the size of paper loaded in the third tray from the top.  
1
Type*  
Tray 2 Paper  
1
Size*  
Tray 2 Custom Size  
1
- Y*  
Tray 2 Custom Size  
1
- X*  
Tray 3 Paper  
1
Type*  
Tray 3 Paper  
1
 
Size*  
Tray 3 Custom Size  
Sets the length of custom size paper loaded in the third tray from the top.  
Sets the width of custom size paper loaded in third tray from the top.  
Sets the type of paper loaded in the fourth tray from the top.  
Sets the size of paper loaded in the fourth tray from the top.  
1
- Y*  
Tray 3 Custom Size  
1
- X*  
Tray 4 Paper  
2
Type*  
Tray 4 Paper  
2
Size*  
Tray 4 Custom Size  
Sets the length of custom size paper loaded in the fourth tray from the top.  
Sets the width of custom size paper loaded in the fourth tray from the top.  
Sets the type of paper loaded in the fifth tray from the top.  
2
- Y*  
Tray 4 Custom Size  
2
- X*  
Tray 5 Paper  
2
Type*  
Tray 5 Paper  
Sets the size of paper loaded in the fifth tray from the top.  
2
Size*  
Tray 5 Custom Size  
Sets the length of custom size paper loaded in the fifth tray from the top.  
2
- Y*  
Tray 5 Custom Size  
Sets the width of custom size paper loaded in the fifth tray from the top.  
Sets the paper size and type when paper is loaded in the MPF.  
2
- X*  
MPF Mode  
Sets whether to display a popup message that prompts to set the paper size and type when  
paper is loaded in the tray 1.  
3
Display Popup*  
3
Sets the type of paper loaded in the MPF.  
Sets the size of paper loaded in the MPF.  
MPF Paper Type*  
3
MPF Paper Size*  
MPF Custom Size -  
Sets the length of custom size paper loaded in the MPF.  
Sets the width of custom size paper loaded in the MPF.  
3
Y*  
MPF Custom Size -  
3
X*  
1
* This item is available only when the optional 550-sheet feeder or 1100-sheet feeder is installed.  
2
* This item is available only when the optional 1100-sheet feeder is installed.  
3
* This item is displayed only when Panel Specified is selected for MPF Mode.  
Print Media Guidelines  
Print media is paper, labels, envelopes, and coated paper among others. Your printer provides high-quality printing on a  
variety of print media. Selecting the appropriate print media for your printer helps avoid printing troubles. This section  
describes selecting print media, caring for print media, and loading the print media in the tray 1 or optional 550-sheet  
feeder.  
Paper  
2
For the best print quality in color, use 75 g/m (20 lb) xerographic, grain long paper. For the best print quality in black  
2
and white, use 90 g/m (24 lb) xerographic, grain long paper. It is recommended that you try a sample first before buying  
large quantities of any print media.  
When loading paper, identify the recommended print side on the paper package, and load the paper accordingly. See  
instructions.  
Paper Characteristics  
The following paper characteristics affect print quality and reliability. It is recommended that you follow these guidelines  
when evaluating new paper stock.  
Weight  
2
The tray automatically feeds paper weights from 60 to 216 g/m (16 to 80 lb bond) grain long. The multipurpose feeder  
2
2
(MPF) automatically feeds paper weights from 60 to 216 g/m (16 to 80 lb bond) grain long. Paper lighter than 60 g/m  
2
(16 lb) may not feed properly, and could cause paper jams. For best performance, use 75 g/m (20 lb bond) grain long  
paper.  
Curl  
Curl is the tendency of print media to curve at its edges. Excessive curl can cause paper feeding problems. Curl usually  
occurs after the paper passes through the printer, where it is exposed to high temperatures. Storing paper unwrapped,  
even in the paper tray, can contribute to paper curling prior to printing and cause feeding problems regardless of  
humidity. When printing on curled paper, straighten the paper and then insert it into the MPF.  
Smoothness  
The degree of paper smoothness directly affects print quality. If the paper is too rough, the toner does not fuse to the  
paper properly, resulting in poor print quality. If the paper is too smooth, it can cause paper feeding problems.  
Smoothness between 150 and 250 Sheffield points produces the best print quality.  
Moisture Content  
   
The amount of moisture in the paper affects both print quality and the ability of the printer to feed the paper properly.  
Leave the paper in its original packaging until you are ready to use it. This limits the exposure of the paper to moisture  
changes that can degrade its performance.  
Grain Direction  
Grain refers to the alignment of the paper fibers in a sheet of paper. Grain is either grain long, running the length of the  
2
paper, or grain short, running the width of the paper. For 60 to 135 g/m (16 to 36 lb bond) paper, grain long fibers are  
2
recommended. For paper heavier than 135 g/m (36 lb bond), grain short is preferred.  
Fiber Content  
Most high-quality xerographic paper is made from 100% chemically pulped wood. Paper containing fibers such as cotton  
possess characteristics that can result in degraded paper handling.  
Recommended Paper  
2
To ensure the best print quality and feed reliability, use 75 g/m (20 lb) xerographic paper. Business paper designed for  
general business use also provide acceptable print quality. Only use paper able to withstand high temperatures without  
discoloring, bleeding, or releasing hazardous emissions. The laser printing process heats paper to high temperatures.  
Check with the manufacturer or vendor to determine whether the paper you have chosen is acceptable for laser printers.  
Always print several samples before buying large quantities of any type of print media. When choosing any print media,  
you should consider the weight, fiber content, and color.  
Unacceptable Paper  
The following paper types are not recommended for use with the printer:  
Chemically treated paper used to make copies without carbon paper, also known as carbonless paper, carbonless  
copy paper (CCP), or no carbon required (NCR) paper  
Preprinted paper with chemicals that may contaminate the printer  
Preprinted paper that can be affected by the temperature in the fuser  
Preprinted paper that require a registration (the precise print location on the page) greater than ±0.09 inches, such  
as optical character recognition (OCR) forms  
In some cases, you can adjust registration with your software program to successfully print on these forms.  
Coated paper (erasable bond), synthetic paper, thermal paper  
Rough-edged, rough or heavily textured surface paper, or curled paper  
Recycled paper containing more than 25% post-consumer waste that do not meet DIN 19 309  
Multiple-part forms or documents  
Print quality may deteriorate (blank spaces or blotches may appear in the text) when printing on talc or acid paper.  
Selecting Paper  
Proper paper selection helps prevent jams and ensures trouble-free printing.  
To help avoid jams or poor print quality:  
Always use new, undamaged paper.  
Before loading the paper, identify the recommended print side of the paper. This information is usually indicated on  
the paper package.  
Do not use paper that you have cut or trimmed yourself.  
Do not mix print media sizes, weights, or types in the same source. This may result in a paper jam.  
Do not remove the tray while a job is printing.  
Ensure that the paper is properly loaded in the tray.  
Flex paper back and forth, and then fan them. Straighten the edges of the stack on a level surface.  
Selecting Preprinted Media and Letterhead  
When selecting preprinted media and letterhead paper for the printer:  
Use grain long paper for best results.  
Use only media and letterhead printed using an offset lithographic or engraved printing process.  
Select paper that absorb ink, but do not bleed.  
Avoid paper with rough or heavily textured surfaces.  
Use paper printed with heat-resistant inks designed for use in xerographic copiers. The ink must withstand  
temperatures of 225°C (437°F) without melting or releasing hazardous emissions.  
Use inks that are not affected by the resin in toner or the silicone in the fuser. Inks that are oxidation-set or oil-  
based should meet these requirements; latex inks might not. If you are in doubt, contact your paper supplier.  
Printing on Letterhead  
Check with the manufacturer or vendor to determine whether the pre-printed letterhead you have selected is acceptable  
for laser printers.  
Page orientation is important when printing on letterhead. Use the following table for help when loading letterhead in the  
print media sources.  
Print media source  
Print side  
Page orientation  
Face up  
Tray 1  
550-sheet feeder  
1100-sheet feeder  
Letterhead enters the printer first  
Face down  
MPF  
Letterhead enters the printer first  
Selecting Pre-Punched Paper  
Pre-punched paper brands can differ in the number and placement of holes and in manufacturing techniques. However, it  
may not be possible to print on the paper to depending on the placement of holes on the paper.  
To select and use pre-punched paper:  
Test paper from several manufacturers before ordering and using large quantities of pre-punched paper.  
Paper should be punched at the paper manufacturer and not drilled into paper already packaged in a ream. Drilled  
paper can cause jams when multiple sheets feed through the printer. This may result in a paper jam.  
Pre-punched paper can include more paper dust than standard paper. Your printer may require more frequent  
cleaning and feed reliability may not be as good as standard paper.  
Weight guidelines for pre-punched paper are the same as non-punched paper.  
Transparencies  
You can load up to 75 sheets of transparencies in the MPF or tray 1 for a single print job. It is recommended that you try  
a sample first before buying large quantities of any print media.  
When printing on transparencies:  
Set the paper type to Transparency from the printer driver to avoid damaging your printer.  
Use transparencies designed specifically for laser printers. Do not use regular transparencies. Transparencies must  
be able to withstand temperatures of 205°C (401°F) without melting, discoloring, offsetting or releasing hazardous  
emissions.  
Avoid getting fingerprints on the transparencies. This may result in poor print quality.  
Before loading transparencies, fan the stack to prevent sheets from sticking together.  
Non-white transparencies are not supported with the printer.  
Selecting Transparencies  
The printer can print directly on transparencies designed for use in laser printers. Print quality and durability depend on  
the transparency used. It is recommended that you try a sample first before buying large quantities of any print media.  
The paper type setting for the MPF should be set to Transparency to help prevent jams. (See "Tray Settings" for detailed  
information about this setting.) Check with the manufacturer or vendor to determine whether your transparencies are  
compatible with laser printers that reach temperatures as high as 205°C (401°F). Only use transparencies that are able to  
withstand these temperatures without melting, discoloring, offsetting, or releasing hazardous emissions.  
NOTE: For the tray 1, setting paper size is not required. The tray 1 detects the paper size automatically. For more  
information on supported paper size for the standard and optional trays, see "Supported Paper Sizes."  
Envelopes  
   
Depending on the choice of envelopes, it is possible to expect variable levels of light wrinkling. It is recommended that you  
try a sample first before buying large quantities of any print media. See "Loading Print Media" for instructions on loading  
an envelope.  
When printing on envelopes:  
Use only high-quality envelopes that are designed for use in laser printers.  
Set the print media source to the MPF or tray 1. Set the paper type to Envelope, and select the correct size of  
envelope from the printer driver.  
2
2
For best performance, use envelopes made from 75 g/m (20 lb bond) paper. You can use up to 105 g/m (28 lb  
bond) weight for the envelope feeder as long as the cotton content is 25% or less. Envelopes with 100% cotton  
2
content must not exceed 90 g/m (24 lb bond) weight.  
Use only freshly unpacked, undamaged envelopes.  
Use envelopes that can withstand temperatures of 205°C (401°F) without sealing, excessive curling, wrinkling, or  
releasing hazardous emissions. If you have any doubts about the envelopes you are considering, check with the  
envelope supplier.  
Adjust the guide to fit the width of the envelopes.  
To load envelope in the MPF, insert the envelopes with the flaps closed and the short-edge of the envelopes facing  
into the printer. The print side must be facing down.  
See "Loading Print Media in the MPF" for instructions on loading an envelope.  
Use one envelope size during a print job.  
Ensure the humidity is low because high humidity (more than 60%) and the high printing temperatures may seal  
the envelopes.  
For best performance, do not use envelopes that:  
Have excessive curl or twist  
Are stuck together or damaged in any way  
Contain windows, holes, perforations, cutouts, embossing  
Use metal clasps, string ties, or metal folding bars  
Have an interlocking design  
Have postage stamps attached  
Have any exposed adhesive when the flap is in the sealed or closed position  
Have nicked edges or bent corners  
Have rough, cockle, or laid finishes  
NOTE: You can load envelopes also on the tray 1. For more information, see "Loading an Envelope in Standard  
Trays."  
Labels  
Your printer can print on many labels designed for use with laser printers. Label adhesives, face sheet (printable stock),  
and topcoats must be able to withstand temperatures of 205°C (401°F) and pressure of 25 pounds per square inch (psi).  
It is recommended that you try a sample first before buying large quantities of any print media.  
When printing on labels:  
Set the paper type to Label from the printer driver.  
Do not load labels together with paper in the same tray. This may result in a jam.  
Do not use label sheets with a slick backing material.  
 
Do not print within 1 mm (0.04 inches) of the die cut.  
Use full label sheets. Partial sheets may cause labels to peel off during printing, resulting in a jam. Partial sheets  
also contaminate your printer and your cartridge with adhesive, and could void your printer and cartridge  
warranties.  
Use labels that can withstand temperatures of 205°C (401°F) without sealing, excessive curling, wrinkling, or  
releasing hazardous emissions.  
Do not print within 1 mm (0.04 inches) of the edge of the label, of the perforations, or between die-cuts of the  
label.  
Do not use label sheets that have adhesive to the edge of the sheet. It is recommended that zone coating of the  
adhesive is at least 1 mm (0.04 inches) away from edges. Adhesive material contaminates your printer and could  
void your warranty.  
If zone coating of the adhesive is not possible, a 3 mm (0.125 inches) strip should be removed on the leading and  
driver edge, and a non-oozing adhesive should be used.  
Remove a 3 mm (0.125 inches) strip from the leading edge to prevent labels from peeling inside the printer.  
Portrait orientation is preferred, especially when printing bar codes.  
Do not use labels that have exposed adhesive.  
Storing Print Media  
For proper print media storage, the following guidelines help avoid media feeding problems and uneven print quality.  
For best results, store print media in an environment where the temperature is approximately 21°C (70°F) and the  
relative humidity is 40%.  
Store cartons of print media on a pallet or shelf, rather than directly on the floor.  
If you store individual packages of print media out of the original carton, ensure that they rest on a flat surface so  
that the edges do not buckle or curl.  
Do not place anything on top of the print media packages.  
Identifying Print Media and Specifications  
The following tables provide information on standard and optional print media.  
Supported Paper Sizes  
Output Expander  
Output Expander  
Standard  
Tray  
Option  
Tray  
MPF  
Duplexer  
1
2
(Sheet* )  
(Set* )  
A4  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
(210 x 297 mm)  
A5  
(148 x 210 mm)  
B5  
N
N
N
N
(182 x 257 mm)  
Letter  
(8.5 x 11 in.)  
Folio  
(8.5 x 13 in.)  
Legal  
     
(8.5 x 14 in.)  
Executive  
(7.25 x 10.5 in.)  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Envelope #10 (4.125 x 9.5  
in.)  
3
3
3
3
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y*  
Y*  
Y*  
Monarch  
(3.875 x 7.5 in.)  
DL  
(4.25 x 8.75 in.)  
C5  
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y*  
Y
(9 x 6.5 in.)  
Custom  
*1  
: In this mode, each page is output separately to the stacker tray.  
*2  
*3  
: In this mode, the document is sorted into sets or jobs and output to the stacker tray.  
: To print envelopes using the standard tray, you must select the kind of the  
envelope in the Tray1 Settings. For details, see "Understanding the Printer Menus."  
Supported Paper Types  
Output Expander Output Expander  
MPF  
Standard Tray  
Option Tray  
Duplexer  
1
2
(Sheet* )  
(Set* )  
One-  
sided  
Two-  
sided  
One-  
sided  
Two-  
sided  
One-  
sided  
Two-  
sided  
One-  
sided  
Two-  
sided  
One-  
sided  
Two-  
sided  
One-  
sided  
Two-  
sided  
Normal Y  
Thick  
Normal Y  
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
Plain  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Covers  
Coated  
Thick  
Normal Y  
Thick  
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Label  
Normal Y  
Y
Envelope  
Recycled  
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Transparency  
Y
N
N
N
*1  
*2  
: In this mode, each page is output separately to the stacker tray.  
: In this mode, the document is sorted into sets or jobs and output to the stacker tray.  
Paper Type Specifications  
Paper type  
Plain Paper  
Weight (gsm)  
60-80  
Remarks  
-
-
-
-
Plain Thick Paper 81-105  
Covers  
106-162  
163-216  
106-162  
Covers Thick  
Coated Normal  
Inkjet printer paper cannot be used.  
Coated Thick  
Transparency  
Label Normal  
Label Thick  
Envelopes  
163-216  
Inkjet printer paper cannot be used.  
-
-
-
-
-
Inkjet printer paper cannot be used.  
Inkjet printer paper cannot be used.  
Inkjet printer paper cannot be used.  
-
-
Recycled  
Loading Print Media  
Loading print media properly helps prevent jams and ensures trouble-free printing.  
Before loading print media, identify the recommended print side of the print media. This information is usually on the  
print media package.  
NOTE: After loading paper in the tray, specify the same paper type on the operator panel.  
Capacity  
The tray 1 can hold:  
550 sheets of standard paper.  
The optional 550-sheet feeder can hold:  
550 sheets of standard paper.  
The optional 1100-sheet feeder can hold:  
1100 sheets of standard paper.  
The MPF can hold:  
150 sheet of the standard paper.  
Print Media Dimensions  
The standard and optional trays accept print media within the following dimensions:  
Width - 98.4 mm (Monarch) to 215.9 mm (8.5 inches)  
Length - 190.5 mm (Monarch) to 355.6 mm (14.00 inches)  
The MPF accepts print media within the following dimensions:  
Width - 76.2 mm (3.00 inches) to 215.9 mm (8.5 inches)  
Length - 127 mm (5.00 inches) to 355.6 mm (14.00 inches)  
Loading Print Media in Standard and Optional Trays  
       
NOTE: To avoid paper jams, do not remove the tray while a printing is in progress.  
NOTE: Use only laser print media. Do not use ink jet paper in this printer.  
All trays are loaded the same way:  
1. Remove the paper tray from the printer.  
2. Adjust the width guides to the size of paper to be loaded.  
3. Adjust the length guide to the size of paper to be loaded.  
4. Before loading the paper, flex the sheets back and forth, and then fan them.  
Straighten the edges of the stack on a level surface.  
5. Load paper into the tray with the recommended print side facing up.  
NOTE: Do not exceed the maximum fill line in the tray. Overfilling the tray may cause paper jams.  
6. After confirming that the guides are securely adjusted, replace the paper tray into the printer.  
7. Select the paper type from the operator panel if any print media other than plain print media is loaded. If a user-  
specified print media is loaded in the standard 550-sheet tray, you must specify the paper size setting by using the  
operator panel.  
NOTE: For standard-size papers, adjust the guides first and then set papers.  
Loading an Envelope in Standard Trays  
1. Raise the latch on the handle of the right hand cover to open the cover.  
2. Press down the lever to set the envelope mode.  
NOTE: If you insert media other than envelopes, lift up the lever.  
NOTE: If you use the optional output expander, raise the lever as shown in the illustration.  
 
NOTE: To print plain paper using the optional output expander, check if the lever is pulled down as shown in the  
illustration.  
3. Load the envelope into the tray.  
When Loading Envelope#10, Monarch, or DL  
When Loading C5  
NOTICE: Never use envelopes with windows, coated linings, or self-stick adhesives. These lead to paper jams and  
can cause damage to the printer.  
NOTE: Ensure that you load an envelope with the flap completely closed.  
NOTE: If you do not load envelopes in the MPF right after they have been removed from the packaging, they may  
bulge. To avoid jams, flatten them as shown below when loading them in the MPF.  
NOTE: If envelopes are still not fed correctly, add some bending to the lead edge of the envelopes as shown in the  
following illustration.  
The amount of the bending shall be 5mm or less.  
Loading Letterhead  
The letterhead must be toward the top edge of the standard tray or the optional feeder with the print side facing up.  
However, the letterhead must be inserted top edge first with the print side facing down when loading paper into the  
multipurpose feeder (MPF).  
Print media source  
Print side  
Page orientation  
Face up  
Tray 1  
550-sheet feeder  
1100-sheet feeder  
Letterhead enters the printer first  
Face down  
MPF  
Letterhead enters the printer first  
Loading Print Media in the MPF  
1. Gently pull open the MPF cover.  
2. Extend the extension tray.  
3. Slide the width guides to the edge of the tray. The width guides should be fully extended.  
4. Insert all media facing down and top edge first into the MPF.  
NOTE: Do not force the print media into the MPF.  
 
5. Slide both width guides until they rest lightly against the edge of the print media stack.  
NOTE: Do not force the print media into the MPF.  
6. Ensure the type setting for the MPF is set to the correct value for the print media you have loaded.  
7. Select print media source, size, and type in your software program and select the print media size and type on the  
printer operator panel.  
Loading an Envelope in the MPF  
1. Open the right hand cover.  
2. Press down the lever to set the envelope mode.  
NOTE: If you insert plain paper in the other tray, lift up the lever.  
3. Insert the envelopes with the flaps closed and the short-edge of the envelopes facing into the printer.  
Orient the print side facing down and slide the envelope into the entry slot.  
You can load envelopes up to the maximum fill line in the tray at one time.  
 
When Loading Envelope#10, Monarch, or DL  
When Loading C5  
NOTICE: Never use envelopes with windows, coated linings, or self-stick adhesives. These lead to paper jams and  
can cause damage to the printer.  
NOTE: Ensure that you load an envelope with the flap completely closed.  
NOTE: If you do not load envelopes in the MPF right after they have been removed from the packaging, they may  
bulge. To avoid jams, flatten them as shown below when loading them in the MPF.  
NOTE: If envelopes are still not fed correctly, add some bending to the lead edge of the envelopes as shown in the  
following illustration.  
The amount of the bending shall be 5mm or less.  
Using the MPF  
Load only one size and type of print media during a single print job.  
To achieve the best possible print quality, use only high-quality print media that is designed for use in laser  
printers. For more guidelines on print media, see "Print Media Guidelines."  
Do not add or remove print media when there is still print media in the MPF or when the printer is printing from the  
MPF. This may result in a paper jam.  
Print media should be loaded with the recommended print side down and the top of the print media going into the  
MPF first.  
Do not place objects on the MPF. Also, avoid pressing down or applying excessive force on it.  
The icons on the MPF identify how to load the MPF with paper, and how to turn an envelope for printing.  
Linking Trays  
The printer automatically links the trays when you load the same size and type of print media in them. The first tray will  
be utilized until the media runs out after which the next tray will be used.  
NOTE: The print media should be the same size and type in each tray.  
The Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) cannot be linked to any of the tray sources.  
After loading the selected trays with the same size and type of print media, select the Paper Typesetting in the Tray  
Settings component for each source (tray).  
To disable tray linking change the Paper typein one of the sources (trays) to a unique value.  
NOTE: If different types of print media of the same size are loaded in each tray, the printer will automatically link  
them if the paper type is not specified in the printer driver properties/preferences.  
Using the Duplex Function  
Duplex printing (or two-sided printing) allows you to print on both sides of a sheet of paper. For sizes that are acceptable  
for duplex printing, see "Supported Paper Sizes."  
   
Using Booklet Print  
To use booklet print, you must select either Flip on Short Edge or Flip on Long Edge from the Duplex menu in the  
printer properties dialog box and then select Booklet Creation in the Booklet/Poster/Mixed Document dialog box  
displayed by clicking the Booklet/Poster/Mixed Document button. From the Duplex menu, you can define the way 2-  
sided print pages are bound, and how the printing on the back of the sheet (even-numbered pages) is oriented in relation  
to the printing on the front (odd-numbered pages).  
NOTE: When XPS driver is used, booklet print is not available.  
Assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for portrait orientation and top edge for  
landscape orientation). The following illustration shows long-edge binding for portrait and landscape pages:  
Flip on  
Long  
Edge  
Flip on  
Short  
Edge  
Assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for portrait orientation and left edge for  
landscape orientation). The following illustration shows short-edge binding for portrait and landscape pages:  
Using the Center Output Tray  
The center output tray holds up to:  
2
500 sheets (20 lb (75 g/m )) of plain paper  
Using the Stacker Tray  
   
The stacker tray holds up to:  
Discharging Not Stapled Paper size  
mode  
stapled  
In bulk  
1,000- 50-set (SFP)  
sheet  
or 750-  
sheet  
A4: P: 64gsm  
A4: C2: 70gsm  
Letter: Business 4200: 20 lb  
Letter: Color Xpressions+: 24 lb  
(MPF)  
A4: Premier: 80gsm  
A4: Premier: 4-hole punched: 80gsm  
A4: Business: 80gsm  
A4: Colotech+: 90gsm  
Letter: Business 4200: 75gsm  
Letter: Digital Color Xpressions+: 90gsm/24 lb  
750-  
sheet  
50-set Legal: Business 4200: 20 lb  
or 500-  
sheet  
Legal: Color Xpressions+: 24 lb  
Legal: Digital Color Xpressions+: 24 lb  
On a one-  
by-one  
basis  
300-  
sheet  
-
B5, A6, B6, A5, Post card (US, 5 x 7, 3 x 5, 3.5 x 5, 3.5 x 5.5, 6  
x 9), Statement, Coated (106 to 163gsm), Coated thick (164 to  
1
216gsm), Label, Index paper* , Transparency, Post card (134  
to 190gsm)  
NOTE: The number of sheets shown left may not be achieved  
depending on the type or size of paper.  
100-  
sheet  
-
-
Legal  
NOTE: The number of sheets shown left may not be achieved  
depending on the type or size of paper.  
50-  
Envelope (Com-10, Monarch, DL, C5)  
sheet  
NOTE: The number of sheets shown left may not be achieved  
depending on the type or size of paper.  
1
* : Only those whose index tab is attached to its shorter side are available.  
Operator Panel  
Using the Operator Panel Buttons  
The operator panel has a liquid crystal display (LCD), eight buttons, and an indicator that blinks when the printer is ready  
to print, and when an error occurs.  
1. Ready/Error indicator  
Lights up green when the printer is ready or sleeping and blinks when data is being received.  
Lights up yellow when an error occurs and blinks when an unrecoverable print error occurs.  
2.  
3.  
buttons  
In the Menu mode, selects submenus or setting values.  
buttons  
In the Menu mode, scrolls through menus or items. To enter numbers or passwords for secure print jobs,  
press these buttons.  
4. Cancel button  
Cancels the current print job.  
In the top menu of the Menu mode, switches to the Print mode.  
In the submenu of the Menu mode, switches to the upper hierarchy of the menu.  
5. Menu button  
In the Print mode, switches to the Menu mode.  
In the Menu mode, switches to the Print mode.  
6.  
(Set) button  
In the Menu mode, displays the selected menu or item and determines the selected value.  
7. Information button  
When the information mark is displayed on the screen, press this button to view information, such as  
resolving an error.  
8. LCD panel  
   
Printing a Panel Settings Page  
The panel settings page shows current settings for the operator panel menus.  
When Using the Operator Panel  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
3. Press button until Panel Settings is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
The panel settings page is printed.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Settings Report tab.  
4. Select Reports.  
5. Click the Start button in the Panel Settings.  
The panel settings report is printed.  
 
Printing  
This chapter covers tips for printing, how to print certain lists of information from your printer, and how to cancel a job.  
Tips for Successful Printing  
Tips on Storing Print Media  
Store your print media properly. For more information, see "Storing Print Media."  
Avoiding Paper Jams  
NOTE: It is recommended that you try a limited sample of any print media you are considering using with the  
printer before purchasing large quantities.  
By selecting appropriate print media and loading it properly, you can avoid paper jams. See the following instructions on  
loading print media:  
"Loading Print Media in Standard and Optional Trays" (which includes the tray 1, the optional 550-sheet feeder,  
and the optional 1100-sheet feeder)  
If you experience a jam, see "Clearing Jams" for instructions.  
Sending a Job to Print  
To support all of the printer features, use the printer driver. When you choose Print from a software program, a window  
representing the printer driver opens. Select the appropriate settings for the specific job you are sending to print. Print  
settings selected from the driver override the default menu settings selected from the operator panel.  
You may need to click Preferences from the initial Print box to see all of the available system settings you can change.  
If you are not familiar with a feature in the printer driver window, open the online Help for more information.  
®
To print a job from a typical Windows application:  
1. Open the file you want to print.  
2. From the File menu, select Print.  
3. Verify that the correct printer is selected in the dialog box. Modify the printer settings as appropriate (such as the  
pages you want to print or the number of copies).  
4. Click Preferences to adjust system settings not available from the first screen, and then click OK.  
     
5. Click OK or Print to send the job to the selected printer.  
Canceling a Print Job  
There are several methods for canceling a print job.  
Canceling From the Operator Panel  
To cancel a job after it has started printing:  
Press Cancel.  
Printing is canceled only for the current job. All the following jobs will continue to print.  
Canceling a Job From the Computer Running Windows  
Canceling a Job From the Taskbar  
When you send a job to print, a small printer icon appears in the right corner of the taskbar.  
1. Double-click the printer icon.  
A list of print jobs appears in the printer window.  
2. Select the job you want to cancel.  
3. Press Delete on the keyboard.  
Canceling a Job From the Desktop  
1. Minimize all programs to reveal the desktop.  
Click start® Printers and Faxes.  
®
Click Start® Devices and Printers (for Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2).  
®
Click start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers (for Windows Vista ).  
Click start® Control Panel® Printers (for Windows Server 2008).  
Click start® Settings® Printers (for Windows 2000).  
A list of available printers appears.  
2. Double-click the printer you selected when you sent the job.  
A list of print jobs appears in the printer window.  
3. Select the job you want to cancel.  
4. Press Delete on the keyboard.  
Printing a Report Page  
   
By using the Report menu, you can print a variety of settings for your printer including printer settings, panel setting,  
and font list. The following describes two examples of printing from the Report menu.  
Printing a Printer Settings Page  
To verify detailed printer settings, print a printer settings page. A printed printer settings page also allows you to verify  
whether or not options have been installed properly.  
See "Understanding the Printer Menus" to identify the display and operator panel buttons if you need help.  
When Using the Operator Panel  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
3. Printer Settings is displayed, and then press  
(Set) button.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Settings Report tab.  
4. Select Reports.  
5. Click the Start button in the Printer Settings.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
The message Printer Settings Printing appears while the page prints. The printer returns to the standby mode after  
the printer settings page prints.  
If any other message appears when you print this page, see the online Help for more information.  
Printing a Font Sample List  
To print samples of all the fonts currently available for your printer:  
When Using the Operator Panel  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
3. Press button until either PCL Fonts Listor PS Fonts Listis highlighted.  
Select PCL Fonts Listto print a listing of the fonts available to the PCL.  
(Set) button.  
 
®
Select PS Fonts Listto print a listing of the fonts available to the PostScript 3™.  
4. Press  
(Set) button.  
The message PCL Fonts List Printing or PS Fonts List Printing appears and remains on the operator panel until  
the page prints. The printer returns to the Ready to Print state after the font sample list prints.  
Using the Stapling Function  
When you use the staple function, you can staple each copy. The staple position is located at the upper-left of the paper  
corner.  
B5, A4, Letter, Executive, Folio (8.5), Legal, Plain, Plain-thick, Covers, Covers Thick and Recycled paper can be used with  
the Stapling function.  
NOTE: This item is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
NOTE: This item is available only when using the PCL or PS driver.  
Using the Offset Function  
When you use the offset function, you can identify one paper set from another paper set. When you select "Offset per  
Set", you can offset each copy before printing the next copy. When you select "Offset per Job", you can offset each copy  
per paper job you specify. You can also specify whether to staple or insert a banner sheet after offsetting each copy.  
B5, A4, Letter, Executive, Folio (8.5), Legal, Plain, Plain-thick, Covers, Covers Thick and Recycled paper can be used with  
the Offset function.  
NOTE: This item is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
NOTE: This item is available only when using the PCL or PS driver.  
Examples of two jobs when printing two copies of a three page document:  
Using the Stored Print Function  
When you send a job to the printer, you can specify in the driver that you want the printer to store the job in memory.  
When you are ready to print the job, go to the printer and use the operator panel menus to identify which job in the  
memory or hard disk you want to print. You can use this function for Secure Print, Public MailBox Print, Private MailBox  
Print, and Proof Print.  
NOTE: The data in memory is cleared when the printer is turned off. The data on the optional hard disk is not  
     
cleared even when the printer is turned off.  
NOTE: Stored Print functions are available when:  
Enabling the RAM disk in the operator panel menu and setting  
"RAM Disk" to "Available" in the printer driver  
or  
Installing a hard disk in your printer and setting "Hard Disk"  
to "Available" in the printer driver  
The stored printing function includes the following job types.  
Secure Print  
You can store print jobs temporarily in printer memory to output at a specified time at the printer. This feature can be  
used to print confidential documents. A stored print job will be deleted after you print it, or after a designated period of  
time has elapsed.  
NOTE: This item is available when using the PCL or PS driver.  
Private MailBox Print  
You can store print jobs temporarily in printer memory to output at a more convenient time at the printer. This feature  
can be used to print confidential documents. The stored jobs remain in printer memory until you delete them on the  
operator panel.  
NOTE: This item is available when using the PCL or PS driver.  
Public MailBox Print  
You can store print jobs temporarily in printer memory to output at a more convenient time at the printer. A print job is  
stored until you delete it from printer memory on the printer operator panel. You cannot use the password function with  
this feature. This function does not require a password to print a stored job.  
NOTE: This item is available when using the PCL or PS driver.  
Proof Print  
When you specify multiple copies for a collated job, this feature allows you to print only the first set for checking, before  
proceeding to print the remaining copies at the printer.  
NOTE: Depending on the documents, its job may be too big for the available memory. In this case, an error occurs.  
NOTE: If a document name is not assigned to your print job in the printer driver, the job's name will be identified  
using the PC's time and date of submission to distinguish it from other jobs you have stored under your name.  
NOTE: This item is available when using the PCL or PS driver.  
Storing Print Jobs  
When you select a job type other than "Normal Print" in the "Paper/Output" tab of the printer driver, the job will be stored  
in temporary memory or stored on the hard disk until you request to print it from the operator panel.  
NOTE: Secure Print and Private MailBox Print require specifying a password for confidentiality.  
Printing the Stored Jobs  
Once jobs are stored, you can use the operator panel to specify printing. Select the job type you are using from Secure  
Print, Private MailBox Print, Public MailBox Print, and Proof Print. Then, you select your user name from a list. Secure Print  
 
and Private MailBox Print require the password you specified in the driver when you sent the job.  
To print the stored documents, use the procedure below.  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
3. Press  
button until Print Menuis highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
button until your desirable job type is highlighted, and then press  
The stored document will be printed.  
Specifying your password on the operator panel (Secure  
Print/Private MailBox Print)  
When you select Secure Print or Private MailBox Print from the Print Menu after selecting your user name, the  
following prompt is displayed:  
[************]  
Use the buttons on the operator panel to enter the numeric password you specified in the printer driver. The password you  
entered will be displayed to ensure confidentiality.  
If you enter an invalid password, the message Wrong Password appears. Wait three seconds, or Press  
(Set) or Cancel  
button to return to the screen for user selection.  
When you enter a valid password, you have access to all print jobs matching the user name and password you entered.  
The print jobs matching the password you entered appear on the screen. You can then choose to print or delete jobs  
matching the password you entered. (See "Printing the Stored Jobs" for more information.)  
Deleting Stored Jobs  
With Secure Print, a job that has been stored will be deleted after printing or deleted at a designated time if entered on  
the operator panel.  
For other jobs, these jobs remain stored until you delete them on the operator panel.  
 
Printer Settings  
You can change most printer settings from your software program. If your printer is attached to the network, you can  
change settings from the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. To launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool,  
type the printer's IP address in your web browser. To find your printer's IP address, see "Printing a Printer Settings Page."  
Settings from the software program update the default printer settings for the printer. Settings from the printer driver  
only apply to the job you are sending to the printer.  
If you cannot change a setting from your software program, use the operator panel or the Dell Printer Configuration  
Web Tool. Changing a printer setting from the operator panel or the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool makes that  
setting the user default.  
Printing a Printer Settings Page  
You can verify the detailed printer settings by printing a printer settings page.  
When Using the Operator Panel  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
3. Printer Settings is displayed. Press  
(Set) button.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Settings Report tab.  
4. Select Reports.  
5. Click the Start button in the Printer Settings.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
Using the Operator Panel to Change Printer Settings  
     
You can select menu items and corresponding values from the operator panel.  
When you first enter the menus from the operator panel, you see a bullet next to a value in the menus.  
This bullet indicates the factory default menu setting. These settings are the original printer settings.  
Factory defaults may vary for different countries.  
When you select a new setting from the operator panel, a bullet appears next to the setting to identify it as the current  
user default menu setting.  
These settings are active until new ones are selected or the factory defaults are restored.  
To select a new value as a setting:  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
3. Press  
or  
or  
button until the desired menu is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until the desired menu or menu item is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
If the selection is a menu, the menu is opened and the first printer setting in the menu appears.  
If the selection is a menu item, the default menu setting for the menu item appears. (The current user  
default menu setting has a bullet beside it.)  
Each menu item has a list of values for the menu item. A value can be:  
A phrase or word to describe a setting  
A numerical value that can be changed  
An On or Off setting  
NOTE: Pressing  
and  
buttons at the same time will restore the factory default menu settings. Press  
(Set) button to return the settings to the factory default menu settings.  
4. Press  
5. Press  
or  
button until the desired value is highlighted.  
(Set) button.  
This enables the setting value, which is indicated by a bullet next to the setting value.  
6. Press Cancel or button to return to the previous menu.  
To continue setting other items, select the desired menu. To quit setting new values, press Cancel button.  
Driver settings may override changes previously made and may require you to change the operator panel defaults.  
Using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool to Change  
Printer Settings  
If your printer is connected to the network, you can change the device settings from your web browser. If you are a  
network administrator, you can clone the printer settings of one printer to one or all printers on the network.  
Type your printer's IP address in your web browser. Choose Printer Settings from the topics list, and then select the  
Printer Settings you want to change. To change the paper type and size, choose Tray Settings from the topics list. To  
change the ColorTrack settings, choose Print Volume from the topics list and select the Dell ColorTrack tab.  
To copy your printer settings to another printer on the network, choose Copy Printer Settings from the topics list, and  
then type the other printer's IP address.  
If you do not know your printer's IP address, see the printer settings page. To print the printer settings page using the  
operator panel:  
 
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Ensure Report/List is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
3. Printer Settings is displayed. Press  
(Set) button.  
The printer settings page is printed.  
Resetting Defaults  
After executing this function and rebooting the printer, all the menu parameters, except the parameters for the network,  
are reset to their default values.  
When Using the Operator Panel  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
3. Press  
4. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
button until Maintenance is highlighted, and then press  
button until Reset Defaults is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
5. Start or Cancel message appears on the operator panel. Press  
6. Turn off the printer, and then on again to apply the settings.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Maintenance tab.  
4. Select Reset Defaults from the list at the left side of the page.  
The Reset Defaults page is displayed.  
5. Click Start next to Reset Defaults and restart printer to reset to default values.  
The printer is turned off automatically to apply the settings.  
Initializing NVRAM for Network Settings  
You can initialize the IP address and network-related settings by initializing NVRAM for Network settings.  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
 
3. Ensure Network is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
4. Press button until Reset Wireless or Reset LAN is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
5. Start or Cancel message appears on the operator panel. Press  
(Set) button.  
6. Turn off the printer, and then on again to apply the settings.  
Understanding the Tool Box Menus  
The Tool Box allows you to diagnose the printer settings.  
NOTE: A Password dialog box appears the first time you try to change settings on Tool Box when Panel Lock is  
set on the printer. In this case, input the password you specified, and click OK to apply the settings.  
NOTE: For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your Printer Software."  
Chart Print  
Purpose:  
To output various charts that can be used for the printer's diagnosis.  
Values:  
Pitch  
Configuration  
Chart  
Clicking Pitch Configuration Chart button outputs full halftone pages for yellow, magenta, cyan,  
and black. Also outputs pages to check the pitch. The output report contains five pages and the paper  
size is A4 or Letter.  
Ghost  
Configuration  
Chart  
Clicking Ghost Configuration Chart button outputs a chart to check for ghost printing. The output  
report contains one page and the paper size is A4 or Letter.  
4 Colors  
Configuration  
Chart  
Clicking 4 Colors Configuration Chart button outputs bands of yellow, magenta, cyan, and black  
with varying density. The output report contains one page and the paper size is A4 or Letter.  
Clicking MQ Chart button outputs a chart to confirm the banding. The output report contains two  
pages and the paper size is A4 or Letter.  
MQ Chart  
Alignment  
Chart  
Clicking Alignment Chart button outputs a chart to check for proper alignment of the print image on  
the paper. The output report contains one page and the paper size is A4 or Letter.  
Drum Refresh  
Configuration  
Chart  
Clicking Drum Refresh Configuration Chart button outputs a chart to check the light fatigue of the  
drum cartridge. The output report contains one page and the paper size is A4 or Letter.  
Environment Sensor Info  
Purpose:  
To output the printer's internal environment sensor information to Result by pressing the Get Environment Sensor  
Info button.  
 
Understanding the Printer Menus  
When your printer is configured as a network printer available to a number of users, the access to the Admin Menumenus  
can be limited. This prevents other users from using the operator panel to inadvertently change a printer user default that  
has been set by the administrator. In this case, you can access the Stored Document, and Tray Settings menus only.  
However, you can use your printer driver to override printer user defaults and select settings for individual print jobs.  
To complete print jobs, you may also need to modify tray settings.  
Report/List  
Use the Report/List menu to print various types of reports and lists.  
Printer Settings  
Purpose:  
To print a list of the current user default values, the installed options, the amount of installed print memory, and the  
status of printer supplies.  
Panel Settings  
Purpose:  
To print a detailed list of all the settings on the operator panel menus.  
PCL Fonts List  
Purpose:  
To print a sample of the available PCL fonts.  
See also:  
PCL Macro List  
Purpose:  
To print the information on the downloaded PCL macro.  
PS Fonts List  
Purpose:  
To print a sample of the available PostScript fonts.  
   
See also:  
Job History  
Purpose:  
To print a detailed list of the print jobs that have been processed. This list contains the last 20 jobs.  
Error History  
Purpose:  
To print a detailed list of paper jams and fatal errors.  
Print Meter  
Purpose:  
To print the reports for the total number of pages printed. When printed using either the printer control panel or Dell  
Printer Configuration Web Tool, the report will be titled Print Volume Report.  
Color Test Page  
Purpose:  
To print a page for testing colors.  
Stored Document  
Purpose:  
To print a list of all files that are stored for Secure Print and Proof Print in the RAM disk.  
NOTE: The Stored Document is displayed only when the optional hard disk, or memory module is installed on the  
printer and RAM Disk under System Settings is enabled.  
Admin Menu  
Use the Admin Menu menu to configure a variety of printer features.  
Network  
Use the Network menu to change the printer settings affecting jobs sent to the printer through the wired or wireless  
network.  
NOTE: Values marked by an asterisk (*) are the factory default menu settings.  
Ethernet  
Purpose:  
To specify the communication speed and the duplex settings of Ethernet. The change becomes effective after the printer  
is turned off and then on again.  
 
Values:  
Auto*  
Detects the Ethernet settings automatically.  
Uses 10 base-T half-duplex.  
10Base Half  
10Base Full  
Uses 10 base-T full-duplex.  
100Base Half Uses 100 base-TX half-duplex.  
100Base Full Uses 100 base-TX full-duplex.  
1000Base Full Uses 1000 base-T full-duplex.  
Status  
Purpose:  
To display the information on the wireless signal strength. Any change cannot be made on the operator panel to improve  
the status of the wireless connection.  
Values:  
Good  
Indicates good signal strength.  
Acceptable  
Low  
Indicates marginal signal strength.  
Indicates insufficient signal strength.  
No Reception Indicates that no signal is received.  
NOTE: This item is available only when connecting the printer with a wired network.  
Wireless Setup  
Purpose:  
To configure the wireless network interface.  
Values:  
Enter  
Network  
(SSID)  
Specify a name to identify the wireless network. Up to 32 alphanumeric characters can be  
entered.  
Select when you configure the wireless setting through the access point such as a wireless  
router.  
No  
Security  
Specify No Security to configure the wireless setting without specifying a security  
method from WEP, WPA-PSK-TKIP, and WPA-PSK-AES.  
Manual  
Setup  
Specify the WEP 64bit Key to use through the wireless network. Up to 10  
hexadecimal characters can be entered.  
WEP Key  
Entry  
Infra-  
structure  
Transmit Specify the transmit key from WEP Key 1, WEP Key 2, WEP Key  
(64Bit)  
Key  
3, and WEP Key 4.  
Specify the WEP 128bit Key to use through the wireless network. Up to 26  
hexadecimal characters can be entered.  
WEP Key  
Entry  
Transmit Specify the transmit key from WEP Key 1, WEP Key 2, WEP Key  
(128Bit)  
Key  
3, and WEP Key 4.  
Select to configure the wireless setting with the security method of WPA-PSK-  
TKIP.  
WPA-PSK-  
TKIP  
Pass  
Specify the passphrase of alphanumeric characters from 8 to 63 only  
Phrase  
when WPA-PSK-TKIP is selected for Encryption.  
Infra-  
structure  
Select to configure the wireless setting with the security method of WPA2-PSK-  
AES.  
WPA2-  
PSK-AES  
Pass  
Specify the passphrase of alphanumeric characters from 8 to 63 only  
Phrase  
when WPA-PSK-AES is selected for Encryption.  
Select to configure the wireless setting without the access point such as a wireless router.  
Manual  
Setup  
No  
Select to configure the wireless setting without specifying the security method  
from WEP.  
Security  
Specify the WEP 64bit Key to use through the wireless network. Up to 10  
hexadecimal characters can be entered.  
WEP Key  
Entry  
Ad-hoc  
Transmit Specify the transmit key from WEP Key 1, WEP Key 2, WEP Key  
(64Bit)  
Key  
3, and WEP Key 4.  
Specify the WEP 128bit Key to use through the wireless network. Up to 26  
hexadecimal characters can be entered.  
WEP Key  
Entry  
Transmit Specify the transmit key from WEP Key 1, WEP Key 2, WEP Key  
(128Bit)  
Key  
3, and WEP Key 4.  
Push  
Button  
Control  
Cancel*  
Disables the security method of WPS-PBC.  
PBC Start  
Start  
Configures the wireless setting with the security method of WPS-PBC.  
Start  
Configu-  
ration  
WPS  
Configures the wireless setting using the PIN code assigned automatically by the  
printer.  
PIN Code  
Print PIN  
Code  
Prints PIN Code. Confirm it when entering PIN assigned to the printer into your  
computer.  
NOTE: This item is available only when connecting the printer with a wireless network.  
Reset Wireless  
Purpose:  
To initialize wireless network settings. After executing this function and rebooting the printer, all wireless network settings  
are reset to their default values.  
NOTE: This item is available only when connecting the printer with a wireless network.  
TCP/IP  
Purpose:  
To configure TCP/IP settings. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Values:  
Dual Stack*  
IPv4 Mode  
IPv6 Mode  
Uses both IPv4 and IPv6 to set the IP address.  
Uses IPv4 to set the IP address.  
IP  
Mode  
Uses IPv6 to set the IP address.  
AutoIP* Automatically sets the IP address.  
BOOTP  
RARP  
DHCP  
Panel  
Uses BOOTP to set the IP address.  
Get IP  
Address  
Uses RARP to set the IP address.  
Uses DHCP to set the IP address.  
IPv4  
Enables the IP address entered on the operator panel.  
Sets the IP address allocated to the printer by using the keys on the operator  
panel.  
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
Sets the subnet mask.  
Gateway Address  
Sets the gateway address.  
1
Disables IPsec.  
IPsec*  
1
* Only displayed when an optional network protocol adapter is installed and IPsec is enabled.  
Protocol  
Purpose:  
To enable or disable each protocol. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Values:  
Enable* Enables the LPD port.  
LPD  
Disable Disables the LPD port.  
Enable* Enables the Port9100 port.  
Port9100  
Disable Disables the Port9100 port.  
Enable* Enables the IPP port.  
IPP  
Disable Disables the IPP port.  
Enable* Enables FTP.  
FTP  
Disable Disables FTP.  
Enable* Uses IP for NetWare.  
NetWare  
Disable Does not use IP for NetWare.  
Enable* Enables the WSD port.  
WSD  
Disable Disables the WSD port.  
Enable* Enables the UDP.  
SNMP  
Disable Disables the UDP.  
Enable* Enables the E-mail Alerts feature.  
E-Mail Alert  
Disable Disables the E-mail Alerts feature.  
Enable* Enables an access to Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool embedded in the printer.  
EWS  
Disable Disables an access to Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool embedded in the printer.  
Enable* Enables the Bonjour(mDNS).  
Bonjour(mDNS)  
Disable Disables the Bonjour(mDNS).  
Enable* Enables the Telnet.  
Telnet  
Disable Disables the Telnet.  
Enable* Enables the HTTP-SSL/TLS.  
1
HTTP-SSL/TLS*  
Disable Disables the HTTP-SSL/TLS.  
1
* This item is displayed only when the self-signed certificate is generated.  
IP Filter  
Purpose:  
To block data received from certain IP addresses through the wired or wireless network. You can set up to five IP  
addresses. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Values:  
No. n/Address  
Sets the IP address for Filter n.  
1
(n is 1-5.)*  
No. n/Mask  
Sets the address mask for Filter n.  
1
(n is 1-5.)*  
Off*  
Disable the IP Filter feature for Filter n.  
1
Accept Accepts an access from the specified IP address.  
No. n/Mode (n is 1-5.)*  
 
Reject Rejects an access from the specified IP address.  
1
* This item is only available for LPD or Port9100.  
IEEE 802.1x  
Purpose:  
To disable the IEEE 802.1x authentication. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
NOTE: This item is displayed only when the IEEE 802.1x authentication is enabled.  
NOTE: This item is available only when connecting the printer with a wired network.  
Reset LAN  
Purpose:  
To initialize wired network data stored in NV (non-volatile) memory. After executing this function and rebooting the  
printer, all wired network settings are reset to their default values.  
Adobe Protocol  
Purpose:  
To specify PostScript communication protocol for a parallel interface, you can configure the Adobe Protocol settings for  
the wired network. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Values:  
Auto  
Used when auto-detecting the PostScript communication protocol.  
Standard Used when the communication protocol is in ASCII interface.  
BCP  
Used when the communication protocol is in binary format.  
Used when the communication protocol supports both ASCII and binary data to switch between them  
according to the specified control code.  
TBCP*  
Binary  
Used when no special processing is required for data.  
Parallel  
Use the Parallel menu to change the parallel interface.  
NOTE: Values marked by an asterisk (*) are the factory default menu settings.  
Parallel Port  
Purpose:  
To enable or disable the parallel interface. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Values:  
Disable The parallel interface is disabled.  
Enable* The parallel interface is enabled.  
ECP  
 
Purpose:  
To specify the ECP communication mode of the parallel interface. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned  
off and then on again.  
Values:  
Disable ECP communication mode is disabled.  
Enable* ECP communication mode is enabled.  
Adobe Protocol  
Purpose:  
To specify PostScript communication protocol for parallel interface. You can configure the Adobe Protocol settings for  
parallel port. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Values:  
Auto  
Used when auto-detecting the PostScript communication protocol.  
Standard Used when the communication protocol is in ASCII interface.  
BCP  
Used when the communication protocol is in binary format.  
Used when the communication protocol supports both ASCII and binary data to switch between them  
according to the specified control code.  
TBCP*  
Binary  
Used when no special processing is required for data.  
USB Settings  
Use the USB Settings menu to change printer settings affecting a USB port.  
NOTE: Values marked by an asterisk (*) are the factory default menu settings.  
USB Port  
Purpose:  
To enable or disable the USB interface. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Values:  
Disable The USB interface is disabled.  
Enable* The USB interface is enabled.  
Adobe Protocol  
Purpose:  
To specify PostScript communication protocol for USB interface. You can configure the Adobe Protocol settings for USB.  
The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Values:  
Auto  
Used when auto-detecting the PostScript communication protocol.  
Standard Used when the communication protocol is in ASCII interface.  
BCP  
Used when the communication protocol is in binary format.  
Used when the communication protocol supports both ASCII and binary data to switch between them  
according to the specified control code.  
TBCP*  
Binary  
Used when no special processing is required for data.  
System Settings  
Use the System Settings menu to configure a variety of printer features.  
NOTE: Values marked by an asterisk (*) are the factory default menu settings.  
PowerSaver Time  
Purpose:  
To specify the time for transition to power saver mode.  
Values:  
15 min.*  
Sleep  
Specifies the time for transition to the power saver time (Sleep) in minutes.  
Specifies the time for transition to the power saver time (Deep Sleep) in minutes.  
5-30 min.  
15 min.*  
1-29 min.  
Deep Sleep  
Enter 5 to put the printer in power saver mode five minutes after it finishes a job. This uses much less energy, but  
requires more warm-up time for the printer. Enter 5 if your printer shares an electrical circuit with room lighting and you  
notice lights flickering.  
Select a high value if your printer is in constant use. Under most circumstances, this keeps the printer ready to operate  
with minimum warm-up time. Select a value between 5 and 30 minutes for power save mode if you want a balance  
between energy consumption and a shorter warm-up period.  
The printer automatically returns to the standby mode from the power saver mode when it receives data from the  
computer or remote fax printer. You can also return the printer to the standby mode by pressing any button on the  
operator panel.  
Audio Tones  
Purpose:  
To configure settings for tones emitted by the printer during operation or when a warning message appears.  
Values:  
Off* Does not emit a tone when the operator panel input is correct.  
Control  
Panel  
On  
Off* Does not emit a tone when the operator panel input is incorrect.  
On Emits a tone when the operator panel input is incorrect.  
Off* Does not emit a tone when the printer becomes ready.  
On Emits a tone when the printer becomes ready.  
Off* Does not emit a tone when a job is complete.  
On Emits a tone when a job is complete.  
Off* Does not emit a tone when a job ends abnormally.  
On Emits a tone when a job ends abnormally.  
Off* Does not emit a tone when a problem occurs.  
On Emits a tone when a problem occurs.  
Off* Does not emit a tone when the printer runs out of paper.  
On Emits a tone when the printer runs out of paper.  
Emits a tone when the operator panel input is correct.  
Invalid Key  
Machine  
Ready  
Job  
Completed  
Fault Tone  
Alert Tone  
Out of Paper  
Off* Does not emit a tone when toner or some other consumable is low.  
Low Toner  
Alert  
On  
Emits a tone when toner or some other consumable is low.  
Does not emit a tone when the operator panel display is returned to the default settings by  
scrolling the loop menu.  
Off*  
Base Tone  
Emits a tone when the operator panel display is returned to the default settings by scrolling the  
loop menu.  
On  
Fault Time-Out  
Purpose:  
To specify in seconds the amount of time the printer should cancel for a job stops abnormally. The print job is cancelled if  
the time-out time is exceeded.  
Values:  
Off Disables the fault time-out.  
60 sec.*  
On  
Specifies the amount of time the printer cancels for a job stops abnormally.  
6-300 sec.  
Job Time-Out  
Purpose:  
To specify in seconds the amount of time the printer should wait for data to arrive from the computer. The print job is  
cancelled if the time-out time is exceeded.  
Values:  
Off Disables the job time-out.  
30 sec.*  
On  
Specifies the amount of time the printer should wait for data to arrive from the computer.  
5-300 sec.  
Panel Language  
Purpose:  
To determine the language of the text on the operator panel screen.  
Values:  
English*  
Italiano  
Español  
Français  
Deutsch  
Dansk  
Nederlands Norsk  
Svenska  
Auto Log Print  
Purpose:  
To automatically print a log of completed jobs after every 20 jobs.  
Values:  
Off* Does not automatically output a log of completed jobs.  
On  
Automatically outputs a log of completed jobs.  
Print logs can also be printed using the Report/List menu.  
NOTE: Restart your printer when you change the settings for the RAM Disk menu.  
Print ID  
Purpose:  
To specify a location where the user ID is printed.  
Values:  
Off*  
Does not print the user ID.  
Top Left  
Top Right  
Bottom Left  
Prints the user ID on the top left of the page.  
Prints the user ID on the top right of the page.  
Prints the user ID on the bottom left of the page.  
Bottom Right Prints the user ID on the bottom right of the page.  
NOTE: When printing on DL size paper, a part of the user ID may not be printed correctly.  
Print Text  
Purpose:  
To specify whether the printer outputs PDL data, which is not supported by the printer, as text when the printer receives  
it. Text data is printed on A4 or Letter size paper.  
Values:  
On* Prints the received data as text data.  
Off Does not print the received data.  
Banner Sheet  
Purpose:  
To specify the position of banner sheet, and also specify the tray in which the banner sheet is loaded. This feature is  
available for the PCL driver but is not available for the PS driver.  
Values:  
Off*  
Does not print the banner sheet.  
Front  
Back  
Inserted before the first page of every copy.  
Inserted after the last page of every copy.  
Insert Position  
Front & Back Inserted before the first page of every copy and after the last page of every copy.  
Tray 1*  
Tray 2*  
Tray 3*  
Tray 4*  
The banner sheet is loaded in the first tray from the top.  
The banner sheet is loaded in the second tray from the top.  
1
1
2
2
The banner sheet is loaded in the third tray from the top.  
The banner sheet is loaded in the fourth tray from the top.  
Specify Tray  
The banner sheet is loaded in the fifth tray from the top.  
The banner sheet is loaded in multipurpose feeder (MPF).  
Tray 5*  
MPF  
1
* This item is displayed only when an optional 550-sheet feeder or 1100-sheet feeder is installed on the printer.  
2
* This item is displayed only when an optional 1100-sheet feeder is installed on the printer.  
RAM Disk  
Purpose:  
To allocate memory to the RAM disk file system for the Secure Print, Proof Print, and Mailbox Print features. The change  
becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Values:  
Enable  
Allocate memory to the RAM disk file system.  
Does not allocate memory to the RAM disk file system. Secure Print and Proof Print jobs will abort and be  
recorded to the job log.  
Disable  
500MB*  
Specifies the amount of memory to allocate to the RAM disk file system. (50 MB step)  
50-  
1000MB  
NOTE: The RAM Disk menu is displayed only when memory module is installed on the printer.  
NOTE: Restart your printer when you change the settings for the RAM Disk menu.  
Date & Time  
Purpose:  
To set the date and time, and regional time zone of the printer.  
Values:  
Set Date Specifies the date of the printer with the date format; yy/mm/dd,  
mm/dd/yy, or dd/mm/yy.  
Set Time Specifies the time of the printer on 12 Hour Clock or 24 Hour Clock.  
Date  
Format  
dd/mm/yy*  
yy/mm/dd  
mm/dd/yy  
12 Hour Clock  
24 Hour* Clock  
UTC -12:00  
UTC -11:00  
UTC -10:00  
UTC -09:00  
UTC -08:00  
UTC -07:00  
UTC -06:00  
UTC -05:00  
UTC -04:00  
Specifies the date format; dd/mm/yy.  
Specifies the date format; yy/mm/dd.  
Specifies the date format; mm/dd/yy.  
Specifies the date format; 12 Hour Clock.  
Specifies the date format; 24 Hour Clock.  
Time  
Format  
Time  
Zone  
UTC -03:30  
UTC -03:00  
UTC -02:00  
UTC -01:00  
UTC 00:00*  
UTC +01:00  
UTC +02:00  
UTC +03:00  
UTC +03:30  
UTC +04:00  
UTC +04:30  
UTC +05:00  
UTC +05:30  
UTC +05:45  
UTC +06:00  
UTC +06:30  
UTC +07:00  
UTC +08:00  
UTC +09:00  
UTC +09:30  
UTC +10:00  
UTC +11:00  
UTC +12:00  
UTC +13:00  
Substitute Tray  
Purpose:  
To specify whether or not to use another size paper when the paper that is loaded in the specified tray does not match the  
 
paper size settings for the current job.  
Values:  
Off  
No tray size substitute accepted.  
Substitutes paper of next largest size. When there is no larger paper size, the printer substitutes paper of  
nearest size.  
Larger Size  
Nearest  
Size*  
Substitutes paper of nearest size.  
Substitutes paper from the MPF.  
MPF Feed  
mm/inch  
Purpose:  
To specify the default measurement unit displayed after the numeric value on the operator panel.  
Values:  
millimeter (mm) Selects millimeter as the default measurement unit.  
inch (")  
Selects inch as the default measurement unit.  
NOTE: The default for mm/inch varies depending on other settings, such as Country and Document Size.  
Set Available Time  
Purpose:  
To specify the time period when printing is available.  
Values:  
Off* Does not specify the time period when printing is available.  
Specifies the time period when printing is available.  
Start Time Specifies the start time of the time period when printing is available.  
On  
End Time  
Specifies the end time of the time period when printing is available.  
Recurrence Specifies the day of the week to repeat the setting.  
Data Encryption  
Purpose:  
To disable or enable data encryption when using the printer.  
Values:  
Off* Disables to encrypt the data.  
Encryption  
On  
Enables to encrypt the data.  
Encryption Key Sets a key that is required to encrypt.  
NOTE: You can enter only characters from 0 to 9, a to z, A to Z, and NULL values for encryption key.  
HDD Overwrite Mode  
Purpose:  
To select to overwrite the hard disk drive and the number of times you can overwrite the disk.  
Values:  
Off*  
Disables to overwrite the hard disk drive.  
1Time Overwrites the hard disk drive once.  
3Times Overwrites the hard disk drive 3 times.  
NOTE: This item is available only when the optional hard disk drive is installed.  
Secure Job Expiration  
Purpose:  
To specify the date and time to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk drive.  
Values:  
Does not specify the date and time to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM  
disk or the hard disk drive.  
Off*  
Expiration  
Mode  
Specifies the date and time to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or  
the hard disk drive.  
On  
Expiration  
Time  
Specifies the time to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk drive.  
Specifies to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk drive  
daily.  
Daily  
Specifies to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk drive  
weekly.  
Recurrence  
Weekly*  
Monthly  
Monday*  
Tuesday  
Wednesday  
Thursday  
Friday  
Specifies to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk drive  
monthly.  
Specifies to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk on  
Mondays.  
Specifies to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk on  
Tuesdays.  
Specifies to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk on  
Wednesdays.  
Weekly  
Settings  
Specifies to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk on  
Thursdays.  
Specifies to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk on  
Fridays.  
Specifies to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk on  
Saturdays.  
Saturday  
Sunday  
Specifies to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk on  
Sundays.  
Specifies to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk or the hard disk on the  
first day of the month.  
1 Day*  
Monthly  
Settings  
Specifies the day of the month to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk  
or the hard disk.  
2-28 Day  
NOTICE: This item is available only when the RAM disk is on or the optional hard disk is installed.  
ColorTrack Mode  
Purpose:  
To specify which users have access to color printing and to limit print volume per user.  
Values:  
Off*  
Enables to print the data with no authentication information.  
Internal Mode Restricts printing based on the print user information registered in the internal server.  
External Mode Restricts printing based on the print user information registered in the external server.  
No Account User Print  
Purpose:  
To specify whether to permit the printing of data with no authentication information.  
Values:  
Off*  
Rejects printing the data with no authentication.  
Permits printing the data with no authentication.  
1
On*  
1
* Set No Account User Password using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
ColorTrack Error Report  
Purpose:  
To specify whether to print the error report on the ColorTrack.  
Values:  
Off* Not print the content of a printer output error for a ColorTrack.  
On  
Print the content of a printer output error for a ColorTrack.  
Letterhead Duplex Mode  
Purpose:  
To enable or disable duplex printing when using letterhead paper.  
Values:  
Disable* Disables duplex printing for letterhead paper.  
Enable  
Enables duplex printing for letterhead paper.  
Low Toner Alert Msg  
Purpose:  
To turn Off or On the alert message when toner is low.  
Values:  
Off Shows no alert message when the toner is low.  
On* Shows the alert message when the toner is low.  
Job Offset  
Purpose:  
To identify one paper set from another set by offsetting the output paper.  
Values:  
Off*  
Disables to offset the output paper.  
Offset per Set Offsets each copy before printing the next copy.  
Offset per Job Offsets each copy per paper job you specify.  
NOTE: This item is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
Banner Sheet Offset  
Purpose:  
To specify whether to offset the output paper, and insert a banner sheet before the first page of each copy.  
Values:  
Off* Disables to insert the banner sheet after offsetting the output paper.  
On  
Enables to insert the banner sheet after offsetting the output paper.  
NOTE: This item is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
Job Offset of Staple  
Purpose:  
To offset the output paper, and specify whether to staple each copy.  
Values:  
Off  
Disables to staple each copy after offsetting the output paper.  
Offset per Set* Enables to staple each copy after offsetting the output paper.  
Offset per Job Enables to staple per paper job after offsetting the output paper.  
NOTE: This item is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
Stapler Cart. Empty  
Purpose:  
To specify whether to continue a print job when the stapler cartridge is empty.  
Values:  
Not Continue* Stops the print job when the stapler cartridge is empty.  
Continue  
Continues the print job when the stapler cartridge is empty.  
NOTE: This item is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
Power On Wizard  
Purpose:  
To perform initial setup for the printer.  
Maintenance  
Use the Maintenance menu to initialize the NV (non-volatile) memory, configure the plain paper quality adjustment  
settings, and configure the security settings.  
NOTE: Values marked by an asterisk (*) are the factory default menu settings.  
F/W Version  
Purpose:  
To display the printer's firmware version.  
Service Tag  
Purpose:  
To display the printer's service tag.  
Paper Density  
Purpose:  
To specify paper density settings.  
Values:  
Normal*  
Plain  
Light  
Normal*  
Label  
Light  
Adjust BTR  
NOTICE: The print quality changes depending on the setting values you select for this item.  
Purpose:  
To specify the optimum voltage settings for printing for the transfer roller (BTR). To lower the voltage, set negative  
values. To increase, set positive values.  
The default settings may not give the best output on all paper types. If you see mottles on the print output, try to  
increase the voltage. If you see white spots on the print output, try to decrease the voltage.  
Values:  
0*  
Plain  
(60 to 90 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Plain Thick  
(80/90 to 105 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Transparency  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Covers  
(106 to 163 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Covers Thick  
(164 to 216 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Label  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Coated  
(106 to 163 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Coated Thick  
(164 to 216 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Envelope  
Recycled  
-6 - +6  
0*  
-6 - +6  
Adjust Fuser  
Purpose:  
To specify the optimum temperature settings for printing for the fuser. To lower the temperature, set negative values. To  
increase, set positive values.  
The default settings may not give the best output on all paper types. When the printed paper has curled, try to lower the  
temperature. When the toner does not fuse on the paper properly, try to increase the temperature.  
Values:  
0*  
Plain  
(60 to 90 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Plain Thick  
(80/90 to 105 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Transparency  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Covers  
(106 to 163 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Covers Thick  
(164 to 216 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Label  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Coated  
(106 to 163 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Coated Thick  
(164 to 216 gsm)  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Envelope  
-6 - +6  
0*  
Recycled  
-6 - +6  
Auto Registration Adjustment  
Purpose:  
To specify whether to automatically perform color registration adjustment.  
Values:  
On* Automatically performs color registration adjustment.  
Off Does not automatically perform color registration adjustment.  
Color Registration Adjustment  
Purpose:  
To specify whether to manually perform color registration adjustment.  
Manual Color Registration Adjustments are required such as when the printer is initially installed and after the printer is  
moved.  
NOTE: The Color Registration Adjustment feature can be configured when Auto Registration Adjustment is set to  
Off.  
Values:  
Auto  
Correct  
Automatically performs color registration correction.  
Prints a color registration chart. The color registration chart prints a lattice pattern of yellow, magenta, and  
ColorRegi cyan lines. On the chart, find the values on the right side that are next to the straightest lines for each of  
Chart  
the three colors. If the value for the straightest line is 0, color registration adjustment is not required. If the  
value for the straightest line is any value other than 0, specify the adjustment values under Enter Number.  
0*  
LeftYellow  
LeftMagenta  
LeftCyan  
Specifies the values that are found in the color registration chart for Left Yellow.  
-5 -  
+5  
0*  
Specifies the values that are found in the color registration chart for Left  
Magenta.  
-5 -  
+5  
0*  
Specifies the values that are found in the color registration chart for Left Cyan.  
Specifies the values that are found in the color registration chart for Right Yellow.  
-5 -  
+5  
Enter  
Number  
0*  
RightYellow  
RightMagenta  
RightCyan  
-5 -  
+5  
0*  
Specifies the values that are found in the color registration chart for Right  
Magenta.  
-5 -  
+5  
0*  
Specifies the values that are found in the color registration chart for Right Cyan.  
-5 -  
+5  
Adjust Altitude  
Purpose:  
To specify the altitude of the location where the printer is installed.  
The discharge phenomenon for charging the photo conductor varies with barometric pressure. Adjustments are performed  
by specifying the altitude of the location where the printer is being used.  
NOTICE: An incorrect altitude adjustment setting leads to poor printing quality, incorrect indication of remaining  
toner, etc.  
Values:  
0m*  
1000m  
2000m Specifies the altitude of the location where the printer is installed.  
3000m  
4000m  
Initialize PrintMeter  
Purpose:  
To initialize the print meter of the printer. When the print meter is initialized, the meter count is reset to 0.  
Reset Defaults  
Purpose:  
To initialize the NV (non-volatile) memory. After executing this function and rebooting the printer, all the menu  
parameters, except the parameters for the network, are reset to their default values.  
Clear Storage  
Purpose:  
To clear all files stored as Secure Print, Mailbox Print, Proof Print and Stored Print in the RAM disk or the optional hard  
disk.  
Values:  
Deletes all files stored as Secure Print, Mailbox Print, and Proof Print in the RAM disk or the optional  
hard disk.  
All Clear  
Secure  
Document  
Deletes all files stored as Secure Print and Mailbox Print in the RAM disk or the optional hard disk.  
Stored  
Document  
Clears all files stored as Stored Print in the RAM disk or the optional hard disk.  
NOTE: This item is available only when the RAM disk is on or the optional hard disk is installed.  
Format HDD  
Purpose:  
To initialize the optional hard disk.  
NOTE: The Format HDD menu is displayed only when an optional hard disk is installed on your printer.  
Non-Dell Toner  
Purpose:  
To specify whether or not to use another manufacturer's toner cartridge.  
NOTE: Before you use another manufacture's toner cartridge, be sure to restart the printer.  
NOTICE: Use of a non-Dell toner cartridge may result in some of the printer's functions to be unavailable, a  
reduction in print quality, or deterioration of printer's reliability. Use of a new Dell brand toner cartridge is  
recommended for your printer. The Dell warranty does not cover any problems caused by the use of any accessory,  
part, or component that is not supplied by Dell.  
Values:  
Off* Does not use another manufacturer's toner cartridge.  
On  
Uses another manufacturer's toner cartridge.  
PCL  
Use the PCL menu to change printer settings that only affect jobs using the PCL emulation printer language.  
NOTE: Values marked by an asterisk (*) are the factory default menu settings.  
Paper Tray  
Purpose:  
To specify the input tray.  
Values:  
Auto*  
Automatically selects a tray according to the paper size and type settings of the printing job.  
The paper is fed from the first tray from the top.  
Tray 1  
1
1
2
2
The paper is fed from the second tray from the top.  
The paper is fed from the third tray from the top.  
The paper is fed from the fourth tray from the top.  
Tray 2*  
Tray 3*  
Tray 4*  
The paper is fed from the fifth tray from the top.  
The paper is fed from the MPF.  
Tray 5*  
MPF  
1
* This item is displayed only when an optional 550-sheet feeder or 1100-sheet feeder is installed on the printer.  
2
* This item is displayed only when an optional 1100-sheet feeder is installed on the printer.  
Paper Size  
Purpose:  
To specify the default paper size.  
Values:  
1
A4*  
B5  
8.5x13"  
Executive  
DL  
Envelope #10  
A5  
1
Letter*  
Legal  
Monarch  
C5  
210 mm*/8.3 inch*  
X Size  
Specifies the width of the custom size paper.  
77 - 215 mm/3.0-8.5 inches  
Custom Size  
297 mm*/11.7 inch*  
Y Size  
Specifies the length of the custom size paper.  
127 - 355 mm/5.0-14.0 inches  
1
* Denotes country-specific factory default values.  
NOTE: Selecting a custom size for the paper size prompts you to enter a custom length and width.  
210 mm*/8.3 inch*  
Specifies the width of the custom size paper.  
77 - 215 mm/3.0-8.5 inches  
Orientation  
Purpose:  
To specify how text and graphics are oriented on the page.  
Values:  
Portrait*  
Prints text and graphics parallel to the short edge of the paper.  
Landscape Prints text and graphics parallel to the long edge of the paper.  
2 Sided  
Purpose:  
To set duplexing as the default for all print jobs. (Select Duplex from the printer driver to duplex only specific jobs.)  
Values:  
Off*  
Prints on one side of the paper.  
Prints on both sides of the paper.  
2 Sided  
Print  
On  
Flip Long  
Edge*  
Assumes binding along the long edge of the page. (Left edge for portrait orientation and top  
edge for landscape orientation)  
Binding  
Edge  
Flip Short  
Edge  
Assumes binding along the short edge of the page. (Top edge for portrait orientation and left  
edge for landscape orientation)  
Font  
Purpose:  
To specify the default font from the fonts registered in the printer.  
Values:  
CG Times  
CG Times It  
Univers Md  
CG Times Bd  
Univers MdIt  
Univers MdCd  
Univers BdCdIt  
AntiqueOlv Bd  
CG Omega Bd  
CG Times BdIt  
Univers Bd  
Univers BdIt  
Univers BdCd  
AntiqueOlv It  
CG Omega It  
Univers MdCdIt  
AntiqueOlv  
CG Omega  
CG Omega BdIt  
Garamond Hlb  
Courier It  
GaramondAntiqua Garamond Krsv  
GaramondKrsvHlb Courier*  
Courier Bd  
Courier BdIt  
LetterGothic  
LetterGothic It  
LetterGothic Bd  
 
Albertus Md  
Coronet  
Albertus XBd  
Marigold  
Clarendon Cd  
Arial  
Arial It  
Arial Bd  
Arial BdIt  
Times New  
Times New BdIt  
Line Printer  
Times Bd  
Times New It  
Symbol  
Times New Bd  
Wingdings  
Times Roman  
Times BdIt  
Helvetica Bd  
CourierPS Ob  
SymbolPS  
Times It  
Helvetica  
Helvetica Ob  
CourierPS  
Helvetica BdOb  
CourierPS Bd  
Palatino Roman  
Palatino BdIt  
CourierPS BdOb  
Palatino It  
ITCBookman Lt  
Palatino Bd  
ITCBookman LtIt ITCBookmanDm  
ITCBookmanDm It HelveticaNr  
HelveticaNr Ob  
N C Schbk Roman  
N C Schbk BdIt  
ITC A G Go Dm  
ZapfDingbats  
HelveticaNr Bd  
N C Schbk It  
HelveticaNrBdOb  
N C Schbk Bd  
ITC A G Go Bk  
ITC A G Go BkOb  
ITC A G Go DmOb ZapfC MdIt  
Symbol Set  
Purpose:  
To specify a symbol set for a specified font.  
Values:  
ROMAN-8* ISO L1  
ISO L2  
PC-8  
ISO L5  
ISO L6  
PC-8 DN  
PC-852  
WIN L1  
DESKTOP  
MS PUB  
PI FONT  
ISO-6  
PC-775  
PC-1004  
WIN L2  
PS TEXT  
MATH-8  
LEGAL  
PC-850  
PC-8 TK  
WIN L5  
MC TEXT  
PS MATH  
ISO-4  
ISO-11  
ISO-21  
WIN 3.0  
ISO-15  
ISO-60  
WINBALT  
ISO-17  
ISO-69  
SYMBOL  
WINGDINGS DNGBTSMS  
Font Size  
Purpose:  
To specify the font size for scalable typographic fonts.  
Values:  
12.00*  
Specify the values in increments of 0.25.  
4.00 - 50.00  
Font size refers to the height of the characters in the font. One point equals approximately 1/72 of an inch.  
NOTE: The Font Size menu is only displayed for typographic fonts.  
See also:  
Font Pitch  
Purpose:  
To specify the font pitch for scalable monospaced fonts.  
Values:  
10.00*  
Specify the value in increments of 0.01.  
6.00-24.00  
Font pitch refers to the number of fixed-space characters in a horizontal inch of type. For nonscalable monospaced fonts,  
the pitch is displayed, but cannot be changed.  
NOTE: The Font Pitch menu is only displayed for fixed or monospaced fonts.  
See also:  
Form Line  
Purpose:  
To set the number of lines in a page.  
Values:  
1
64*  
Specify the value in increments of 1.  
5-128  
1
* Denotes country-specific factory default values.  
The printer sets the amount of space between each line (vertical line spacing) based on the Form Lineand Orientation  
menu items. Select the correct Form Lineand Orientation before changing Form Line.  
See also:  
Quantity  
Purpose:  
To set the default print quantity. (Set the number of copies required for a specific job from the printer driver. Values  
selected from the printer driver always override values selected from the operator panel.)  
Values:  
1*  
Specify the value in increments of 1.  
1-999  
Image Enhancement  
Purpose:  
To specify whether to perform the image enhancement feature. Image enhancement is a feature that makes the boundary  
line between black and white smoother to decrease jagged edges and enhance the visual appearance.  
Values:  
Off Disables the Image Enhancement feature.  
On* Enables the Image Enhancement feature.  
Hex Dump  
Purpose:  
To help isolate the source of a print job problem. With Hex Dump selected, all data sent to the printer is printed in  
hexadecimal and character representation. Control codes are not executed.  
Values:  
Disable* Disables the Hex Dump feature.  
Enable  
Enables the Hex Dump feature.  
Draft Mode  
Purpose:  
To save toner by printing in the draft mode. The print quality is reduced when printing in the draft mode.  
Values:  
Disable* Does not print in the draft mode.  
Enable  
Prints in the draft mode.  
LineTermination  
Purpose:  
To add the line termination commands.  
Values:  
The line termination command is not added.  
CR=CR, LF=LF, FF=FF  
Off*  
The LF command is added.  
CR=CR-LF, LF=LF, FF=FF  
Add-LF  
Add-CR  
CR-XX  
The CR command is added.  
CR=CR, LF=CR-LF, FF=CR-FF  
The CR and LF commands are added.  
CR=CR-LF, LF=CR-LF, FF=CR-FF  
Default Color  
Purpose:  
To specify the color mode to Color or Black. This setting is used for a print job which does not specify a print mode.  
Value:  
Black* Prints in the black and white mode.  
Color Prints in the color mode.  
PostScript  
Use the PostScript menu to change printer settings that only affect jobs using the PostScript emulation printer language.  
NOTE: Values marked by an asterisk (*) are the factory default menu settings.  
PS Error Report  
Purpose:  
To specify whether the printer outputs error contents for a PostScript error. The change becomes effective after the  
printer is turned off and then on again.  
Values:  
Off Discards the print job without printing an error message.  
On* Prints an error message before it discards the job.  
NOTE: This instructions from the PS driver override the settings specified on the operator panel.  
PS Job Time-Out  
Purpose:  
To specify the execution time for one PostScript job. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then  
on again.  
Values:  
Off* Job time-out does not occur.  
On  
1-900 min. A PostScript error occurs if processing is not completed after the specified time.  
PaperSelectMode  
Purpose:  
To specify the way to select the tray for PostScript mode. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and  
then on again.  
Values:  
Auto*  
The tray is selected as the same setting as in the PCL mode.  
Select from Tray The tray is selected in a method compatible with regular Post Script printers.  
Default Color  
Purpose:  
To specify the color mode to Color or Black. This setting is used for a print job which does not specify a print mode.  
Value:  
Black Prints in the black and white mode.  
Color* Prints in the color mode.  
Panel Settings  
Use the Panel Settings menu to set a password to limit access to the menus. This prevents items from being changed  
accidentally.  
NOTE: Values marked by an asterisk (*) are the factory default menu settings.  
See also:  
Panel Lock  
Purpose:  
To limit access to the menus.  
Values:  
Disable* Does not limit access to the menus.  
Enable  
Limits access to the menus.  
New Password  
Purpose:  
To set a password to limit access to the menus.  
Values:  
0000*  
Sets or changes the password required to access Admin Menu and Report/List.  
0000-9999  
Re-enter Password  
Purpose:  
To re-enter your password for confirmation.  
Login Error  
Purpose:  
To specify the number of error entry attempts allowed when logging in as administrator in the Admin Menuand  
Report/List.  
Values:  
Off The administrator cannot access Admin Menu and Report/List. after he fails to log in.  
5 times*  
On  
Sets the error time when the administrator logs in Admin Menu and Report/List.  
1 - 10 times  
Tray Settings  
Use the Tray Settings menu to define the print media loaded in each tray.  
 
NOTE: Values marked by an asterisk (*) are the factory default menu settings.  
MPF  
Purpose:  
To specify the paper loaded in the MPF.  
Values:  
Plain (60 to 90 gsm)*  
Plain Thick (80/90 to 105 gsm)  
Transparency  
Covers (106 to 163 gsm)  
Covers Thick (164 to 216 gsm)  
Label  
Coated (106 to 163 gsm)  
Coated Thick (164 to 216 gsm)  
Envelope  
Paper  
Type  
Recycled  
Letter Head  
1
Plain S2 (60 to 90 gsm)*  
1
Plain Thick S2 (80/90 to 105 gsm)*  
1
Covers S2 (106 to 163 gsm)*  
1
Covers Thick S2 (164 to 216 gsm)*  
1
Coated S2 (106 to 163 gsm)*  
1
Coated Thick S2 (164 to 216 gsm)*  
1
Recycled S2*  
Use Driver Settings*  
A4  
A5  
B5  
Letter  
8.5x13"  
Legal  
Executive  
Monarch  
DL  
Paper  
Size  
C5  
Envelope #10  
210 mm*/8.3 inch*  
X Size  
Y Size  
Specifies the width of the custom size paper.  
Specifies the length of the custom size paper.  
77 - 215 mm/3.0-8.5 inches  
297 mm*/11.7 inch*  
Custom  
Size  
127 - 355 mm/5.0-14.0 inches  
Panel  
Stop printing and show an error on the operator panel if the paper specified from the printer  
driver does not match the paper configured for the MPF from the operator panel.  
Specified  
Driver  
MPF  
Mode  
Continue to print even if the paper specified from the printer driver does not match the paper  
Specified* configured for the MPF from the operator panel.  
Specifies the size and type of paper loaded in the MPF. This item is available only when Panel  
Specifiedis selected for MPF Mode.  
On*  
Display  
Popup  
Size and type of paper loaded in the MPF is not specified. This item is available only when Panel  
Specifiedis selected for MPF Mode.  
Off  
1
* S2 indicates papers whose one side has been printed already.  
NOTE: For the tray 1, optional 550-sheet feeder, or optional 1100-sheet feeder setting paper size is not required.  
These trays detect the paper size automatically. For more information on supported paper size for the standard and  
optional trays, see "Supported Paper Sizes."  
Use this menu item to:  
Optimize print quality for the specified paper.  
Select paper source through your software program by selecting type and size.  
Automatically link trays. The printer automatically links any trays containing the same type and size of paper, if you  
have set the Paper Typeto the correct values.  
Tray 1  
Purpose:  
To specify the paper loaded in the top tray.  
Values:  
Plain(60 to 90 gsm)*  
Plain Thick (80/90 to 105 gsm)  
Transparency  
Covers(106 to 163 gsm)  
Covers Thick (164 to 216g sm)  
Paper Type Label  
Coated (106 to 163 gsm)  
Coated Thick (164 to 216 gsm)  
Envelope  
Recycled  
Letter Head  
Auto*  
Monarch  
DL  
C5  
Paper Size Envelope #10  
210 mm*/8.3 inch*  
X Size  
Specifies the width of the custom size paper.  
Specifies the length of the custom size paper.  
77 - 215 mm/3.0-8.5 inches  
297 mm*/11.7 inch*  
Custom Size  
Y Size  
127 - 355 mm/5.0-14.0 inches  
Tray 2  
Purpose:  
To specify the paper loaded in the second tray from the top.  
Values:  
Plain(60 to 90 gsm)*  
Plain Thick (80/90 to 105 gsm)  
Covers (106 to 163 gsm)  
Paper Type  
Covers Thick (164 to 216g sm)  
Recycled  
Letter Head  
Auto*  
Monarch  
DL  
C5  
Paper Size Envelope #10  
210 mm*/8.3 inch*  
X Size  
Specifies the width of the custom size paper.  
Specifies the length of the custom size paper.  
77 - 215 mm/3.0-8.5 inches  
Custom Size  
297 mm*/11.7 inch*  
Y Size  
127 - 355 mm/5.0-14.0 inches  
Tray 3  
Purpose:  
To specify the paper loaded in the third tray from the top.  
Values:  
Plain (60 to 90 gsm)*  
Plain Thick (80/90 to 105 gsm)  
Covers (106 to 163 gsm)  
Paper Type  
Covers Thick (164 to 216g sm)  
Recycled  
Letter Head  
Auto*  
Monarch  
DL  
C5  
Paper Size Envelope #10  
210 mm*/8.3 inch*  
X Size  
Specifies the width of the custom size paper.  
Specifies the length of the custom size paper.  
77 - 215 mm/3.0-8.5 inches  
Custom Size  
297 mm*/11.7 inch*  
Y Size  
127 - 355 mm/5.0-14.0 inches  
Tray 4  
Purpose:  
To specify the paper loaded in the fourth tray from the top.  
Values:  
Plain (60 to 90 gsm)*  
Plain Thick (80/90 to 105 gsm)  
Covers (106 to 163 gsm)  
Paper Type  
Covers Thick (164 to 216g sm)  
Recycled  
Letter Head  
Auto*  
Monarch  
DL  
C5  
Paper Size Envelope #10  
210 mm*/8.3 inch*  
X Size  
Specifies the width of the custom size paper.  
Specifies the length of the custom size paper.  
77 - 215 mm/3.0-8.5 inches  
Custom Size  
297 mm*/11.7 inch*  
Y Size  
127 - 355 mm/5.0-14.0 inches  
Tray 5  
Purpose:  
To specify the paper loaded in the fifth tray from the top.  
Values:  
Plain (60 to 90 gsm)*  
Plain Thick (80/90 to 105 gsm)  
Covers (106 to 163 gsm)  
Paper Type  
Covers Thick (164 to 216g sm)  
Recycled  
Letter Head  
Auto*  
Monarch  
DL  
C5  
Paper Size Envelope #10  
210 mm*/8.3 inch*  
X Size  
Specifies the width of the custom size paper.  
Specifies the length of the custom size paper.  
77 - 215 mm/3.0-8.5 inches  
Custom Size  
297 mm*/11.7 inch*  
Y Size  
127 - 355 mm/5.0-14.0 inches  
Print Menu  
The Print Menuprovides document storing services with Secure Print, Private Mailbox Print, Public Mailbox Print, and  
Proof Print.  
NOTE: The Print Menu is displayed only when the RAM disk is set to on or the optional hard disk is installed.  
Secure Print  
Purpose:  
To specify printing and deleting the stored document.  
Values:  
Enter the password you specified on the printer driver.  
Print and Delete Deletes all documents from print memory after printing them.  
All  
Select User  
ID  
Document  
Delete  
Print and Delete Deletes the specified document from print memory after printing it.  
Delete Deletes the specified document from print memory.  
Deletes all documents from print memory.  
document n  
(n is number)  
Private Mailbox  
Purpose:  
To specify printing and deleting the stored document.  
Values:  
Enter the password you specified on the printer driver.  
Print and Delete Deletes all documents from print memory after printing them.  
All  
Document  
Print  
Prints all documents and save them in memory.  
Deletes all documents from print memory.  
Select User  
ID  
Delete  
Print and Delete Deletes the specified document from print memory after printing it.  
document n  
Print  
Prints the specified document and save it in memory.  
Deletes the specified document from print memory.  
(n is number)  
Delete  
Public Mailbox  
Purpose:  
To specify printing and deleting the stored document.  
Values:  
Enter the password you specified on the printer driver.  
Print and Delete Deletes all documents from print memory after printing them.  
All  
Document  
Print  
Prints all documents and save them in memory.  
Deletes all documents from print memory.  
Select User  
ID  
Delete  
Print and Delete Deletes the specified document from print memory after printing it.  
document n  
Print  
Prints the specified document and save it in memory.  
Deletes the specified document from print memory.  
(n is number)  
Delete  
 
Proof Print  
Purpose:  
To specify printing and deleting the stored document.  
Values:  
Enter the password you specified on the printer driver.  
Print and Delete Deletes all documents from print memory after printing them.  
All  
Document  
Print  
Prints all documents and save them in memory.  
Deletes all documents from print memory.  
Select User  
ID  
Delete  
Print and Delete Deletes the specified document from print memory after printing it.  
document n  
Print  
Prints the specified document and save it in memory.  
Deletes the specified document from print memory.  
(n is number)  
Delete  
Panel Lock  
This feature prevents unauthorized personnel from changing settings made by the administrator. For regular printing,  
items can be selected from the menu and printer settings remain unchanged. For regular printing, items can be  
configured using the printer driver.  
NOTE: Disabling the operator panel menus does not prevent access to the Stored Print and Tray Settings menus.  
Enabling the Panel Lock  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
button until Panel Settings is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until Enable is highlighted, and then press  
6. Enter the new password, and then press (Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
3. Press  
(Set) button.  
4. Panel Lockis displayed. Press  
5. Press  
(Set) button.  
7. Re-enter the password to confirm the password that you entered, and then press  
The password has been changed.  
(Set) button.  
NOTE: If you forget your password, turn off the printer. Then, while holding Menu button, turn on the printer.  
Perform steps 6 to 7 to reset the password. This will recover the factory default panel password.  
NOTE: If you change the password while Panel Lock is Enable, follow the following steps. Perform steps 1 and 2.  
Press  
button until Change Password is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button. Perform steps 6 and 7 to  
change the password. This will change the password.  
NOTE: If Panel Lock is Enable, the factory-default panel password is 0000.  
See also:  
Disabling the Panel Lock  
 
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
3. Enter the password, and then press  
(Set) button.  
4. Press  
5. Panel Lockis displayed. Press  
6. Press button until Disable is highlighted, and then press  
7. Enter the current password, and then press (Set) button.  
button until Panel Settings is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
8. Re-enter the password to confirm the password that you entered, and then press  
The setting has been changed.  
(Set) button.  
Understanding Your Printer Software  
Use the Drivers and Utilities CD that came with your printer to install a combination of software programs, depending on  
your operating system.  
The following software programs can only operate on Windows. They cannot operate on Macintosh, UNIX, or Linux.  
Status Window  
The Status Window alerts you when an error or warning occurs, for example, when a paper jam occurs or toner is  
running low.  
You can specify when or whether the Status Window appears in the Printing Status Window Properties dialog box.  
Open this dialog box from the start menu or by right-clicking the Status Monitor Console icon.  
The available selections are as below.  
Value  
Function  
Activate window  
during printing  
Activates the Status Window whenever printing. The window closes  
automatically when all print jobs finish or are cancelled.  
Activate window only  
Activates the Status Window only when an error occurs during  
when an error occurs* printing. The window closes automatically when the error is cleared.  
Do not activate  
automatically  
Does not automatically activate the Status Window.  
* factory default setting  
You can also check toner level, quantity of paper remaining, and status of other consumables for the local and network  
printer.  
Status Monitor Console  
Use the Status Monitor Console to manage multiple Status Window.  
Select a printer from the list view (or Printer Selection) by clicking its name to open a Status Window for a  
particular printer.  
The Status Monitor Console displays the Status Window for local and network connections.  
Dell Supplies Management System™  
You can launch the Dell Supplies Management System dialog box from the printing status window (for the local printer  
only), the All Programs menu, or the desktop icon. You can also launch it from the Status Window when a toner error  
occurs.  
You can order consumables by phone or from the web.  
1. Click start® All Programs® Dell Printers® Additional Color Laser Software® Dell Supplies Management  
System.  
The Dell Supplies Management System window appears.  
2. Select your printer from the Select Printer Model list.  
3. If you are ordering from the Web:  
   
a. When you cannot get information from the printer automatically by two-way communication, a window that  
prompts you to type the Service Tag appears. Type your Dell printer Service Tag in the field provided.  
Your Service Tag is located inside the front cover of your printer.  
b. Select a URL from the Select Reorder URL list.  
c. Click Visit Dell printer supplies ordering web site.  
4. If ordering by phone, call the number that appears under the Order by Phone heading.  
User Setup Disk Creating Tool  
The User Setup Disk Creating Tool program located in the MakeDisk folder of the Utilities folder on the Drivers and  
Utilities CD and the printer drivers located on the Drivers and Utilities CD are used to create driver installation packages  
that contain custom driver settings. A driver installation package can contain a group of saved printer driver settings and  
other data for things such as:  
Print orientation and Multiple Up (document settings)  
Watermarks  
Font references  
If you want to install the printer driver with the same settings to multiple computers running the same operating system,  
create a setup disk in a floppy disk or in a server on the network. Using the setup disk that you have created will reduce  
the amount of work required when installing the printer driver.  
Install in advance the Dell™ 5130cdn Color Laser Printer printer driver in the computer on which the setup disk is to  
be created.  
The setup disk can only be used on the operating system on which the disk was created or computers running the  
same operating system. Create a separate setup disk for different types of operating systems.  
Software Update  
The firmware and/or driver updates can be downloaded from the Dell Support website located at support.dell.com.  
Printer Settings Utility  
Using the Quick Launch Utility window, you can open Status Window, Updater, and Troubleshooting.  
When you install the Dell software, the Quick Launch Utility is automatically installed.  
For information about installing the software, see "Setting Up for Shared Printing."  
To open the Quick Launch Utility window:  
1. Click start ® All Programs® Dell Printers® Additional Color Laser Software ® Quick Launch Utility.  
The Quick Launch Utility dialog box opens.  
 
2. The Quick Launch Utility window provides three buttons; Status Window, Updater, and Troubleshooting.  
To exit, click the X button at the top-right of the window.  
For details, click the Help button of each application.  
Status Window  
The Status Window button opens the Status Window. See "Status Window."  
Updater  
The Updater button updates the settings for the printer driver, firmware and service software.  
Troubleshooting  
The Troubleshooting button opens the Troubleshooting Guide, which allows you to recover problems by yourself.  
Tool Box  
You can use the Tool Box to diagnose the printer settings. For details on the settings, see "Understanding the Tool Box  
Menus."  
NOTE: The Tool Box is available only when you connect the printer with USB or network connection.  
To start the Tool Box.  
1. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD into your computer.  
When the Easy Setup Navigator window appears, click the Exit button to close the window.  
2. Click start ® Run, and then type D:\Utilities\Tool Box\DLT12DZ.exe (where D is the drive letter of your CD),  
and then click OK.  
The dialog box prompting you to select the type of connection appears.  
3. Select the type of connection between your computer and printer.  
For network connection  
a. Select Network Connection.  
b. Enter the IP address or host name of your printer.  
NOTE: The scope ID is necessary when you enter the IPv6 address.  
 
For USB connection  
a. Select USB Connection.  
b. In the list on the Select Printer screen, select the target printer that you diagnose printer settings for.  
4. Click OK.  
The Tool Box starts.  
Printing Using ColorTrack (External Authentication)  
With ColorTrack, you can restrict the number of pages that can be printed per user, specify the users who can print in  
color, and restrict the users who can access the printer, based on the user information registered on the external  
authentication server or the printer.  
To print using ColorTrack, you must set ColorTrack Settings and the printer driver. Also, you must set the external server  
with ColorTrack for using an external authentication server. To set the external server, consult your system administrator.  
ColorTrack Settings  
To print using ColorTrack, configure the following settings.  
Dell ColorTrack  
Specify the authentication method.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Print Volume.  
3. Click the Dell ColorTrack tab.  
Select External Mode for ColorTrack Mode.  
Check the No Account User Print check box when you permit the printing of data with no authentication  
information. If not, remove the check mark from the No Account User Print check box.  
Enter the password when the No Account User Print check box is On and External Mode is selected.  
Then, re-enter the password to confirm the password that you entered.  
Check the ColorTrack Error Report check box, if necessary.  
4. Click the Apply New settings button, and then turn off the printer to apply the settings.  
     
When Using the Operator Panel  
You can specify only the settings of ColorTrack Mode, No Account User Print, and ColorTrack Error Report using  
the operator Panel.  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
3. Press  
4. Press  
5. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until System Settings is highlighted, and then press  
button until ColorTrack Modeis highlighted, and then press  
button until External Modeis highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
6. Press Cancel or  
button to return to the previous menu.  
button until No Account User Print is highlighted, and then press  
button to select Off or On, and then press (Set) button.  
button to return to the previous menu.  
button until ColorTrack Error Report is highlighted, and then press  
button to select Off or On, and then press (Set) button.  
7. Press  
8. Press  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
9. Press Cancel or  
10. Press  
11. Press  
12. Turn off the printer to apply the settings.  
ColorTrack Mode  
The following two authentication modes are available: the Internal Mode using user information registered on the printer,  
and the External Mode using user information registered on an external server. To authenticate on the external  
authentication server with External Mode, you need not register user information on the printer. The change becomes  
effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
No Account User Print  
Specify whether to permit the printing of data with no authentication information. This setting is enabled when the printer  
is restarted. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
No-account User Password  
Specify the password to be used for non-account user using 1 to 127 alphanumeric characters. If the password is left  
blank (NULL), you cannot log in to a server. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on  
again.  
NOTE: When External Mode is specified and No Account User Print is set to On, you must set a password.  
NOTE: When using an LDAP server, you also must set the same password on the server.  
Re-enter No-account User Password  
Enter the No-account user password again to confirm it.  
ColorTrack Error Report  
Specify whether to automatically print error-related information if printing using ColorTrack results in an error.  
Setup Remote Authentication  
Click Setup Remote Authentication Page to display the Authentication System page.  
NOTE: This item is displayed only when External Mode is specified.  
Authentication System  
Specify the server authentication type, the server response time-out, or the search time-out.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Security tab.  
4. Select Authentication System.  
Authentication System page is displayed.  
Select the authentication system for Authentication System Settings.  
Specify the time-out period for Server Response Time-Out.  
Specify the time-out period for Search Time-Out.  
5. Click the Apply New settings button, and then turn off the printer to apply the settings.  
Authentication System Settings  
Select the authentication system from the list. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on  
again.  
Server Response Time-Out  
Specify the amount of time the printer should wait for response from the server. Set the time period from 1 up to 75  
seconds. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Search Time-Out  
Specify the amount of time the printer should wait for searching for the server. Set the time period from 5 up to 120  
seconds. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Kerberos Server  
   
Specify the settings for the Kerberos Server.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Security tab.  
4. Select Kerberos Server.  
5. Enter the primary server name or IP address, and the port address in Primary Server Name / IP Address &  
Port.  
6. Enter the secondary server name or IP address, and the port address in Secondary Server Name / IP Address  
& Port if necessary.  
7. Enter the domain name in Domain Name.  
8. Click the Apply New settings button, and then turn off the printer to apply the settings.  
Primary Server Name / IP Address & Port  
Specify the primary server name or IP address, and the port address. The change becomes effective after the printer is  
turned off and then on again.  
NOTICE: Do not use the same port address as that of another port.  
NOTE: The port address must be 88 or between 5,000 and 65,535. The default value is 88.  
NOTE: Specify the IP address in the nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn format for IPv4. Each section of "nnn" is a variable value  
between 0 and 255.  
NOTE: Specify the IP address in the xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx format for IPv6. Each section of  
"xxxx" is a hexadecimal variable value.  
Secondary Server Name / IP Address & Port  
Specify the secondary server name or IP address, and the port address, as necessary. The change becomes effective after  
the printer is turned off and then on again.  
NOTICE: Do not use the same port address as that of another port.  
NOTICE: Set the secondary server after setting the primary server.  
NOTE: The port address must be 88 or between 5,000 and 65,535.The default value is 88.  
NOTE: Specify the IP address in the nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn format for IPv4. Each section of "nnn" is a variable value  
between 0 and 255.  
NOTE: Specify the IP address in the xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx format for IPv6. Each section of  
"xxxx" is a hexadecimal variable value.  
Domain Name  
®
Specify the domain name of the Active Directory in Domain Name (Realm Name). The change becomes effective after  
the printer is turned off and then on again.  
NOTE: Specify the domain name with uppercase characters. Depending on your server, an error may occur if you  
specify the domain name with lowercase characters.  
LDAP Server  
Specify the directory server and the authentication method to execute LDAP authentication or to acquire information using  
LDAP, and specify the range and attributes for searching.  
NOTE: When using LDAPS or certificate verification, you must set the LDAP server or import an external certificate.  
For more information, see "Using Digital Certificates."  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Security tab.  
4. Select LDAP Server.  
Enter the IP address or the host name, and the port address in IP Address / Host Name & Port.  
Enter the backup IP address or the host name, and the port address in Backup IP Address / Host Name  
& Port.  
Confirm the software information for LDAP Server.  
Enter a text string in Search Directory Root.  
Enter the login name in Login Name.  
Enter the password in Password. Then, re-enter the password to confirm the password that you entered.  
Specify the time-out period for Search Time-Out.  
5. Click the Apply New settings button, and then turn off the printer to apply the settings.  
Server Information  
IP Address / Host Name & Port  
Specify the IP address or the host name, and the port address. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned  
off and then on again.  
NOTICE: Do not use the same port address as that of another port.  
NOTE: The port address must be 389, 636 or between 5,000 and 65,535. The default value is 389. When using  
LDAPS, normally specify 636.  
NOTE: Specify the IP address in the nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn format for IPv4. Each section of "nnn" is a variable value  
between 0 and 255.  
NOTE: Specify the IP address in the xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx format for IPv6. Each section of  
 
"xxxx" is a hexadecimal variable value.  
Backup IP Address / Host Name & Port  
Specify the backup IP address or the host name, and the port address, as necessary. Specify the backup IP address or the  
host name, and the port address after specifying the IP Address / Host Name & Port. The change becomes effective  
after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
NOTICE: Do not use the same port address as that of another port.  
NOTICE: Set the backup server after setting the main server.  
NOTE: The port address must be 389, 636 or between 5,000 and 65,535. The default value is 389. When using  
LDAPS, normally specify 636.  
NOTE: Specify the IP address in the nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn format for IPv4. Each section of "nnn" is a variable value  
between 0 and 255.  
NOTE: Specify the IP address in the xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx format for IPv6. Each section of  
"xxxx" is a hexadecimal variable value.  
LDAP Server  
Displays the current software information of the LDAP server.  
Operation Information  
Search Directory Root  
Specify a text string as the origin of the search when using LDAP communication. The change becomes effective after the  
printer is turned off and then on again.  
For example: ou=colortrackv3,dc=win2003ad,dc=colortrack.dc=net  
Login Name  
Specify the login name for accessing the directory server with LDAP authentication. Specify the name of a user with the  
authority to update the LDAP server. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Password  
Specify the password for accessing the directory server with LDAP authentication. Specify the password of a user with the  
authority to update the LDAP server using 1 to 127 alphanumeric characters. If the password is left blank (NULL), you  
cannot log in to a server. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Re-enter-Password  
Enter the password again to confirm it.  
Search Time-Out  
Specify the amount of time the printer should wait for searching for the server. To specify a time-out period for searching,  
select Wait, and set the time period from 5 up to 120 seconds. To not specify a time-out period, select the Wait LDAP  
Server Limit. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
 
LDAP Authentication  
Specify the LDAP server authentication method.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Security tab.  
4. Select LDAP Authentication.  
Confirm the authentication method.  
When adding a text string to the UserID, specify Enable for Use Added Text String.  
When specifying Enable for Use Added Text String, enter the additional text string in Text String Added  
to User Name.  
5. Click the Apply New settings button, and then turn off the printer to apply the settings.  
Authentication Method  
Displays the current LDAP authentication method. Direct Authentication executes server authentication with the UserID  
and password entered.  
Use Added Text String  
Specify whether to add a text string to the UserID. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then  
on again.  
Text String Added to User Name  
When using an added string for the user name, specify the text string to be added.  
For example: if the user name is "[email protected]", normally you must enter "[email protected]".  
However if Use Added Text String is set to Enable, and "@myhost.example.com" is specified in Text String Added to  
User Name, only the data "abcde" must be entered with the printer driver, thus simplifying the entry task.  
The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again.  
Setting the Printer Driver  
To print using ColorTrack, set the printer driver. Once set, the settings of the printer driver are enabled until they are  
changed.  
1. Open the Properties of the printer driver.  
2. Configure the following settings from the Configuration tab.  
 
Dell ColorTrack Mode  
Specify whether to allow general users to change settings related to authentication or whether general users must use the  
settings configured by the Administrator.  
Specify Group Name  
Specify the name of the belonging group to use when authenticating. If you specify a group that does not belong,  
authentication fails and the data is not printed. Also, the default group is set if Specify Group Name is not specified.  
Specify Job Owner  
Select Use Login Name to use the user information logged into your PC, and select Enter ID to enter the user name  
yourself.  
Job Owner Name  
Specify the user name to use when authenticating with an external server. You can enter this only when selecting Enter  
ID for Specify Job Owner.  
Password  
Specify the user password to use when authenticating with an external server.  
Using Digital Certificates  
The authentication feature using digital certificates upgrades security when sending print data or setting data.  
This chapter describes how to manage digital certificates as follows.  
NOTE: The external certificate management described above is enabled only when the optional hard disk is  
installed and is set to On for Encryption.  
NOTE: For information about digital certificate error, see "Understanding Printer Messages" and "Digital Certificate  
Problem."  
Managing Certificates  
Preparing  
Changing Encryption Setting  
Some items are effective only when On is selected for Encryption. Change the encryption setting to On and set a key that  
is required to encrypt, if necessary.  
NOTICE: All files stored on the optional hard disk are cleared when changing the encryption setting.  
NOTE: You can enter only characters from 0 to 9, a to z, A to Z, and NULL values for encryption key.  
When Using the Operator Panel  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
3. Press  
4. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until System settings is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
button until Data Encryption is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
5. Encryption is displayed. Press  
(Set) button.  
6. Press button until On is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
7. The cursor is located at the first digit of the encryption key. Press  
encryption key.  
or  
button to enter the numbers for the  
   
8. Press  
(Set) button. The cursor moves to the next digit.  
9. Repeat steps 7 and 8 to enter all of the digits, and then press  
(Set) button.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Settings tab.  
4. Select Secure Settings.  
5. Click Data Encryption.  
The Data Encryption page is displayed.  
6. Select the Encryption check box.  
7. Enter a key that is required to encrypt.  
8. Re-enter the key again to confirm it.  
9. Click the Apply New Settings button.  
Setting HTTPS Communication  
Before managing certificates, set HTTPS communication with a self-signed certificate.  
NOTE: Set HTTPS communication after changing the Encryption setting to On.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Security tab.  
4. Select SSL/TLS.  
5. Click the Generate Self-Signed Certificate button of Machine Digital Certificate. The Generate Self-Signed  
Certificate page is displayed.  
6. Select the size of public key from the list of Size of Public Key.  
7. Specifies the issuer of SSL self-signed certificate.  
8. Click the Generate Signed Certificate button.  
9. The Restart Printer button is displayed after generating the self-signed certificate, and then click the Restart  
Printer button.  
10. Repeat steps 2 to 4 to display the SSL/TLS page after restarting the printer.  
11. If the self-signed certificate is set correctly, since the HTTP- SL/TLS Communication column is set to Enable  
and a check box is displayed, select Enable.  
Importing a Digital Certificate  
NOTICE: Before importing a certificate file, back up the certificate file.  
NOTE: Be sure to import the certificate with Internet Explorer.  
NOTE: After importing a PKCS#12 format certificate, the secret key is not exported even if you execute exporting.  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Security tab.  
4. Select SSL/TLS.  
5. Click the Upload Signed Certificate button of Machine Digital Certificate.  
The Upload Signed Certificate page is displayed.  
NOTE: The Upload Signed Certificate button is displayed only when the optional hard disk is installed and  
is set to On for encryption.  
6. Enter a password.  
7. Re-enter the password again to confirm it.  
8. Press the Browse button of File Name, and select the file to be imported.  
9. Press the Import button to import the certificate.  
Setting a Digital Certificate  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Security tab.  
4. Select SSL/TLS.  
5. Click the Certificate Management button to display the Certificate Management page.  
   
NOTE: The Certificate Management button is displayed only when the optional hard disk is installed and is  
set to On for encryption.  
6. When setting a Wireless LAN (Server) certificate, select Trusted Certificate Authorities within Category.  
When setting a certificate of SSL Server, SSL Client, or IPsec, select Local Device.  
7. Select the purpose of use from the Certificate Purpose list.  
8. Click the Display the List button to display the Certificate List page.  
NOTE: If the list includes more than 20 certificates, press the Next button to display the next page.  
9. Select the certificate to associate. At this time, confirm that Validity of the certificate selected is set to Valid.  
10. Click the Certificate Details button to display the Certificate Details page.  
11. Confirm the content, and press the Use This Certificate button at the upper-right corner.  
Confirming the Settings of a Digital Certificate  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Security tab.  
4. Select SSL/TLS.  
5. Click the Certificate Management button to display the Certificate Management page.  
NOTE: The Certificate Management button is displayed only when the optional hard disk is installed and is  
set to On for encryption.  
6. Select the category from the Category list.  
7. Select the purpose of use from the Certificate Purpose list.  
8. Click the Display the List button to display the Certificate List page.  
NOTE: If the list includes more than 20 certificates, press the Next button to display the next page.  
9. The certificate displayed with an asterisk as "*Valid" in the Validity column is the certificate associated with the  
use purpose and actually used.  
Deleting a Digital Certificate  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
   
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Security tab.  
4. Select SSL/TLS.  
5. Click the Certificate Management button to display the Certificate Management page.  
NOTE: The Certificate Management button is displayed only when the optional hard disk is installed and is  
set to On for encryption.  
6. Select the category from the Category list.  
7. Select the purpose of use from the Certificate Purpose list.  
8. Click the Display the List button to display the Certificate List page.  
NOTE: If the list includes more than 20 certificates, press the Next button to display the next page.  
9. Select the certificate to be deleted.  
10. Click the Certificate Details button to display the Certificate Details page.  
11. To delete the selected certificate, press the Delete button at the upper- right corner.  
NOTE: When a certificate is deleted, the features associated with the deleted certificate are disabled. To  
delete a certificate being used, either set the feature to OFF in advance or switch the association to another  
certificate, and then switch to another operation mode if possible before deleting the certificate.  
For an SSL Server, switch to another certificate such as a self-signed certificate.  
For an SSL Client, set the LDAP-SSL/TLS setting to OFF.  
For IPsec, change the IKE setting to Pre-Shared Key or set the feature to OFF.  
For Wireless LAN, change the Wireless Security setting to other than WPA-Enterprise before deleting the  
certificate.  
Exporting a Digital Certificate  
NOTE: Since the secret key is not exported, an imported PKCS#12 format certificate can be exported only as a  
PKCS#7 certificate.  
1. Launch Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool.  
a. Open the web browser.  
b. Enter the IP address of your printer in the web browser.  
2. Select Print Server Settings.  
3. Click the Security tab.  
4. Select SSL/TLS.  
5. Click the Certificate Management button to display the Certificate Management page.  
NOTE: The Certificate Management button is displayed only when the optional hard disk is installed and is set to  
On for encryption.  
 
6. Select the category from the Category list.  
7. Select the purpose of use from the Certificate Purpose list.  
Click the Display the List button to display the Certificate List page.  
NOTE: If the list includes more than 20 certificates, press the Next button to display the next page.  
8. Select the certificate to be exported.  
9. Click the Certificate Details button to display the Certificate Details page.  
10. To export the selected certificate, press the Export This Certificate button.  
Setting the Features  
Setting the Certificate in the IPsec Digital Signature Mode  
1. Import the certificate to be used with IPsec. For more information, see "Importing a Digital Certificate."  
2. Set the certificate to be used with IPsec. For more information, see "Setting a Digital Certificate."  
3. Confirm whether the certificate is set correctly in IPsec. For more information, see "Confirming the Settings of a  
4. Select Print Server Settings from the left side of the page.  
5. Click the Security tab.  
6. Select IPsec.  
7. Select Enable for Protocol.  
8. Select Digital Signature from the IKE list.  
9. Set each item, as necessary.  
10. Click the Apply New Settings button.  
11. After restarting the printer, IPsec communication using digital signatures is enabled. You can execute IPsec  
communication (Digital Signature Mode) between the printer and the network device (such as PC) on which the  
certificate and IPsec are set identically as on this device.  
Setting the SSL-use Server Certificate (HTTP/IPP)  
1. Import the certificate to be used with the SSL-use server. For more information, see "Importing a Digital  
2. Set the certificate to be used with the SSL-use server. For more information, see "Setting a Digital Certificate."  
3. Confirm whether the certificate is set correctly. For more information, see "Confirming the Settings of a Digital  
NOTE: Confirm whether the newly set certificate, not the self-signed certificate, is associated.  
4. After restarting the printer, the certificate set as described above is used as the server certificate when executing  
communication with HTTP/IPP- SSL/TLS.  
   
Setting LDAP-SSL/TLS Communication  
1. Displays the SSL/TLS page.  
2. Select Enable for LDAP-SSL/TLS Communication.  
3. After restarting the printer, LDAP-SSL/TLS Communication is enabled.  
NOTE: This setting is available only when the optional hard disk is installed and is set to On for encryption.  
NOTE: When executing the certificate validity of the server and the presentation of the client certificate, see  
Setting Server Certificate Verification for LDAP-SSL/TLS  
Communication  
1. Import the root certificate (including intermediate certificate) for the LDAP server certificate. For more information,  
NOTE: In the verification of a certificate of the connected server, to automatically search for an imported  
certificate and verify the path, the certificate does not need to be associated.  
2. Confirm whether the root certificate is correctly imported to the LDAP server. For more information, see  
3. Select SSL/TLS.  
4. Select Enable of Verify Remote Server Certificate.  
5. After restarting the printer, the certificate presented by the LDAP server is verified when LDAP-SSL/TLS  
communication starts with the LDAP server.  
NOTE: This setting is available only when the optional hard disk is installed and is set to On for encryption.  
NOTE: This feature is enabled only when Enable is set for LDAP-SSL/TLS Communication.  
NOTE: When the result of verification is NG, communication is not established and an error results.  
Setting Client Certificate for LDAP-SSL/TLS Communication  
1. Import a certificate to be used with SSL Client. For more information, see "Importing a Digital Certificate."  
2. Set a certificate to be used with SSL Client. For more information, see "Setting a Digital Certificate."  
3. Confirm whether the certificate is set correctly. For more information, see "Confirming the Settings of a Digital  
4. After restarting the printer, the LDAP client certificate is presented when LDAP-SSL/TLS communication with the  
LDAP server starts. When the LDAP server is set to require a client certificate, the client certificate provided by the  
printer is verified by the LDAP server.  
NOTE: This setting is available only when the optional hard disk is installed and is set to On for encryption.  
NOTE: This feature is enabled only when Enable is set for LDAP-SSL/TLS Communication.  
Setting for Wireless LAN WPA-Enterprise  
1. Import the certificate to be used with Wireless LAN. For more information, see "Importing a Digital Certificate."  
   
2. Set the certificate to be used with Wireless LAN. For more information, see "Setting a Digital Certificate."  
3. Confirm whether the certificate is set correctly. For more information, see "Confirming the Settings of a Digital  
4. Click the Print Server Settings tab.  
5. Select Wireless LAN.  
6. Select either of the following items from the list of Encryption of Secure Settings.  
WPA-Enterprise-AES/WPA2-Enterprise-AES  
WPA-Enterprise-TKIP  
7. Set Login Name, EAP-Identity, and Password of WPA-Enterprise.  
NOTE: This setting is available only when the optional hard disk is installed and is set to On for encryption.  
Understanding Fonts  
Typefaces and Fonts  
A font is a set of characters and symbols created with a distinct design. The distinct design is called a typeface. The  
typefaces you select add personality to a document. Well-chosen typefaces make a document easier to read.  
The printer has numerous resident fonts in PCL 5/PCL 6 and PostScript 3. See "Resident Fonts" for a listing of all resident  
fonts.  
Weight and Style  
Typefaces are often available in different weights and styles. These variations modify the original typeface so you can, for  
example, emphasize important words in text or highlight book titles. The different weights and styles are designed to  
complement the original typeface.  
Weight refers to the thickness of the lines that form the characters. Thicker lines result in darker characters. Some words  
commonly used to describe the weight of a typeface are bold, medium, light, black, and heavy.  
Style refers to other typeface modifications, such as tilt or character width. Italic and oblique are styles where the  
characters are tilted. Narrow, condensed, and extended are three common styles that modify the character widths.  
Some fonts combine several weight and style modifications; for example, Helvetica BdOb. A group of several weight and  
style variations of a single typeface is called a typeface family. Most typeface families have four variations: regular, italic  
(oblique), bold, and bold italic (bold oblique). Some families have more variations, as the following illustration for the  
Helvetica typeface family shows:  
Pitch and Point Size  
The size of a font is specified as either a pitch or point size, depending on whether the font is fixed space or proportional.  
In fixed space fonts, each character has the same width. Pitch is used to specify the size of fixed space fonts. It is a  
measure of the number of characters that will print in one horizontal inch of type. For example, all 10-pitch fonts print 10  
characters per inch (cpi) and all 12-pitch fonts print 12 cpi:  
     
In proportional (or typographic) fonts, every character can have a different width. Since proportional fonts have  
characters with different widths, the font size is specified in point size, not pitch. Point size refers to the height of the  
characters in the font. A point is defined as 1/72 inch. The characters in a font printed at 24 point will be twice as large as  
the characters in the same font printed at 12 point.  
The following illustration shows samples of a font printed in different point sizes:  
The point size of a font is defined as the distance from the top of the tallest character in the font to the bottom of the  
lowest character in the font. Due to the definition of point size, different fonts printed at the same point size may appear  
quite different in size. This is because there are other font parameters that affect how the font looks. However, the point  
size of a font is an excellent specification of the relative size of a font. The following examples illustrate two very different  
proportional fonts at 14 point:  
Bitmapped and Scalable Fonts  
The printer uses both bitmapped and scalable fonts.  
Bitmapped fonts are stored in print memory as predefined patterns of bits that represent a typeface at a specific size,  
style, and resolution. The following illustration shows an example of a character from a bitmapped font.  
Bitmapped fonts are available in different type styles and point sizes as downloadable fonts.  
Scalable fonts (also called outline fonts) are stored as computer programs that define the outlines of the characters in the  
font. Each time you print characters from a scalable font, the printer creates a bitmap of the characters at the point size  
you choose and saves it temporarily in print memory.  
These temporary bitmapped fonts are deleted when you turn off or reset the printer. Scalable fonts provide the flexibility  
of printing in many different point sizes.  
Your printer uses different scalable font formats for downloading fonts to the printer. PCL 5/PCL 6 uses Intellifont and  
TrueType scalable fonts. PostScript 3 uses Type 1 and TrueType scalable fonts. There are thousands of different scalable  
fonts available in these different font formats from numerous font suppliers.  
 
If you plan to use many downloadable bitmapped or scalable fonts or if you plan to use many different sizes of scalable  
fonts, you may need to purchase additional memory for your printer.  
Resident Fonts  
Your printer is equipped with resident fonts stored permanently in print memory. Different fonts are available in PCL  
5/PCL 6 and PostScript 3. Some of the most popular typefaces, like Courier and TimesNew (PCL 5/PCL 6)/Times New  
Roman (PostScript 3), are available for all printer languages.  
The following table lists all the fonts resident in your printer. See "Printing a Font Sample List" for instructions on how to  
print samples of the fonts. You can select the resident fonts from your software program. You can also select the fonts  
from the operator panel if you are using PCL 5.  
Resident bitmapped and scalable fonts  
PCL 5/PCL 6  
CG Times  
PostScript 3  
Albertus  
CG Times It  
Albertus Italic  
Albertus Light  
CG Times Bd  
CG Times BdIt  
Antique Olive Roman  
Antique Olive Italic  
Antique Olive Bold  
Antique Olive Compact  
Apple Chancery  
Univers Md  
Univers MdIt  
Univers Bd  
Univers BdIt  
Univers MdCd  
Univers MdCdIt  
Univers BdCd  
Univers BdCdIt  
Arial  
Arial Italic  
Arial Bold  
Arial Bold Italic  
ITC Avant Garde Gothic Book  
ITC Avant Garde Gothic Book Oblique  
ITC Avant Garde Gothic Demi  
ITC AvantGarde Gothic Demi Oblique  
Bodoni Roman  
AntiqueOlv  
AntiqueOlv It  
AntiqueOlv Bd  
CG Omega  
Bodoni Italic  
CG Omega It  
CG Omega Bd  
CG Omega BdIt  
Bodoni Bold  
Bodoni Bold Italic  
Bodoni Poster  
Bodoni Poster Compressed  
Garamond Antiqua ITC Bookman Light  
Garamond Krsv  
Garamond Hlb  
ITC Bookman Light Italic  
ITC Bookman Demi  
Garamond KrsvHlb ITC Bookman Demi Italic  
Carta  
Courier  
Chicago  
Courier It  
Courier Bd  
Clarendon Roman  
Clarendon Bold  
 
Courier BdIt  
Clarendon Light  
Cooper Black  
LetterGothic  
Cooper Black Italic  
Cooper Gothic 32BC  
Cooper Gothic 33BC  
Coronet  
LetterGothic It  
LetterGothic Bd  
Albertus Md  
Albertus XBd  
Courier  
Courier Oblique  
Courier Bold  
Clarendon Cd  
Coronet  
Courier Bold Oblique  
Eurostile Medium  
Eurostile Bold  
Eurostile Extended No. 2  
Eurostile Bold Extended No. 2  
Geneva  
Marigold  
Arial  
Gill Sans  
Arial It  
Arial Bd  
Arial BdIt  
Gill Sans Italic  
Gill Sans Bold  
Gill Sans Bold Italic  
Gill Sans Light  
TimesNew  
Gill Sans Light Italic  
Gill Sans Extra Bold  
Gill Sans Condensed  
Gill Sans Condensed Bold  
Goudy Oldstyle  
TimesNew It  
TimesNew Bd  
TimesNew BdIt  
Symbol  
Goudy Oldstyle Italic  
Goudy Bold  
Wingdings  
Line Printer  
Goudy Bold Italic  
Goudy Extra Bold  
Helvetica  
Helvetica Oblique  
Helvetica Bold  
Times Roman  
Times It  
Helvetica Bold Oblique  
Helvetica Narrow  
Helvetica Narrow Oblique  
Helvetica Narrow Bold  
Helvetica Narrow Bold Oblique  
Helvetica Condensed  
Helvetica Condensed Oblique  
Helvetica Condensed Bold  
Helvetica Condensed Bold Oblique  
Hoefler Text  
Times Bd  
Times BdIt  
Helvetica  
Helvetica Ob  
Helvetica Bd  
Helvetica BdOb  
CourierPS  
CourierPS Ob  
CourierPS Bd  
CourierPS BdOb  
Hoefler Text Italic  
Hoefler Text Black  
Hoefler Text Black Italic  
Hoefler Ornaments  
Joanna  
SymbolPS  
Joanna Italic  
Palatino Roman  
Palatino It  
Joanna Bold  
Joanna Bold Italic  
Letter Gothic  
Palatino Bd  
Palatino BdIt  
Letter Gothic Slanted  
Letter Gothic Bold  
Letter Gothic Bold Slanted  
ITC Lubalin Graph Book  
ITC Lubalin Graph Book Oblique  
ITCBookman Lt  
ITCBookman LtIt  
ITCBookmanDm  
ITCBookmanDm It ITC Lubalin Graph Demi  
ITC Lubalin Graph Demi Oblique  
Marigold  
HelveticaNr  
HelveticaNr Ob  
HelveticaNr Bd  
Monaco  
ITC Mona Lisa Recut  
HelveticaNr BdOb New Century Schoolbook Roman  
New Century Schoolbook Italic  
N C Schbk Roman New Century Schoolbook Bold  
N C Schbk It  
N C Schbk Bd  
N C Schbk BdIt  
New Century Schoolbook Bold Italic  
NewYork  
Optima Roman  
Optima Italic  
ITC A G Go Bk  
ITC A G Go BkOb  
ITC A G Go Dm  
Optima Bold  
Optima Bold Italic  
Oxford  
ITC A G Go DmOb Palatino Roman  
Palatino Italic  
ZapfC MdIt  
Palatino Bold  
Palatino Bold Italic  
Stempel Garamond Roman  
Stempel Garamond Italic  
Stempel Garamond Bold  
Stempel Garamond Bold Italic  
Symbol  
ZapfDingbats  
Tekton Regular  
Times Roman  
Times Italic  
Times Bold  
Times Bold Italic  
Times New Roman  
Times New Roman Italic  
Times New Roman Bold  
Times New Roman Bold Italic  
Univers 45 Light  
Univers 45 Light Oblique  
Univers 55  
Univers 55 Oblique  
Univers 65 Bold  
Univers 65 Bold Oblique  
Univers 57 Condensed  
Univers 57 Condensed Oblique  
Univers 67 Condensed Bold  
Univers 67 Condensed Bold Oblique  
Univers 53 Extended  
Univers 53 Extended Oblique  
Univers 63 Extended Bold  
Univers 63 Extended Bold Oblique  
Wingdings  
ITC Zapf Chancery Medium Italic  
Symbol Sets  
A symbol set is the collection of alphabetic and numeric characters, punctuation, and special characters available in the  
font you select. Symbol sets support the requirements for different languages or specific applications, such as math  
symbols used for scientific text.  
In PCL 5/PCL 6, a symbol set also defines which character will print for each key on the keyboard (or more specifically, for  
each code point). Some applications require different characters at some code points. To support multiple applications and  
languages, your printer has 36 symbol sets for the resident PCL 5/PCL 6 fonts.  
Symbol Sets for PCL 5/PCL 6  
Not all font names support all of the symbol sets listed.  
Roman 8 (Default)  
ISO 8859-1 Latin 1  
ISO 8859-2 Latin 2  
PC-8  
ISO 8859-9 Latin 5 ISO 8859-10 Latin 6  
PC-8 DN  
PC-775 Baltic  
PC-1004 OS/2  
PC-850 Multilingual  
PC Turkish  
PC-852 Latin 2  
Windows 3.1 Latin 1 Windows 3.1 Latin 2  
DeskTop PS Text  
Microsoft Publishing Math 8  
Windows 3.1 Latin 5  
MC Text  
PS Math  
Pi Font  
Legal  
ISO 4 United Kingdom  
ISO 6 ASCII  
ISO 11 Swedish:names ISO 15 Italian  
 
ISO 17 Spanish  
ISO 69 French  
Symbol  
ISO 21 German  
Windows 3.0 Latin 1  
Wingdings  
ISO 60 Norwegian v1  
Windows Baltic  
ITC ZapfDingbats MS  
Understanding Printer Messages  
The printer operator panel displays messages describing the current state of the printer and indicates possible printer  
problems you must resolve. This topic provides a list of all printer messages, explains what they mean, and tells you how  
to clear the messages.  
NOTICE: When an error code is displayed, the print data remaining on the printer and the information  
accumulated in the memory of the printer are not secured.  
1
1
2
5
6
Menu button  
Ready/Error indicator*  
buttons  
(Set) button  
2
3
4
7
8
buttons  
Information button*  
LCD panel  
Cancel button  
1
* Lights green when the printer is ready or sleeping and blinks when data is being received. Lights yellow when an  
error occurs and blinks when an unrecoverable print error occurs.  
2
* When the  
mark is displayed at the beginning of a message, pressing the  
Information button will show more detailed information.  
Message  
(The first and second  
What this message means  
lines are displayed  
What you can do  
together. The third and  
forth lines blink every  
second.)  
NNN-NNN  
Turn off the printer, and then on. If this does not  
solve the problem, contact Dell.  
Restart Printer  
Error NNN-NNN relates to printer  
problems.  
Contact Support  
See "Contacting Dell."  
If Message Returns  
NNN-NNN  
Confirm that the unit is securely inserted.  
If the problem is not solved, contact Dell.  
See "Contacting Dell."  
XXX is not fully inserted.  
Restart Printer  
Error NNN-NNN relates to printer  
problems.  
Reseat XXX  
Contact Support  
XXX is either missing or not fully inserted  
in the printer.  
XXX Error  
NNN-NNN  
Insert XXX.  
Confirm that the unit is securely inserted.  
Error NNN-NNN relates to printer  
problems.  
 
XXX has reached its end of life.  
Replace XXX.  
Life Over  
NNN-NNN  
Error NNN-NNN relates to printer  
Order a new consumable at the website  
problems.  
Replace Now XXX  
XXX indicates a consumable.  
An unsupported consumable is installed.  
Replace the consumable with the supported one.  
CRUM ID  
NNN-NNN  
Error NNN-NNN relates to printer  
Order a new consumable at the website  
problems.  
Reseat XXX  
XXX indicates a consumable.  
An unsupported consumable is installed.  
Replace the consumable with the supported one.  
CRUM DATA  
NNN-NNN  
Error NNN-NNN relates to printer  
Order a new consumable at the website  
problems.  
Reseat XXX  
XXX indicates a consumable.  
A cover is open.  
Cover Open  
NNN-NNN  
Close XXX  
Close the cover.  
Error NNN-NNN relates to printer  
problems.  
XXX indicates a cover.  
The printer detects a paper jam.  
Paper Jam  
NNN-NNN  
XXXXXX  
Check and clear the paper path.  
See "Clearing Jams."  
Error NNN-NNN relates to printer  
problems.  
XXXXX indicates an instruction to clear a  
paper jam.  
CRUM ID  
009-NNN  
Remove the unsupported unit and install a  
supported one.  
An unsupported unit is installed.  
XXX indicates a unit.  
Reseat XXX  
010-360  
Confirm that the outer levers on both sides of  
the fuser unit are securely locked. If this does  
not solve the problem, contact Dell.  
Restart Printer  
Reseat Fuser  
The outer levers on both sides of the  
fuser unit are not securely locked.  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Contact Support  
Ready to Print  
Prepare a new fuser.  
010-420  
Fuser  
Order a new consumable at the website  
The fuser needs to be replaced soon.  
Ready to Print prepare  
Check Cartridge  
010-421  
Replace the fuser.  
Replace Fuser  
Order a new consumable at the website  
The fuser needs to be replaced.  
Check Cartridge  
Contact Support  
Env. Mode Error  
010-910  
Open the right hand cover, and then lift up the  
envelope lever to clear the envelope mode.  
Open Right Hand Cover  
and make a Envelope  
Lever the normal  
position.  
The printer is in the envelope mode when  
you print on plain paper.  
Close Right Hand Cover  
016-XXX  
Inquire of your system administrator to re-  
configure the security settings.  
Certificate Fail  
Init Certificate  
Certification error has occurred.  
Contact Dell if this message appears repeatedly.  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Are You Sure?  
016-316  
Remove the unsupported memory module. If this  
does not solve the problem, contact Dell.  
Restart Printer  
Reseat Memory  
The printer detected an unsupported  
memory module in the memory slot.  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Contact Support  
016-318  
Remove the memory module from the slot, and  
then reinsert it. If this does not solve the  
problem, contact Dell.  
Restart Printer  
Reseat Memory  
Contact Support  
The memory module is not fully inserted  
in the slot.  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Turn the printer off and on. Ensure the following:  
The wireless adapter is securely inserted in the  
slot on the control board.  
016-338  
Restart Printer  
Reseat Wireless  
Contact Support  
Unauthorized USB devices are not used.  
An error occurred in the wireless adapter.  
If this does not solve the problem, contact Dell.  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Invalid ID  
016-383  
Press  
(Set) button.  
An error occurred because an  
invalid firmware is installed.  
Contact Dell if this message appears repeatedly.  
Data Violation  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Press  
Range Chk Error  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-384  
In downloading the firmware, the address  
of the writing destination is inaccurate.  
Contact Dell if this message appears repeatedly.  
Data Violation  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Press  
Header Error  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-385  
In downloading the firmware, the header  
information of a download file is  
inaccurate.  
Contact Dell if this message appears repeatedly.  
Data Violation  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Press  
Check Sum Error  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-386  
In downloading the firmware, the  
checksum of a download file is  
inaccurate.  
Contact Dell if this message appears repeatedly.  
Data Violation  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Press  
Format Error  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-387  
In downloading the firmware, the format  
of a download file is inaccurate.  
Contact Dell if this message appears repeatedly.  
Data Violation  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Press  
Protection Error  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-391  
A firmware download was performed  
while it was prohibited.  
Contact Dell if this message appears repeatedly.  
Data Violation  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Press  
Erase Flash Err.  
016-392  
Contact Dell if this message appears repeatedly.  
A ROM erasing error occurred while  
downloading the firmware.  
Contact Support  
See "Contacting Dell."  
If Message Returns  
Write Flash Err.  
016-393  
Contact Dell if this message appears repeatedly.  
A ROM writing error occurred while  
downloading the firmware.  
Contact Support  
See "Contacting Dell."  
If Message Returns  
Verify Error  
016-394  
Contact Dell if this message appears repeatedly.  
A verification error occurred while  
downloading the firmware.  
Contact Support  
See "Contacting Dell."  
If Message Returns  
016-522  
The SSL client certificate is required from the  
LDAP server.  
An SSL authentication error of the LDAP  
server has occurred. The SSL client  
certificate cannot be acquired.  
Restart Printer  
Certificate Fail  
Ask your system administrator to set the SSL  
client certificate on the printer.  
Contact Administer  
016-523  
The printer cannot trust the SSL certificate of the  
LDAP server. Ask your system administrator to  
register the root certificate of the SSL certificate  
of the LDAP server on the printer.  
An SSL authentication error of the LDAP  
server has occurred. The server  
certificate data is invalid.  
Restart Printer  
Certificate Fail  
Contact Administer  
Ask your system administrator to use a valid SSL  
certificate of the LDAP server.  
Ensure that the address of the LDAP server set  
on the printer and the address described in the  
SSL certificate of the LDAP server match.  
An SSL authentication error of the LDAP  
server has occurred.  
016-524  
Restart Printer  
Certificate Fail  
Contact Administer  
The server certificate is invalid or the  
address of the LDAP server set on the  
printer does not match the one described  
in the SSL certificate.  
This error can be cleared by disabling LDAP-  
SSL/TLS Communication under SSL/TLS in the  
printer menu. Take note that the validity of the  
connected LDAP server will not be guaranteed in  
this case.  
016-527  
Ask your system administrator to confirm  
whether the Kerberos server or the LDAP server  
is set correctly on the printer.  
An SSL authentication error of the  
Kerberos server or the LDAP server has  
occurred.  
Restart Printer  
Certificate Fail  
If this does not solve the problem, contact Dell.  
Contact Administer  
Press  
(Set) button.  
Job Fail  
Ask your system administrator to confirm  
whether the Kerberos server and the LDAP server  
are set correctly on the printer.  
016-531  
An authentication error of the LDAP  
server or of the Kerberos server has  
occurred.  
Sign On Error  
If this does not solve the problem, contact Dell.  
Press  
See "Contacting Dell."  
Press  
(Set) button.  
Job Fail  
Ask your system administrator to confirm  
whether the user information is set correctly on  
the LDAP server.  
016-532  
The user information of the LDAP server  
is invalid.  
Wrong Attribute  
Also confirm whether LDAP is set correctly on the  
printer.  
Press  
Press  
(Set) button.  
Confirm whether the clock of the printer and the  
clock of the Kerberos server are set correctly and  
identically.  
Job Fail  
An authentication protocol error of the  
Kerberos server has occurred.  
016-533  
The time difference between the clocks of  
the printer and the Kerberos server  
exceeds the limit value of the clock skew  
of the Kerberos server.  
Also confirm whether the summer time and the  
time zone are set identically on the printer and  
the Kerberos server.  
Clock Skew Err.  
Press  
See "Clock Settings."  
See "Date & Time."  
Job Fail  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-534  
The Kerberos server setting information  
or the LDAP server setting information is  
invalid.  
Ask your system administrator to confirm  
whether the Kerberos server and the LDAP server  
are set correctly on the printer.  
Wrong Server  
Press  
Job Fail  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-535  
The account setting values for the LDAP  
administrator are invalid.  
Ask your system administrator to confirm  
whether the account values for the administrator  
of the LDAP server are set correctly on the  
printer.  
Admin Error  
Press  
Job Fail  
An internal error of the LDAP server or of  
the Kerberos server has occurred.  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-536  
Ask your system administrator to confirm  
whether the LDAP server or the Kerberos server  
is set correctly on the printer.  
Setting a secondary server without  
setting a primary server may result in  
this error.  
Access Error  
Press  
016-541  
Ask your system administrator to connect the  
printer with a wired network, initialize the  
referenced while using the Wireless WPA Wireless settings, import the Wireless certificate,  
A wireless certificate cannot be correctly  
Restart Printer  
Certificate Fail  
Enterprise or WPA2-Enterprise.  
and set WPA-Enterprise or WPA2 Enterprise  
again.  
Contact Administer  
A server certificate error has occurred  
when acquiring the certificate with the  
operation of WPA-Enterprise or WPA2-  
Enterprise.  
016-542  
Ask your system administrator to confirm the  
server certificate being used with the Radius  
server.  
Restart Printer  
Certificate Fail  
Contact Administer  
This is a problem in the server certificate,  
such as the validity period has expired  
for the server certificate being used with  
the Radius server.  
016-543  
Ask your system administrator to connect the  
printer with a wired network, initialize the  
Wireless settings, import the Wireless certificate,  
and set WPA-Enterprise or WPA2-Enterprise  
again.  
A certificate destruction error has  
occurred while using the Wireless WPA  
Enterprise or WPA2-Enterprise.  
Restart Printer  
Certificate Fail  
Contact Administer  
Press  
(Set) button, then the Cancel button to  
cancel the current print job.  
Delete unnecessary stored jobs.  
Out of Memory  
016-700  
The printer memory is full and cannot  
continue processing the current print job.  
Job too Large  
To avoid this error in the future, do the following:  
Press  
Delete unnecessary fonts, macros, and other  
data in printer memory.  
Install additional printer memory.  
PDL Request  
016-720  
An error relating to the PDL emulation  
problems has occurred.  
Press  
(Set) button, then the Cancel button to  
Data Violation  
cancel the current print job.  
Press  
Job Fail  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-756  
Printing was attempted during the  
prohibited time zone.  
Inquire of your system administrator for the  
permitted time zone.  
Prohibited Time  
Press  
Press  
(Set) button.  
Confirm whether the user account or the group  
account is set correctly with the printer driver  
when printing.  
Invalid User  
016-757  
The setting values of the user account or  
of the group account are invalid. Whether  
the user is a member user or the group  
is a member group could not be  
confirmed.  
Account Denied  
If the account is set correctly with the printer  
driver, ask your system administrator to confirm  
the setting on the LDAP server (external mode)  
or the Print Volume (internal mode).  
Press  
Disabled Func  
016-758  
Press  
(Set) button.  
The use of the print function or the use  
of color printing is not allowed for the  
user.  
Ask your system administrator to change the  
settings to allow the use of the print function or  
the use of color printing.  
Denied Col Print  
Press  
Reached Limit  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-759  
The total number of printed pages has  
reached the number allowed to be  
printed.  
Ask your system administrator to change the  
maximum number of pages allowed to be  
printed.  
Over your limits  
Press  
Invalid Job  
Press  
(Set) button, then the Cancel button to  
cancel the current print job.  
016-799  
The configuration of the printer set on  
the printer driver does not match the  
configuration of your printer.  
Ensure that the printer configuration on the  
printer driver match the configuration of your  
Data Violation  
printer.  
Press  
Press  
Wireless Error  
WPS failed to connect.  
(Set) button.  
016-920  
A timeout occurred during connection  
with the wireless LAN access point  
(Registrar).  
Execute the operation again according to the  
operation procedure.  
Timeout Error  
Press  
Download Error  
WPS failed to connect.  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-921  
A download error has occurred during  
connection with the wireless LAN access  
point (Registrar).  
Execute the operation again according to the  
operation procedure.  
Timeout Error  
Press  
Wireless Error  
Press  
(Set) button.  
016-922  
Multiple wireless LAN access points  
(Registrar) are being operated with WPS-  
PBC.  
Set only wireless LAN access point (Registrar) to  
be operated with WPS-PBC, and execute the  
operation again according to the operation  
procedure.  
Session Overlap Error  
Press  
Press  
(Set) button, then the Cancel button to  
cancel the current print job.  
Delete unnecessary stored jobs.  
Disk Full  
016-980  
RAM disk memory or hard disk is full and  
cannot continue processing the current  
print job.  
To avoid this error in the future, do the following:  
Job too Large  
Reduce the number of print pages by splitting  
the print data.  
Press  
Increase free memory space by deleting  
unnecessary data in the RAM disk or hard disk.  
Collate Full  
016-981  
Press  
(Set) button, then the Cancel button.  
The specified print job exceeded the  
printer memory capacity.  
Job too Large  
Re-try printing with a job of less volume.  
Press  
Tray Detached  
A paper tray is detached.  
024-9XX  
Confirm if the indicated tray is securely installed.  
N indicates the number of the tray.  
Push in Tray N  
One of the following has occurred.  
Tray N has run out of paper.  
No Suitable Paper  
024-9XX  
The size or type of paper in the Tray N  
does not match the specified one.  
Load the specified paper  
in Tray N .  
Load Tray N  
XXXXXXXX  
YYYYYYYY  
N indicates the number of the tray.  
XXXXXXXX indicates a paper size.  
YYYYYYYY indicates a paper type.  
Load paper of the specified size.  
The size of the paper loaded in a tray  
does not match the size specified on the  
printer.  
Paper Size Mismatch  
024-91X  
Error NNN-NNN relates to printer  
problems.  
Change the paper size settings according to the  
size of the paper you load.  
Load Tray N  
N indicates the number of the tray.  
XXXXXXXX indicates a paper size.  
YYYYYYYY indicates a paper type.  
XXXXXXXX YYYYYYYY  
Load paper of the specified size.  
The size of the paper loaded in the MPF  
does not match the size specified on the  
printer.  
Paper Size Mismatch  
024-914  
Error NNN-NNN relates to printer  
problems.  
Change the paper size settings according to the  
size of the paper you load.  
Load Tray MPF  
XXXXXXXX indicates a paper size.  
XXXXXXXX YYYYYYYY  
YYYYYYYY indicates a paper type.  
Stacker Full  
024-916  
Prints have reached the capacity of the  
stacker tray of the output expander.  
Remove the prints from the stacker tray.  
Remove the prints from the stacker tray.  
Remove the prints from the center output tray.  
Remove Paper  
Stacker Tray  
Over Count  
Stapled prints have reached the capacity  
of the stacker tray of the output  
expander.  
024-917  
Remove Paper  
Stacker Tray  
Output Tray Full  
024-920  
Prints have reached the capacity of the  
center output tray.  
Remove Paper  
Center Output Tray  
One of the following has occurred.  
MPF has run out of paper.  
No Suitable Paper  
024-969  
Load the specified paper  
in the MPF.  
The size or type of paper in the MPF does  
not match the specified one.  
Load MPF  
XXXXXXXX  
YYYYYYYY  
XXXXXXXX indicates a paper size.  
YYYYYYYY indicates a paper type.  
Staple Error  
024-976  
Remove the jammed paper following the steps  
displayed in the operator panel.  
1.Open Output Expander  
Front Door and remove  
paper.  
Paper jam has occurred in the output  
expander.  
See "Clearing Jams."  
2.Close Output Expander  
Front Door.  
Staple Fail  
024-977  
Replace the stapler cartridge.  
Replace Now Stapler  
The stapler cartridge of the output  
Order a new consumable at the website  
Cartridge.  
expander needs to be replaced now.  
Continue without Staple?  
Are you Sure?  
Empty Staple  
024-979  
Replace the stapler cartridge.  
Replace Now Stapler  
Cartridge.  
The stapler cartridge of the output  
expander is empty.  
Order a new consumable at the website  
Continue without Staple?  
Are You Sure?  
Stacker Full  
024-980  
The stacker tray of the output expander  
is full of prints.  
Remove the prints from the stacker tray.  
Remove Paper  
Stacker Tray  
Finisher Error  
024-982  
Some error has occurred in the output  
expander.  
Remove the prints from the stacker tray.  
Remove Paper  
Stacker Tray  
Over Heat  
042-700  
Since it is abnormally hot inside the  
printer, printing is paused.  
Wait for a while with the printer on until the  
error disappears.  
Restart Printer  
Contact Support  
If Message Returns  
050-152  
1.Open Output Expander  
Front Door.  
Remove the jammed paper following the steps  
displayed in the operator panel.  
Paper jam has occurred in the output  
expander.  
2.Please turn a knob if  
necessary, and remove  
paper.  
See "Clearing Jams."  
3.Close Output Expander  
Front Door.  
050-153  
1.Open Output Expander  
Front Door and remove  
Remove the jammed paper following the steps  
displayed in the operator panel.  
Paper jam has occurred in the output  
expander.  
paper.  
See "Clearing Jams."  
2.Close Output Expander  
Front Door.  
Some pieces of ribbon are remaining in  
the drum cartridge.  
Cartridge Error  
091-NNN  
Remove the remaining ribbon from the drum  
cartridge.  
Tape Staying  
XXX indicates a color of the drum  
cartridge.  
XXX Drum Crtrdg  
Ready to Print  
091-400  
Replace the waste toner box soon.  
Waste Toner Box  
The waste toner box needs to be  
replaced soon.  
Order a new consumable at the website  
Ready to Print  
Is close to life  
Ready to Print  
A drum cartridge needs to be replaced  
soon.  
Replace the drum cartridge of the indicated color  
soon.  
091-4XX  
N Drum Crtrdg  
Order a new consumable at the website  
N indicates the color of the drum  
cartridge.  
Is close to life  
Ready to Print  
A drum cartridge needs to be replaced  
soon.  
Prepare a new drum cartridge of the indicated  
color.  
091-41X  
N Drum Crtrdg  
Order a new consumable at the website  
N indicates the color of the drum  
cartridge.  
prepare  
Insert the X drum cartridge into the correct color  
slot.  
The X drum cartridge is either missing or  
not fully inserted into the printer.  
Cartridge Error  
091-92N  
If the message remains, set the X drum cartridge  
again and push it in firmly.  
X indicates the color of the toner  
cartridge.  
Make sure that the X drum cartridge has been  
fully installed.  
Insert XXX Drum Crtrdg  
Clean the CTD sensor.  
092-651  
CTD Sensor Dirty  
The CTD sensor is dirty.  
Clean CTD Sensor  
Ready to Print  
A toner cartridge needs to be  
replaced soon.  
Replace the toner cartridge of the indicated color  
soon.  
093-42X  
N Toner Crtrdg  
Order a new consumable at the website  
N indicates the color of the toner  
cartridge.  
Is close to life  
Ready to Print  
Prepare a new belt unit.  
094-419  
Belt Unit  
The belt unit needs to be replaced soon.  
Order a new consumable at the website  
prepare  
Ready to Print  
Replace the belt unit soon.  
094-422  
Belt Unit  
The belt unit needs to be replaced soon.  
Order a new consumable at the website  
Is close to life  
Follow the instructions in the operator panel and  
make sure that the belt unit has been fully  
installed.  
Belt Error  
094-910  
The belt unit is either missing or not fully  
installed in the printer.  
Insert Belt Unit  
Belt Unit  
Remove the belt unit and install a new one.  
094-911  
Order a new belt unit at the website  
The belt unit needs to be replaced now.  
Replace Belt  
Contact Support  
Follow the instructions in the operator panel and  
make sure that the transfer roller has been fully  
installed.  
Trans. Error  
094-913  
The transfer roller is either missing or  
not fully installed in the printer.  
Insert Transfer Roller  
Ready to Print  
142-700  
You can use the printer, however the print  
quality is inferior.  
Since it is abnormally hot or cold inside  
the printer, the print speed decreases.  
If you wait for a short while, the temperature  
within the printer becomes normal.  
Slow Speed Printing  
Ready to Print  
193-700  
Though some of the toner cartridges have  
reached the end of their lives, you can continue  
printing.  
The printer is in the custom toner  
cartridge mode.  
Non-DELL Toner  
Installed  
Printing With Web Services on Devices (WSD)  
®
®
This section provides information for network printing with WSD, the new Windows Vista , Windows Server 2008,  
®
®
Windows Server 2008 R2, and Windows 7 protocol of Microsoft .  
Adding Roles of Print Services  
When you use Windows Server 2008 or Windows Server 2008 R2, you need to add the roles of print services to the  
Windows Server 2008 or Windows Server 2008 R2 client.  
For Windows Server 2008:  
1. Click Start® Administrative Tools® Server Manager.  
2. Select Add Roles from the Action menu.  
3. Check the Print Services check box on the Server Roles window in the Add Roles Wizard, and then click Next.  
4. Check the Print Server check box, and then click Next.  
5. Click Install.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2:  
1. Click Start® Administrative Tools® Server Manager.  
2. Select Add Roles from the Action menu.  
3. Check the Print and Document Services check box on the Server Roles window in the Add Roles Wizard, and  
then click Next.  
4. Click Next.  
5. Check the Print Server check box, and then click Next.  
6. Click Install.  
Printer Setup  
You can install your new printer on the network using the Drivers and Utilities CD that shipped with your printer, or using  
Microsoft's Windows Add Printer wizard.  
Installing a Printer Driver Using the Add Printer Wizard  
1. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers (Start® Devices and Printers for Windows  
Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7).  
2. Click Add a printer to launch the Add Printer wizard.  
3. Select Add a network, wireless or Bluetooth printer.  
     
4. In the list of available printers, select the one you want to use, and then click Next.  
NOTE: In the list of available printers, the WSD printer is displayed in the form of http://IP address/ws/.  
NOTE: If no WSD printer is displayed in the list, enter the printer's IP address manually to create a WSD  
printer. To enter the printer's IP address manually, follow the instructions below.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2, to create a WSD printer, you must be a member of Administrators group.  
1. Click The printer that I want isn't listed.  
2. Select Add a printer using a TCP/IP address or hostname and click Next.  
3. Select Web Services Device from Device type.  
4. Enter the printer's IP address in the Hostname or IP address text box and click Next.  
5. If prompted, install the printer driver on your computer. If you are prompted for an administrator password or  
confirmation, type the password or provide confirmation.  
6. Complete the additional steps in the wizard, and then click Finish.  
7. Print a test page to verify print installation.  
a. Click Start® Control Panel® Hardware and Sound® Printers (Start® Devices and Printers for  
Windows Server 2008 R2 and Windows 7).  
b. Right-click the printer you just created, and then click Properties (Printer properties for Windows Server  
2008 R2 and Windows 7).  
For PCL driver:  
On the Options tab, set each setting item, and then click Apply.  
For PS driver:  
On the Device Settings tab, set each setting item, and then click Apply.  
c. On the General tab, click Print Test Page. When a test page prints successfully, installation is complete.  
Printing With UX Filter (UNIX)  
Overview  
The UX Filter  
This section describes the features of the UX filter and its operating environment.  
Features  
The UX filter is an utility software which converts files created by the UNIX workstation into a format which conforms to  
the PostScript language loaded in the printer. The utility provides software that converts text files, SunRaster image files  
(for Sun/Solaris only), TIFF image files and XWD image files into the PostScript language program. Also, it makes use of  
the printer features to output in the following manner.  
Input paper selection  
Double-sided printing  
Output paper selection  
NOTICE: Depending on the configurations of the printers, some may not be able to use the UX filter.  
Operating Environment  
Text files, SunRaster image files (for Solaris only), TIFF image files and XWD image files received from a workstation  
connected to a printer by a USB cable or parallel cable (hereinafter referred to as the local workstation), or from one  
located on the network (hereinafter referred to as the remote workstation), can be converted into the PostScript language  
program and output to the printer.  
In addition, it can also be used in an environment where a printer, installed with an interface board, is connected directly  
to the network.  
   
Before Using the UX Filter  
Check the following items before using the UX filter.  
Before setting up the workstation, set up the printer as follows.  
1. Make sure the lpd port is working or not when using the network environment. If the lpd port is not working, set  
LPD to On on the operator panel. (Mandatory) See "Protocol" for more information.  
When a parallel or USB port is to be used, make sure these are working. (Mandatory)  
2. Set up IP address and subnet mask when the printer is used in the network environment. (Mandatory)  
3. Make TBCPFilter function available if TBCPFilter function is installed on the printer. See "Adobe Protocol" for more  
information.  
Installing the UX Filter  
Before Installation  
The following are required for the installation.  
Disk capacity: 20 MB of free disk space required, including temporary working space for installation.  
Log on as a root account to perform the operation here. If you have no root privilege, contact your system  
administrator.  
Output printer must be registered in the workstation before using UX filter. (HP-UX)  
Use sam command for registration of output printer.  
For more information, see the HP-UX related manual.  
Files Added by the Installation  
The following files will be added when the UX filter is installed.  
Solaris  
Directory  
File name  
txt2ps2  
Contents  
Text conversion utility  
SunRaster conversion utility  
TIFF conversion utility  
XWD conversion utility  
sunras2ps2  
tiff2ps2  
/usr/local/dellbin5130  
xwd2ps2  
 
dellpsif  
Input filter  
dellposttxt5130cdn  
dellpostps5130cdn  
dellbinpath5130  
Symbolic link file to call txt2ps2  
Symbolic link file to call dellpsif  
Directory description file for the UX filter print tool  
/usr/lib/lp/postscript  
Model interface  
program  
Source file of the model interface program (stored as the printer  
name during registration)  
/usr/lib/lp/model  
/etc/lp/interfaces  
Model interface  
program  
Interface program for PRINTER (stored as the printer name during  
registration)  
posttxt5130cdn.fd  
dell5130cdn.fd  
postio5130.fd  
Filter description file for txt2ps2  
Dell5130cdn filter description file for Dell 5130cdn Color Laser Printer  
Dellpostio filter description file  
/etc/lp/fd  
download5130cdn.fd Delldownload filter description file  
txt2ps25130cdn.1 Manual page file for txt2ps2  
sunras2ps25130cdn.1 Manual page file for sunras2ps2  
/usr/share/man/man1  
tiff2ps25130cdn.1  
xwd2ps25130cdn.1  
dellpsif5130cdn.1  
Manual page file for tiff2ps2  
Manual page file for xwd2ps2  
Manual page file for dellpsif  
NOTE: The directories listed are default directories.  
HP-UX  
Directory  
File name  
txt2ps2  
Contents  
Text conversion utility  
/usr/local/dellbin5130  
xwd2ps2  
XWD conversion utility  
tiff2ps2  
TIFF conversion utility  
/usr/lib/lp/postscript  
/usr/spool/lp/interface  
dellbinpath5130  
Directory description file for the UX filter print tool  
Model interface  
program  
Interface program for PRINTER (stored as the printer name during  
registration)  
txt2ps25130cdn.1  
tiff2ps25130cdn.1  
xwd2ps25130cdn.1  
Manual page file for txt2ps2  
Manual page file for tiff2ps2  
Manual page file for xwd2ps2  
/usr/share/man/man1  
NOTE: The directories listed are default directories.  
Installation Procedure Overview  
This section provides information on the installation of the UX filter using the UNIX workstation.  
Solaris  
1. Setup the printer and network.  
2. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD into the local workstation.  
3. Run the installer and begin the installation.  
4. Print for testing the printer.  
HP-UX  
1. Setup the printer and network.  
2. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD into the local workstation.  
3. Run the installer and begin the installation.  
4. Print for testing the printer.  
Operation on Solaris  
Installation/Printer Setting  
1. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD in the CD-ROM drive of the local workstation.  
If CD-ROM drive is not mounted on your workstation, extract files by using another workstation that has a CD-ROM  
drive to transfer those files to your workstation.  
2. Log on as a root account and extract the installation script from the Drivers and Utilities CD.  
NOTICE: If you have no root privilege, contact your system administrator.  
# cd /tmp  
# cp /cdrom/cdrom0/UXFILTER.tar /tmp  
# tar xvf ./UXFILTER.tar  
3. Type ./install.sh and run the installer.  
# ./install.sh  
4. Select the printer model to install.  
Printer Model ?  
1. Dell 5130cdn Color Laser Printer  
2. Exit  
Enter Process No (1/2)? : 1  
5. The following menu appears. Select <1> and set up the local printer.  
Solaris Installation for Dell 5130cdn Color Laser Printer Type Printer  
1. Set Local Printer  
2. Set Remote Printer  
Enter Process No (1/2)? : 1  
6. Type the device name of the connection port.  
Enter port-device-name? [/dev/ecpp0] : /dev/bpp0  
NOTICE: Specify the device file in the communication port available.  
7. When Set Remote Printer is selected, type the host name of the server or the host name of the printer.  
Enter server-hostname? : server  
server-hostname is 'server' (y/n)[y] : y  
NOTICE: The host name of the server must be pre-registered with DNS, NIS, NIS+ or /etc/hosts.  
8. When Set Remote Printer is selected, type the remote printer name.  
Enter server-printer-name? : ps  
server-printer-name is 'ps' (y/n)[y] : y  
NOTICE: Type ps when the printer is a network connection printer.  
9. Type the printer name to be registered with the system.  
Enter printer-name? [dell5130cdn] : dell5130cdn  
Printer-name is 'dell5130cdn' (y/n)[y] : y  
10. Specify the directory to install the utility. To install into /usr/local/dellbin5130, press the <Enter> key. To  
change the directory, specify one.  
Enter Binary directory name? [/usr/local/dellbin5130] :  
11. If this utility has been installed earlier, the user will be prompted whether to overwrite the earlier version.  
directory is '/usr/local/dellbin5130' (y/n)[n] : y  
12. If the server input at step 5 the printer connected by the network, type <y>. If the server and the printer are  
connected locally, type <n>.  
'dell5130cdn'is network printer?:(y/n)[y] : y  
The software installation is complete.  
NOTICE: When the printing settings are modified or changed by the Administration Tool (admintool) after the  
installation, printing may not work.  
Operation on HP-UX  
Installation Procedure  
NOTE: The host name of the output printer which you want to specify in step 6 must be pre-registered with a sam  
command.  
1. Insert the Drivers and Utilities CD into the CD-ROM drive of the local workstation.  
2. Log on as a root account and extract the installation script from the Drivers and Utilities CD.  
NOTICE: If you have no root privilege, contact your system administrator.  
# mount -F cdfs -o cdcase /dev/dsk/c1t2d0 /cdrom  
# cd /tmp  
# cp /cdrom/uxfilter.tar /tmp  
# tar xvf UXFILTER.tar  
NOTE: /dev/ds/clt2d0 is an example. Specify the CD-ROM device file for all workstations.  
3. Type ./install.sh and run the installer.  
# ./install.sh  
4. Select the printer model to install.  
Printer Model ?  
1. Dell 5130cdn Color Laser Printer  
2. Exit  
Enter Process No (1/2)? : 1  
5. Specify the directory to install the utility.  
Enter install directory name [/usr/local/dellbin5130] :  
directory is '/usr/local/dellbin5130' (y/n)[n] : y  
6. Type the name of the output printer. Type delllp5130cdn. Type the printer name to be registered with the system.  
Enter output-printer-name? : delllp5130cdn  
output-printer-name is 'delllp5130cdn' (y/n)[y] : y  
NOTE: The registered printer name can be verified by executing lpstat -v.  
7. Type the logical printer name. Register dell5130cdn. Type a printer name that has not already been registered  
with the system.  
Enter logical-printer-name? : dell5130cdn  
Printer-name is 'dell5130cdn' (y/n)[y] : y  
8. The utility will be installed in the directory specified at step 5. Registration will be executed here so that the logical  
printer registered at step 7 can access the utility. As this process is automatically executed, no input is required.  
With the above steps, the installation is complete.  
Uninstalling the UX Filter  
The UX filter does not come with an uninstaller. To uninstall the UX filter, follow the following procedure.  
NOTICE: Log on as a root account to perform the operation here. If you have no root privilege, contact your  
system administrator.  
Solaris  
1. Delete the printer that was registered with the system. Use the printer name created during the installation and the  
lpadmin command.  
# lpadmin -x printername  
2. Delete the filters registered with the system. Delete the filters registered during the installation using the lpfilter  
command.  
# lpfilter -f dell5130cdn -x (for Dell 5130cdn Color Laser Printer)  
# lpfilter -f download5130 -x  
# lpfilter -f postio5130cdn -x  
# lpfilter -f posttxt5130cdn -x  
 
3. Delete the symbolic files required to call up the filter.  
Delete the following files from /usr/lib/lp/postscript.  
dellposttxt5130cdn  
dellpostps5130cdn  
dellbinpath5130  
4. Delete the interface program files of Selected printer type name from /usr/lib/lp/model.  
Please also delete the interface program files of Selected printer name from /etc/lp/interfaces.  
5. Delete all the directories that contain the UX filters and the files in these directories created during the installation.  
The following directories must be deleted.  
/usr/local/dellbin5130  
6. Delete the filter description files. Delete the following files from /etc/lp/fd.  
Filter description files for various printers.  
dell5130cdn.fd(for Dell 5130cdn Color Laser Printer)  
download5130.fd  
postio5130cdn.fd  
posttxt5130cdn.fd  
HP-UX  
1. Delete the printer that was registered with the system. Use the sam command to delete the printer set up during  
the installation.  
# sam  
2. Delete all the directories that contain the UX filters and the files in these directories created during the installation.  
The following directories must be deleted.  
/usr/local/dellbin5130 (directory specified during the installation)  
Printing and Using the Utilities  
Printing (Solaris)  
This section provides information on printing that makes use of the filter. To print from Solaris, specify the printer  
registered during the installation of filters as the output destination.  
NOTICE: To use the lp command, make sure the operating environment of the spooler has been set up correctly  
(enabled, available) using the lpstat command (lpstat-p all). For details on the options of the lp command  
and the lpstat command or how to make use of them, see the related manuals of Solaris.  
Printing From Solaris  
To print to the default printer:  
If the printer is registered as the default printer, the name of the printer can be shortened and specified as shown in  
the following example.  
% lp filename  
 
To print to other printers:  
To print to a printer named dell5130cdn, type as follows.  
% lp -d dell5130cdn filename  
NOTE: The name of the printer can be confirmed by executing lpstat -v.  
To change the default printer temporarily for printing:  
To change the default printer, set the printer name in the environment variable LPDEST.  
To set a printer named dell5130cdn as the default printer for printing, type as follows.  
% setenv LPDEST dell5130cdn  
% lp filename  
NOTE: Using this method, a default printer can be set up for each user.  
NOTE: The above example describes the setup method executed when cache is used.  
To select a paper tray for printing:  
To select a paper tray for printing, specify the paper tray after the -y option of the lp command.  
NOTE: Depending on installed options, the available paper trays are different.  
To select and print to a letter size paper of the printer named dell5130cdn with landscape, specify as follows.  
% lp -d dell5130cdn -y landscape -y letter filename  
The following options can be specified by the lp command.  
To print text files:  
NOTE: It prints according to the length and width specified by the lpadmin command.  
-y double  
Sets printing to 2-column printing.  
-y landscape  
Rotates the image by 90° and uses the paper in the landscape orientation.  
-y size=n  
Sets the font size to n point.  
-y outcolumn=n  
This option converts text to single-byte text and sets printing to start from the nth column.  
-y outline=n  
Sets printing to start from the nth line.  
-y font=font  
Sets the font for printing single-byte alphanumeric characters. If the font specified is not available for the  
printer, the default fonts are used.  
NOTE: To specify a font, type the font name as-is after the -y font= option.  
% lp -y font=Courier-Oblique filename  
NOTE: For information on the available fonts, see the PS Fonts List.  
-y margin=u:b:r:l  
Specifies the margin of a page in inches. The u (upper margin), b (bottom margin), r (right margin), and l  
(left margin) are positive real numbers (up to two decimal points). The default is 0.  
-y ps  
The input file will be processed as the PostScript file. If the file does not begin with "%!", "%!" will be output  
to the beginning line. Whether the file contains "%!" will be ignored.  
To print text/PostScript files:  
-y DuplexBook  
Enables the long-edge binding feature. When it is specified, the printing direction or position will be adjusted  
and both sides of the paper printed so that the longer edge of the pages can be bound.  
-y DuplexList  
Enables the short-edge binding feature. When it is specified, the printing direction or position will be adjusted  
and both sides of the paper printed so that the shorter edge of the pages can be bound.  
-y tray-input  
The paper tray-related parameters that can be specified by the lp command are as follows:  
tray1  
Feed paper from tray 1 (top tray).  
tray2  
Feed paper from tray 2 (the second tray from the top).  
tray3  
Feed paper from tray 3 (the third tray from the top).  
tray4  
Feed paper from tray 4 (the fourth tray from the top).  
tray5  
Feed paper from tray 5 (the fifth tray from the top).  
a4  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with A4 (210 x 297 mm).  
a5  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with A5 (148 x 210 mm).  
b5  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with B5 (182 x 257 mm).  
letter  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Letter (8.5 x 11 inches).  
folio  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Folio (8.5 x 13 inches).  
legal  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Legal (8.5 x 14 inches).  
executive  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches).  
monarch  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Monarch (3.875 x 7.5 inches).  
com10  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Envelope #10 (4.125 x 9.5 inches).  
dl  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with DL (110 x 220 mm).  
c5  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with C5 (162 x 229 mm).  
MxNmm  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with MxNmm defined by users.  
Possible range specified:  
Width: 76.2 to 215.9 mm  
Length: 127.0 to 355.6 mm  
MxNin  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with MxNinches defined by users.  
Possible range specified:  
Width: 3.00 to 8.5 inches  
Length: 5.00 to 14.0 inches  
If this option is not specified or the tray specified tray is not available, feed paper from the default tray.  
-y toner_save  
Turns on the save toner mode for printing. The print result will be fainter than that of normal printing.  
-y nc=n  
Specifies the number of output copies (the value of copies must be a positive integer). If this option is not  
specified, 1 will be selected.  
-y cl  
Specifies that printing be collated. If the copies option is not specified, this option will be ignored.  
-y ps  
The input file will be processed as the PostScript file. If the file does not begin with %!, %! will be output to  
the beginning line. If a file contains %!, this option will be ignored.  
-y msi  
Specifies multipurpose feeder.  
-y m=type  
Specifies multipurpose feeder Paper Type.  
Available multipurpose feeder Paper Types are as follows:  
B
FinePaper/Bond/Plain Paper 2  
BB  
FinePaperBack/Bond/Plain Paper 2 - Side 2  
P
Stationery/Plain/Plain Paper 1  
PB  
StationeryBack/Plain/Plain Paper 1 - Side 2  
R
Recycled Paper  
RB  
RecycledPaperBack/Recycled Paper - Side 2  
H1  
ThickPaper/Heavyweight 1/Covers 1  
H1B  
ThickPaperBack/Heavyweight 1/Covers 1 - Side 2  
H2  
ThickPaper2/Heavyweight 2/Covers 2  
H2B  
ThickPaper2Back/Heavyweight 2/Covers 2 - Side 2  
OHP  
Transparency  
L
LabelPaper/Labels  
C2  
Coated/Coated 2/Coated Paper 2  
C2B  
Coated Back/Coated 2/Coated Paper 2 - Side 2  
C3  
Coated Thick/Coated 3/Coated Paper 3  
C3B  
Coated Thick Back/Coated 3/Coated Paper 3 - Side 2  
LH  
LetterHead  
E
Envelope  
If this option is not specified, multipurpose feeder Paper Type for the printer can be used.  
-y mfo=mode  
Specifies orientation for multipurpose feeder.  
Available orientations for multipurpose feeder are as follows:  
le  
Landscape  
ler  
Landscape (Rotated)  
se  
Portrait  
ser  
Portrait (Rotated)  
-y po=n  
Specifies alternate tray.  
Available alternate trays are as follows:  
0
Use printer settings  
1
Display message  
2
Feed from multipurpose feeder  
3
Use nearest size (Adjust to fit)  
4
Use larger size (Adjust to fit)  
5
Use nearest size (No zoom)  
6
Use larger size (No zoom)  
-y st=mode  
Specifies feed separators from.  
Available feed separators from the following.  
auto  
AutoTray/Auto  
1
1stTray/Tray 1 (Standard 550-sheet tray)  
2
2ndTray/Tray 2 (Optional 550-sheet feeder)  
3
3rdTray/Tray 3(Optional 550-sheet feeder)  
4
4thTray/Tray 4 (Optional 1100-sheet feeder)  
5
5thTray/Tray 5 (Optional 1100-sheet feeder)  
msi  
Multipurpose Feeder  
off  
Off  
-y sp  
Specifies printed separators.  
-y sb  
Specifies Skip Blank Pages.  
-y cm=mode  
Specifies output color.  
Available output colors are as follows:  
c
Color (CMYK)  
k
Black  
-y pr=mode  
Specifies print mode.  
Available print modes are as follows:  
hs  
High speed  
hq  
High quality  
hr  
High Resolution  
-y cc=mode  
Specifies image types.  
Available image types are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
Photo  
2
Screen Display  
3
Standard/ Normal  
4
Business Graphics  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-y gc=mode  
Specifies RGB gamma correction.  
Available RGB gamma corrections are as follows:  
1.0  
1.0  
1.4  
1.4  
1.8  
1.8  
2.2  
2.2  
2.6  
2.6  
off  
Off  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-y sc=mode  
Specifies screen.  
Available screens are as follows:  
0
Fineness  
1
Standard  
2
Auto  
3
Gradation  
-y gg=mode  
Specifies gray guaranteed.  
Available gray guaranteed modes are as follows:  
on  
On  
off  
Off  
This option is available only for color printing.  
Specifies color transformation.  
-y ct  
This option is available only for color printing.  
-y br=mode  
Specifies brightness adjustment.  
Available brightness adjustment option values are as follows:  
+5  
Bright 5  
+4  
Bright 4  
+3  
Bright 3  
+2  
Bright 2  
+1  
Bright 1  
+0  
Normal  
-1  
Dark 1  
-2  
Dark 2  
-3  
Dark 3  
-4  
Dark 4  
-5  
Dark 5  
-y rgbc=mode  
Specifies RGB color correction.  
Available RGB color corrections are as follows:  
10  
Perceptual  
11  
Saturation  
12  
RelativeC  
13  
AbsoluteC  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-y rgbpr=mode  
Specifies RGB input profile.  
Available RGB input profile option value are as follows:  
0
sRGB  
1
AdobeRGB  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-y rgbtp=mode  
Specifies RGB color temperature.  
Available RGB color temperature option value are as follows:  
5000  
5000K  
6000  
6000K  
9300  
9300K  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-y cb=cyan-low:cyan-middle:cyan-high:magenta-low:magenta-middle:magenta-high:yellow-low:yellow-  
middle:yellow high:black-low:black-middle:black-high  
Specifies adjustment value for color balance of each color/density.  
Available adjustment values are as follows:  
+3  
Dark 3  
+2  
Dark 2  
+1  
Dark 1  
0
Normal  
-1  
Light 1  
-2  
Light 2  
-3  
Light 3  
-Cb  
Option value must be specified in the following order:  
Cyan low density, Cyan medium density, Cyan high density, Magenta low density, Magenta medium density,  
Magenta high density, Yellow low density, Yellow medium density, Yellow high density, Black low density,  
Black medium density, Black high density  
If no value is specified, it is treated as "0"(Normal).  
For example, if you want to specify "Light 2" for Cyan medium density, "Dark 3" for Yellow high density, and  
"Dark 2" for Black low density, it can be specified using either of the following:  
-Cb=0:-2:0:0:0:0:0:0:+3:+2:0:0  
-Cb=:-2:::::::+3:+2::  
-y sl=mode  
Specifies staple settings.  
Available staple option values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
This option is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
-y os=mode  
Specifies offset settings.  
Available offset option values are as follows:  
0
Auto  
1
Offset per Set (Offsets each copy before printing the next copy.)  
2
Offset per Job (Offsets each copy per paper job you specify.)  
This option is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
-y lh=mode  
Specifies letterhead duplex mode settings.  
When letterhead duplex mode is enabled, a print sheet is always fed through duplex feeding path in a  
printer. As the result, a user can set sheets without caring about sheet orientation in an input slot.  
Available Letterhead duplex mode values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
2
Auto  
-y tr=mode  
Specifies trapping settings.  
Available trapping option values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
-y -hld=PrintType:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
Specifies the print type.  
Available types of setting are as follows:  
For Secure Print  
secure:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
secure:UserID:Password:  
For Private MailBox Print  
private:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
private:UserID: Password:  
For Public MailBox Print  
public:UserID::DocumentName  
public:UserID::  
For Proof Print  
proof:UserID::DocumentName  
proof:UserID::  
For UserID, enter an ID up to eight single-byte characters from 0x20 to 0x7E, except 0x20 " "(blank)  
and 0x3A":" (colon).  
For Password, enter a password up to 12 single-byte characters from 0x30 to 0x39 (numeric  
characters).  
For DocumentName, enter a document name up to 12 single-byte characters from 0x20 to 0x7E, except  
0x20 " " (blank) and 0x3A":" (colon).  
NOTE: When document name is not specified, the original document name will be used.  
-y -Jown= jobownername: Password: jobgroupname  
Specifies job owner name, password and job group name for authentication.  
Available types of setting are as follows:  
jobownername:password:jobgroupname  
jobownername:password:  
jobownername::  
:password:  
::  
For jobownername, enter a job owner name up to 32 characters.  
For password, enter an alphanumeric password between 4 and 12 characters.  
For jobgroupname, specify a job group name up to 32 characters.  
NOTE: Alphanumeric characters, including spaces and colons, and symbols can be entered to specify a job owner  
name.  
NOTE: When no job owner name is specified, login user name is used as job owner name.  
NOTE: When a job owner name exceeds allowable character length, the extra characters are ignored.  
NOTE: When an unacceptable character is entered to specify a job owner name, "UnknownUser" becomes the job  
owner name.  
NOTE: When an unacceptable character is entered in a password, or when a specified password is not within the  
range of the allowable character length, the authentication password is treated as not specified.  
NOTE: Incomplete form of -Jown option is treated as no authentication setting being made. In such case, if  
authentication setting is made with the environmental variable, it is used as setting information.  
Printing (HP-UX)  
This section provides information on printing from the registered logical printer during the installation.  
Printing From HP-UX  
To print to the default printer:  
If the printer is registered as the default printer, the name of the printer can be shortened and specified as shown in  
the following example.  
% lp filename  
To print to other printers:  
To print to a printer named dell5130cdn, type as follows.  
% lp -d dell5130cdn filename  
To change the default printer temporarily for printing:  
To change the default printer, set the printer name in the environment variable PRINTER.  
To set a printer named dell5130cdn as the default printer for printing, type as follows.  
% setenv PRINTER dell5130cdn  
% lp filename  
To print with added options:  
To print with the options, specify the option of the lp command using -o as follows.  
The available options are the same as txt2ps2/tiff2ps/xwd2ps2.  
Depending on installed options, the available paper trays are different.  
%lp -d dell5130cdn -o r -o ILT filename  
To print using file format:  
To print text files:  
% lp -d dell5130cdn filename  
To print XWD files:  
% lp -d dell5130cdn -o XWD filename  
To print TIFF format files:  
% lp -d dell5130cdn -o TIF filename  
To print PostScript files:  
% lp -d dell5130cdn filename  
To print PostScript files as text files:  
% lp -d dell5130cdn -o TX filename  
However, for PostScript files with options set up, such as paper selection, etc., when the same option is specified, it  
will be ignored.  
Authentication Printing  
This section provides information on how to specify the group and user name used for authentication printing in the  
environment variable.  
Specifying the Group Name  
To specify the Group Name for Authentication Printing:  
You can specify a unique group name in the environment variable as follows.  
% setenv JOWN5130G " jobgroupname"  
NOTE: Up to 32 characters are acceptable for the group name. When a group name exceeds allowable character  
length, the extra characters are ignored.  
NOTE: If you specify the filter option when authentication printing is already specified, the filter option has the  
higher priority over authentication printing.  
Specifying the User Name  
To specify the User Name for Authentication Printing:  
You can specify a unique user name in the environment variable as follows.  
% setenv JOWN5130U " jobownername"  
You can specify the login name as the user name as follows.  
% setenv JOWN5130U ""  
NOTE: Up to 32 characters can be entered to specify the user name. When a user name exceeds allowable  
character length, the extra characters are ignored.  
NOTE: If you specify the filter option when authentication printing is already specified, the filter option has the  
higher priority over authentication printing.  
Specifying the Password  
To Specify the Password for Authentication Printing:  
If you need to specify the password in authentication printing, you can specify the password in the environment  
variable as follows.  
% setenv JOWN5130P "password"  
If you do not specify the password inexplicitly, type as follows.  
% setenv JOWN5130P ""  
NOTE: Acceptable password length is between 4 and 12 characters. When an unacceptable character is entered in a  
password, or when a specified password is not within the range of the allowable character length, the extra  
characters are ignored.  
NOTE: If you specify the filter option when authentication printing is already specified, the filter option has the  
higher priority over authentication printing.  
NOTE: If you only specify the password without specifying the user name in the environment variable, the login  
name is assumed as the user name.  
NOTICE: If you enter the password in the login file for automatically allocating the environment variable when you  
log in, you are recommended to specify the appropriate access privilege that prevents unauthorized users from  
reading the login file.  
txt2ps2 (Solaris/HP-UX)  
Format  
/usr/local/dellbin5130/txt2ps2 [-d] [-D] [-Itray-input] [-t] [-2] [-r] [-F] [-llines] [-wcolumns]  
[-ooutcolumns] [-Loutlines] [-en] [-ssize] [-E] [-ffont] [-Nc=copies] [-cl] [-ps] [-  
mg=up:bottom:right:left] [-Hd=position:format:page] [-Hffont] [-MSI] [-M=type] [-Mfo=mode] [-Pon] [-  
St=mode] [-Sp] [-Sb] [-Cm=mode] [-Pr=mode] [-Cc=mode] [-Gc=mode] [-Sc=mode] [-Gg=mode] [-Cb=cyan-  
low:cyan-middle:cyanhigh:magenta- low:magenta-middle:magenta-high:yellow-low;yellow-middle:yellow  
high:black-low:black-middle:black-high] [-Sl=mode] [-Os=mode] [-Lh=mode] [-Tr=mode] [-  
Hld=PrintType:UserID:Password:DocumentName] [-Jown= jobownername:password:jobgroupname] [filename...]  
Function  
Reads text, converts it to the PostScript language program, and writes to standard output. If the filename is not specified,  
the standard input will be taken as the command input.  
By typing character strings in the environmental variable TXT2PS2OPTION, the input of option at the command line can be  
omitted.  
At the environmental variable TXT2PS2OPTION and the command line, if no option is specified, the printer will output in 10-  
point font size in the portrait orientation.  
At the environmental variable TXT2PS2OPTION and the command line, if the same option is specified, the one specified at  
the command line will prevail.  
txt2ps2 outputs the PostScript language program that adjusts the line/column according to the paper size. For this reason,  
the user need not be aware of the paper size. If there is an option to specify the line/column, automatic line feed  
according to the paper size will not be executed. Printing will be output according to the line/column specified.  
txt2ps2 interprets the following control codes. Other control codes/undefined codes will be converted to octal numbers and  
output as-is.  
LF  
Line feed  
FF  
Form feed (modifiable by option)  
TAB  
8-column tab stop (modifiable by option)  
BS  
Backspace 1 character  
Option  
-d  
Enables the short-edge binding feature. When it is specified, the printing direction or position will be adjusted and  
both sides of the paper printed so that the shorter edge of the pages can be bound.  
-D  
Enables the long-edge binding feature. When it is specified, the printing direction or position will be adjusted and  
both sides of the paper printed so that the longer edge of the pages can be bound. This option is available only  
when the duplexer is installed on the printer.  
-Itray-input  
Specifies the paper tray. A paper tray can be selected by directly specifying a tray or by specifying a paper size.  
When a paper size is specified, the tray loaded with paper of the specified size will be found and selected  
automatically.  
The parameters for selecting a paper tray are as follows:  
1
Feed paper from tray 1 (top tray).  
2
Feed paper from tray 2 (the second tray from the top).  
3
Feed paper from tray 3 (the third tray from the top).  
4
Feed paper from tray 4 (the fourth tray from the top).  
5
Feed paper from tray 5 (the fifth tray from the top).  
A4  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with A4 (210 x 297 mm).  
A5  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with A5 (148 x 210 mm).  
B5  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with B5 (182 x 257 mm).  
LT  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Letter (8.5 x 11 inches).  
FL  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Folio (8.5 x 13 inches).  
LG  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Legal (8.5 x 14 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Monarch (3.875 x 7.5 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Envelope #10 (4.125 x 9.5 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with DL (110 x 220 mm).  
EX  
MO  
COM10  
DL  
C5  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with C5 (162 x 229 mm).  
MxNmm  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with MxNmm defined by users.  
Possible range specified:  
Width: 76.2 to 215.9 mm  
Length: 127.0 to 355.6 mm  
MxNin  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with MxNinches defined by users.  
Possible range specified:  
Width: 3.00 to 8.5 inches  
Length: 5.00 to 14.0 inches  
If this option is not specified or the tray specified is not available, feed paper from the default tray.  
-t  
Turns on the save toner mode for printing. The print result will be fainter than that of normal printing. In some  
cases, this option will be ignored.  
-2  
-r  
-F  
Sets printing to 2-column printing.  
Rotates the image by 90° and uses the paper in the landscape orientation.  
Ignores the form feed code (FF).  
-llines  
Specifies the number of lines per page.  
-wcolumns  
Specifies the number of columns per line.  
-ooutcolumns  
Converts print data to single-byte text and sets printing to start from outcolumns.  
-Loutlines  
Prints text from the outline columns.  
-en  
Expands horizontal tabs to n columns (space). The default is 8.  
-ssize  
Specifies the font size as point size. The default is 10.  
-E  
This function turns on the image enhancement function. For models without the image enhancement mechanism,  
this option will be ignored.  
-ffont  
Sets the font.  
NOTE: The available fonts are limited to the font in the printer. For more information, see "Understanding Fonts."  
-Nc=copies  
Specifies the number of output copies (the value of copies must be a positive integer).  
-Cl  
-ps  
Specifies that printing be collated. If the copies option is not specified, this option will be ignored.  
The input file will be processed as the PostScript file. If the file does not begin with %!, %! will be output to the  
beginning line. If a file contains %!, it will be processed in the same way as dellpsif.  
-mg=up:bottom:right:left  
Specifies the margin of a page in inches. The upper margin, bottom margin, right margin, and left margin are  
positive real numbers (up to two decimal points). The default is 0.  
-mg=0:0:0:3  
Sets the left margin to 3 inches.  
-mg=3:3:0:5  
Sets the upper margin to 3 inches; bottom margin, 3 inches; and left margin, 5 inches. If the margin is 0, it  
can be omitted.  
-mg=:::3  
Sets the left margin to 3 inches.  
-Hd=position:format:page  
Specifies the position that the user information of the header or footer is output at.  
position specifies output position. But this option is available only for converting text files.  
ul  
Output on the upper left corner of the paper.  
ur  
Output on the upper right corner of the paper.  
dl  
Output on the lower left corner of the paper.  
dr  
Output on the lower right corner of the paper.  
format specifies the contents and the order to output. This option is omissible.  
If this option is omitted, uh is specified as the default value.  
u
User name  
h
Host name  
t
Date and time  
If the output contents are specified as tuh, it is output as follows.  
Date and Time User: username Host: hostname  
page specifies the page to output. This option is omissible.  
f
Output the top page only.  
(default in case of PostScriptfiles conversion)  
a
Output all pages.  
(default in case of Text files conversion)  
Specify these options as follows.  
In the case that convert text file, output the host name following the user name on the upper right corner of the  
paper, output all pages.  
(User name, Host name, all page output are default)  
-Hd=ur  
-Hd=ur:uh  
-Hd=ur:uh:a  
In the case that convert PostScript file, output the host name following the date and time on the lower left corner of  
the paper, output all pages (a option value is necessary because output the top page only is default when  
PostScript file is converted.)  
-Hd=dl:th:a  
NOTICE: If the paper size is not specified, it outputs the header and footer at the position of A4 size by default. If  
the paper size is specified by lp command, the output position of the header or footer is not changed from the  
position of the paper size specified by txt2ps2. Specify the paper size at the same time when the header and footer  
option is used. Sometimes all pages are not printed despite specifying all page output when PostScript file  
conversion is specified. In such cases, specify output the top page only. By using TZ environmental variable,  
specify time zone (GMT etc.).  
-Hffont  
Specify the font to print the header and footer. European fonts the same as half size alphanumeric fonts can be  
specified. Helvetica is specified as default. If the wrong font is specified, the default European font of the printer can  
be used. If the header/footer output option is specified, the font specification for the header/footer is ignored.  
-MSI  
Specifies multipurpose feeder.  
-M=type  
Specifies multipurpose feeder Paper Type.  
Available multipurpose feeder Paper Types are as follows:  
B
FinePaper/Bond/Plain Paper 2  
BB  
FinePaperBack/Bond/Plain Paper 2- Side 2  
P
Stationery/Plain/Plain Paper 1  
PB  
StationeryBack/Plain/Plain Paper 1 - Side 2  
R
Recycled Paper  
RB  
RecycledPaperBack/ Recycled Paper - Side 2  
H1  
ThickPaper/Heavyweight 1/Covers 1  
H1B  
ThickPaperBack/Heavyweight 1/Covers 1 - Side 2  
H2  
ThickPaper2/Heavyweight 2/Covers 2  
H2B  
ThickPaper2Back/Heavyweight 2/Covers 2 - Side 2  
OHP  
L
Transparency  
LabelPaper/Labels  
C2  
C2B  
C3  
C3B  
LH  
E
Coated/Coated 2/Coated Paper 2  
Coated Back/Coated 2/Coated Paper 2- Side 2  
Coated Thick/Coated 3/Coated Paper 3  
Coated Thick Back/Coated 3/Coated Paper 3- Side 2  
Letterhead  
Envelope  
If this option is not specified, multipurpose feeder Paper Type of the printer can be used.  
-Mfo=mode  
Specifies orientation for multipurpose feeder.  
Available orientations for multipurpose feeder are as follows:  
le  
Landscape  
ler  
Landscape (Rotated)  
se  
Portrait  
ser  
Portrait (Rotated)  
-Pon  
Specifies alternate tray.  
Available alternate trays are as follows:  
0
Use printer settings  
1
Display message  
2
Feed from multipurpose feeder  
3
Use nearest size (Adjust to fit)  
4
Use larger size (Adjust to fit)  
5
Use nearest size (No zoom)  
6
Use larger size (No zoom)  
-St=mode  
Specifies feed separators from.  
Available feed separators froms are as follows:  
auto  
AutoTray/Auto  
1
1stTray/Tray 1 (Standard 550-sheet feeder)  
2
2ndTray/Tray 2 (Optional 550-sheet feeder)  
3
3rdTray/Tray 3 (Optional 550-sheet feeder)  
4
4thTray/Tray 4 (Optional 1100-sheet feeder)  
5
5thTray/Tray 5 (Optional 1100-sheet feeder)  
msi  
Multipurpose Feeder  
off  
Off  
-Sp  
-Sb  
Specifies printed separators.  
Available only when the paper tray for separators is specified.  
Specifies Skip Blank Pages.  
-Cm=mode  
Specifies output color.  
Available output colors are as follows:  
c
Color (CMYK)  
k
Black  
-Pr=mode  
Specifies print mode.  
Available print modes are as follows:  
hs  
High Speed  
hq  
High Quality  
hr  
High Resolution  
-Cc=mode  
Specifies RGB Color Correction.  
Available RGB Color Corrections are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
2
3
4
Photo  
Screen Display  
Standard/Normal  
Business Graphics  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Gc=mode  
Specifies RGB gamma correction.  
Available RGB gamma corrections are as follows:  
1.0  
1.0  
1.4  
1.4  
1.8  
1.8  
2.2  
2.2  
2.6  
2.6  
off  
Off  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Sc=mode  
Specifies screen.  
Available screens are as follows:  
0
Fineness  
1
Standard  
2
Auto  
3
Gradation  
-Gg=mode  
Specifies gray guaranteed.  
Available gray guaranteed options are as follows:  
on  
On  
off  
Off  
This option is available only for color printing.  
-Ct  
Specifies color transformation.  
This option is available only for color printing.  
-Br=mode  
Specifies brightness adjustment.  
Available brightness adjustment option values are as follows:  
+5  
Bright 5  
+4  
Bright 4  
+3  
Bright 3  
+2  
Bright 2  
+1  
Bright 1  
+0  
Normal  
-1  
Dark 1  
-2  
Dark 2  
-3  
Dark 3  
-4  
Dark 4  
-5  
Dark 5  
-RGBc=mode  
Specifies RGB color correction.  
Available RGB color corrections are as follows:  
10  
Perceptual  
11  
Saturation  
12  
RelativeC  
13  
AbsoluteC  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-RGBPr=mode  
Specifies RGB input profile.  
Available RGB input profile option value are as follows:  
0
sRGB  
1
AdobeRGB  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-RGBTp=mode  
Specifies RGB color temperature.  
Available RGB color temperature option value are as follows:  
5000  
5000K  
6000  
6000K  
9300  
9300K  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Cb=cyan-low:cyan-middle:cyan-high:magenta-low:magenta-middle:magenta-high:yellow-low:yellow-  
middle:yellow high:black-low:black-middle:black-high  
Specifies adjustment value for color balance of each color/density.  
Available adjustment values are as follows:  
+3  
Dark 3  
+2  
Dark 2  
+1  
Dark 1  
0
Normal  
-1  
Light 1  
-2  
Light 2  
-3  
Light 3  
-Cb  
Option value must be specified in the following order:  
Cyan low density, Cyan medium density, Cyan high density, Magenta low density, Magenta medium density,  
Magenta high density, Yellow low density, Yellow medium density, Yellow high density, Black low density,  
Black medium density, Black high density  
If no value is specified, it is treated as "0"(Normal).  
For example, if you want to specify "Light 2" for Cyan medium density, "Dark 3" for Yellow high density, and  
"Dark 2" for Black low density, it can be specified using either of the following:  
-Cb=0:-2:0:0:0:0:0:0:+3:+2:0:0  
-Cb=:-2:::::::+3:+2::  
-Sl=mode  
Specifies staple settings.  
Available staple option values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
This option is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
-Os=mode  
Specifies offset settings.  
Available offset option values are as follows:  
0
Auto  
1
Offset per Set (Offsets each copy before printing the next copy.)  
2
Offset per Job (Offsets each copy per paper job you specify.)  
This option is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
-Lh=mode  
Specifies letterhead duplex mode settings.  
When letterhead duplex mode is enabled, a print sheet is always fed through duplex feeding path in a printer. As  
the result, a user can set sheets without caring about sheet orientation in an input slot.  
Available Letterhead duplex mode values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
2
Auto  
-Tr=mode  
Specifies trapping settings.  
Available trapping option values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
-Hld=PrintType:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
Secure Print  
PrintType  
secure  
Secure Print  
private  
Private MailBox Print  
public  
Public MailBox Print  
proof  
Proof Print  
UserID  
Up to eight single-byte characters from 0x20 to 0x7E, except 0x20 " " (blank) and 0x3A":" (colon).  
Password  
Up to 12 single-byte characters from 0x30 to 0x39 (numeric characters).  
DocumentName  
Up to 12 single-byte characters from 0x20 to 0x7E, except 0x20 " " (blank) and 0x3A ":" (colon).  
Secure Print  
-Hld=store:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
-Hld=store:UserID:Password:  
Private MailBox Print  
-Hld=private:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
-Hld=private:UserID:Password:  
Public MailBox Print  
-Hld=public:UserID::DocumentName  
-Hld=public:UserID::  
Proof Print  
-Hld=proof:UserID::DocumentName  
-Hld=proof:UserID::  
NOTICE: Make sure you specify Secure Print only when you directly print data to a printer. Secure Print may not  
be available if you specify it when data need to be printed through another server or data need to be handled by  
another program such as PostScript files. Collate is automatically specified when you specify Proof Print.  
-Jown= jobownername: Password: jobgroupname Authentication Setting  
Specifies job owner name, password and job group name for authentication.  
When only job owner name is specified (-Jown=jobownername:) (no password specified),  
authentication password is treated as not specified.  
When only password is specified (-Jown=:password) (no job owner name specified), login user name  
is used as job owner name. Entered password is used as authentication password.  
When neither of job owner name nor password is specified (-Jown=:), login user name is used as job  
owner name, and authentication password is treated as not specified.  
When a job owner name exceeds allowable character length, the extra characters are ignored.  
When an unacceptable character is entered to specify a job owner name, "UnknownUser" becomes the  
job owner name.  
NOTE: Characters acceptable for job owner name are alphanumeric characters and symbols, except for space and  
colon.  
NOTE: Up to 32 characters become the job owner name.  
When an unacceptable character is entered in a job group name, the job owner name is treated as not  
specified.  
NOTE: Alphanumeric characters, including spaces and colons, and symbols can be entered to specify a job owner  
name.  
NOTE: Up to 32 characters can be entered to specify a group name.  
When an unacceptable character is entered in a password, or when a specified password is not within  
the range of the allowable character length, the authentication password is treated as not specified.  
NOTE: Acceptable password length is between 4 and 12 characters.  
Incomplete form of -Jown option is treated as no authentication setting being made. In such case, if authentication  
setting is made with the environmental variable, it is used as setting information.  
Example  
To convert the program list of the file.txt file into the PostScript language program that sets the paper to the landscape  
orientation and prints in the 2-up mode, type as follows:  
% txt2ps2 -r -2 file.txt | lp  
To convert file.txt to the PostScript language program and output it to the file.ps file, type as follows:  
% txt2ps2 file.txt > file.ps  
% lp file.ps  
To convert the output result of the command into the PostScript language program using txt2ps2 and print it to the  
printer, type as follows:  
% ls -alF | txt2ps2 | lp  
Environmental Variable  
TXT2PS2OPTION  
Optional settings based on the environmental variable. To output in the 2-up mode, 8 points and the landscape  
orientation, type as follows:  
% setenv TXT2PS2OPTION "-2 -s8 -r"  
To use the same options as those of the dellpsif filter specified by printcap, type as follows:  
% setenv TXT2PS2OPTION "<dellpsif>"  
File  
/usr/local/dellbin5130/.dellpsdefault5130  
This is the default command option setting file for individual users.  
Important  
When the same option is specified twice, the later setting will prevail. As TXT2PS2OPTION is analyzed before the  
option of the command line, it is possible to temporarily modify the options already set in TXT2PS2OPTION by typing  
at the command line.  
The comment description (%%page:m n) of the page number cannot be output to the PostScript program file which  
is output by the default option of txt2ps2. Thus, when the output of txt2ps2 is to be taken as the output of another  
application (psrev of TRANSCRIPT, etc.), add the page number description by inserting the line command (-  
Ilines).  
If a BS code is found at the beginning of a line, the print position of the next character will be located at the left of  
the beginning of the line.  
When there are multiple tab codes in one line, the tab position may be off as a result of automatic line feed. In  
such case, use the -I or -w option.  
The number of columns specified by the -w option is not the actual number of printed characters. The actual  
number of single-byte characters to be printed is derived by deducting the output column position (outcolumns)  
specified by the o option from the number of columns specified by the -w option.  
The -mg option cannot be specified when -w, -l, -o, and -L option are specified.  
The start positions of margin of the margin command (-mg=u:b:r:l) are not set against the edge of the paper. The  
margins are set against the printable area of the paper allowed by the printer.  
Use the -ps option only when a PostScript file that contains no %! at the beginning of the file is used as the  
PostScript file. If a normal text file is input, it will not function correctly.  
In HP-UX, txt2ps2 considers files written by PostScript that contain %! at the beginning of the file as the PostScript  
files. To print PostScript files as text files, specify the TX option. With this option, PostScript files will be processed  
as text files.  
sunras2ps2 (Solaris)  
Format  
/usr/local/dellbin5130/sunras2ps2 [-d] [-D] [-Itray-input] [-t] [-r] [-n] [-l=left,bottom] [-  
s=width,height] [-S=width] [-E] [-Nc=copies] [-Cl] [-Hd=position: format] [-Hffont] [-MSI] [-M=type]  
[-Mfo=mode] [-Pon] [-St=mode] [-Sp] [-Sb] [-Cm=mode] [-Pr=mode] [-Cc=mode] [-Gc=mode] [-Sc=mode] [-  
Gg=mode] [-Ct] [-Br= mode] [-RGBc= mode] [-RGBPr= mode] [-RGBTp= mode] [-Cb=cyan-low:cyan-  
middle:cyan-high:magentalow:magenta-middle:magenta-high:yellow-low;yellow-middle:yellow high:black-  
low:black-middle:black-high] [-Sl=mode] [-Os=mode] [-Lh=mode] [-Tr=mode] [-  
Hld=PrintType:UserID:Password:DocumentName] [-Jown= jobownername:password:jobgroupname] [filename...]  
Function  
Reads SunRaster data, converts it to the PostScript language program and writes to standard output. If the filename is  
not specified, the standard input will be taken as the command input. SunRaster files with a pixel depth of 1, 8, 24, and  
32 bits can be specified.  
sunran2ps2 takes filename as having been created in 72dpi and calculates the output size. Thus, to convert SunRaster  
files created in other resolutions, specify the size option (-s, -S) explicitly.  
Option  
-d  
Enables the short-edge binding feature. When it is specified, the printing direction or position will be adjusted and  
both sides of the paper printed so that the shorter edge of the pages can be bound.  
-D  
Enables the long-edge binding feature. When it is specified, the printing direction or position will be adjusted and  
both sides of the paper printed so that the longer edge of the pages can be bound. This option is available only  
when the duplexer is installed on the printer.  
-Itray-input  
Specifies the paper tray.  
A paper tray can be selected by directly specifying a tray or by specifying a paper size.  
When a paper size is specified, the tray loaded with paper of the specified size will be found and selected  
automatically.  
The parameters for selecting a paper tray are as follows:  
1
Feed paper from tray 1 (top tray).  
2
Feed paper from tray 2 (the second tray from the top).  
Feed paper from tray 3 (the third tray from the top).  
3
4
Feed paper from tray 4 (the fourth tray from the top).  
5
Feed paper from tray 5 (the fifth tray from the top).  
A4  
A5  
B5  
LT  
FL  
LG  
EX  
MO  
COM10  
DL  
C5  
MxNmm  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with A4 (210 x 297 mm).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with A5 (148 x 210 mm).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with B5 (182 x 257 mm).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Letter (8.5 x 11 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Folio (8.5 x 13 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Legal (8.5 x 14 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Monarch (3.875 x 7.5 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Envelope #10 (4.125 x 9.5 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with DL (110 x 220 mm).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with C5 (162 x 229 mm).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with MxNmm defined by users.  
Possible range specified:  
Width: 76.2 to 215.9 mm  
Length: 127.0 to 355.6 mm  
MxNin  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with MxN inches defined by users.  
Possible range specified:  
Width: 3.00 to 8.5 inches  
Length: 5.00 to 14.0 inches  
If this option is not specified or the tray specified is not available, feed paper from the default tray.  
-t  
Turns on the save toner mode for printing. The print result will be fainter than that of normal printing. In some  
cases, this option will be ignored.  
-r  
Rotates the image by 90° and uses the paper in the landscape orientation.  
-n  
Disables the addition of the showpage. It is used when files converted to the PostScript language program are  
merged with files created with other applications.  
-l=left,bottom  
Specifies the print position. Printing will be executed from the left and bottom of the page. The default is 0.25  
inches for both left and bottom.  
-s=width,height  
Specifies the output size. Printing will be executed with the width and height in inches.  
-S=width  
Sets the width of the output size in inches. The height will be calculated automatically according to the width.  
-E  
This function turns on the image enhancement function. In some cases, this option will be ignored.  
-Nc=copies  
Specifies the number of output copies (the value of copies must be a positive integer).  
-Cl  
Specifies that printing be collated. If the copies option is not specified, this option will be ignored.  
-Hd=position:format  
Specifies the position to be output the user information as the header or footer.  
position specifies output position. But this option is available only for converting text files.  
ul  
Output on the upper left corner of the paper.  
ur  
Output on the upper right corner of the paper.  
dl  
Output on the lower left corner of the paper.  
dr  
Output on the lower right corner of the paper.  
format specifies the contents and the order to output. This option is omissible.  
If this option is omitted, uh is specified as the default value.  
u
User name  
h
Host name  
t
Date and time  
If the output contents are specified as tuh, it is output as follows.  
Date and Time User: username Host: hostname.  
Specify these options as follows.  
In the case that convert text file, output the host name following the user name on the upper right corner of the  
paper, output all pages.  
(User name, Host name, all page output are default)  
-Hd=ur  
-Hd=ur:uh  
-Hffont  
Specify the font to print the header and footer. European fonts the same as half size alphanumeric fonts can be  
specified. Helvetica is specified as default.  
If the wrong font is specified, default European font of the printer can be used.  
If header/footer output option is specified, the font specification of header/footer is ignored.  
-MSI  
Specifies multipurpose feeder.  
-M=type  
Specifies multipurpose feeder Paper Type.  
Available multipurpose feeder Paper Types are as follows:  
B
FinePaper/Bond/Plain Paper 2  
BB  
FinePaperBack/Bond/Plain Paper 2 - Side 2  
P
Stationery/Plain/Plain Paper 1  
PB  
StationeryBack/Plain/Plain Paper 1 - Side 2  
R
Recycled Paper  
RB  
RecycledPaperBack/ Recycled Paper - Side 2  
H1  
ThickPaper/Heavyweight 1/Covers 1  
H1B  
ThickPaperBack/Heavyweight 1/Covers 1 - Side 2  
H2  
ThickPaper2/Heavyweight 2/Covers 2  
H2B  
ThickPaper2Back/Heavyweight 2/Covers 2 - Side 2  
OHP  
Transparency  
L
LabelPaper/Labels  
C2  
Coated/Coated 2/Coated Paper 2  
C2B  
Coated Back/Coated 2/Coated Paper 2- Side 2  
C3  
Coated Thick/Coated 3/Coated Paper 3  
C3B  
Coated Thick Back/Coated 3/Coated Paper 3- Side 2  
LH  
Letterhead  
E
Envelope  
If this option is not specified, multipurpose feeder Paper Type of the printer can be used.  
-Mfo=mode  
Specifies orientation for multipurpose feeder.  
Available orientations for multipurpose feeder are as follows:  
le  
Landscape  
ler  
Landscape (Rotated)  
se  
Portrait  
ser  
Portrait (Rotated)  
-Pon  
Specifies alternate tray.  
Available alternate trays are as follows:  
0
Use printer settings  
1
Display message  
2
Feed from multipurpose feeder  
3
Use nearest size (Adjust to fit)  
4
Use larger size (Adjust to fit)  
5
Use nearest size (No zoom)  
6
Use larger size (No zoom)  
-St=mode  
Specifies feed separators from.  
Available feed separators from the following.  
auto  
AutoTray/Auto  
1
1stTray/Tray 1 (Standard 550-sheet feeder)  
2
2ndTray/Tray 2 (Optional 550-sheet feeder)  
3
3rdTray/Tray 3 (Optional 550-sheet feeder)  
4
4thTray/Tray 4 (Optional 1100-sheet feeder)  
5
5thTray/Tray 5 (Optional 1100-sheet feeder)  
msi  
off  
Multipurpose Feeder  
Off  
-Sp  
-Sb  
Specifies printed separators.  
Available only when the paper tray for separators is specified.  
Specifies Skip Blank Pages.  
-Cm=mode  
Specifies output color.  
Available output colors are as follows:  
c
Color (CMYK)  
k
Black  
-Pr=mode  
Specifies print mode.  
Available print modes are as follows:  
hs  
High Speed  
hq  
High Quality  
hr  
High Resolution  
-Cc=mode  
Specifies image types.  
Available image types are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
Photo  
2
Screen Display  
3
Standard/ Normal  
4
Business Graphics  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Gc=mode  
Specifies RGB gamma correction.  
Available RGB gamma corrections are as follows:  
1.0  
1.0  
1.4  
1.8  
2.2  
2.6  
off  
1.4  
1.8  
2.2  
2.6  
Off  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Sc=mode  
Specifies screen.  
Available screens are as follows:  
0
Fineness  
1
Standard  
2
Auto  
3
Gradation  
-Gg=mode  
Specifies gray guaranteed.  
Available gray guaranteed options are as follows:  
on  
On  
off  
Off  
This option is available only for color printing.  
-Ct  
Specifies color transformation.  
This option is available only for color printing.  
-Br=mode  
Specifies brightness adjustment.  
Available brightness adjustment option value are as follows:  
+5  
Bright 5  
+4  
Bright 4  
+3  
Bright 3  
+2  
Bright 2  
+1  
Bright 1  
Normal  
Dark 1  
Dark 2  
Dark 3  
Dark 4  
Dark 5  
+0  
-1  
-2  
-3  
-4  
-5  
-RGBc=mode  
Specifies RGB color correction.  
Available RGB color corrections are as follows:  
10  
Perceptual  
11  
Saturation  
12  
RelativeC  
13  
AbsoluteC  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-RGBPr=mode  
Specifies RGB input profile.  
Available RGB input profile option value are as follows:  
0
sRGB  
1
AdobeRGB  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-RGBTp=mode  
Specifies RGB color temperature.  
Available RGB color temperature option value are as follows:  
5000  
5000K  
6000  
6000K  
9300  
9300K  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Cb=cyan-low:cyan-middle:cyan-high:magenta-low:magenta-middle:magenta-high:yellow-low:yellow-  
middle:yellow high:black-low:black-middle:black-high  
Specifies adjustment value for color balance of each color/density.  
Available adjustment values are as follows:  
+3  
Dark 3  
+2  
Dark 2  
+1  
Dark 1  
0
Normal  
-1  
Light 1  
-2  
Light 2  
-3  
Light 3  
-Cb  
Option value must be specified in the following order:  
Cyan low density, Cyan medium density, Cyan high density, Magenta low density, Magenta medium density,  
Magenta high density, Yellow low density, Yellow medium density, Yellow high density, Black low density,  
Black medium density, Black high density  
If no value is specified, it is treated as "0"(Normal).  
For example, if you want to specify "Light 2" for Cyan medium density, "Dark 3" for Yellow high density, and  
"Dark 2" for Black low density, it can be specified using either of the following:  
-Cb=0:-2:0:0:0:0:0:0:+3:+2:0:0  
-Cb=:-2:::::::+3:+2::  
-Sl=mode  
Specifies staple settings.  
Available staple option values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
This option is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
-Os=mode  
Specifies offset settings.  
Available offset option values are as follows:  
0
Auto  
1
Offset per Set (Offsets each copy before printing the next copy.)  
2
Offset per Job (Offsets each copy per paper job you specify.)  
This option is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
-Lh=mode  
Specifies letterhead duplex mode settings.  
When letterhead duplex mode is enabled, a print sheet is always fed through duplex feeding path in a printer. As  
the result, a user can set sheets without caring about sheet orientation in an input slot.  
Available Letterhead duplex mode values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
2
Auto  
-Tr=mode  
Specifies trapping settings.  
Available trapping option values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
-Hld=PrintType:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
Secure Print  
PrintType  
secure  
Secure Print  
private  
Private MailBox Print  
public  
Public MailBox Print  
proof  
Proof Print  
UserID  
Up to eight single-byte characters from 0x20 to 0x7E, except 0x20 " " (blank) and 0x3A":" (colon).  
Password  
Up to 12 single-byte characters from 0x30 to 0x39 (numeric characters).  
DocumentName  
Up to 12 single-byte characters from 0x20 to 0x7E, except 0x20 " " (blank) and 0x3A ":" (colon).  
Secure Print  
-Hld=secure:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
-Hld=secure:UserID:Password:  
Private MailBox Print  
-Hld=private:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
-Hld=private:UserID:Password:  
Public MailBox Print  
-Hld=public:UserID::DocumentName  
-Hld=public:UserID::  
Proof Print  
-Hld=proof:UserID::DocumentName  
-Hld=proof:UserID::  
NOTICE: Make sure you specify Secure Print only when you directly print data to a printer. Secure Print may not  
be available if you specify it when data need to be printed through another server or data need to be handled by  
another program such as PostScript files. Collate is automatically specified when you specify Proof Print.  
-Jown= jobownername: Password: jobgroupname Authentication Setting  
Specifies job owner name, password and job group name for authentication.  
When only job owner name is specified (-Jown=jobownername:) (no password specified),  
authentication password is treated as not specified.  
When only password is specified (-Jown=:password) (no job owner name specified), login user name  
is used as job owner name. Entered password is used as authentication password.  
When neither of job owner name nor password is specified (-Jown=:), login user name is used as job  
owner name, and authentication password is treated as not specified.  
When a job owner name exceeds allowable character length, the extra characters are ignored.  
When an unacceptable character is entered to specify a job owner name, "UnknownUser" becomes the  
job owner name.  
NOTE: Alphanumeric characters, including spaces and colons, and symbols can be entered to specify a job owner  
name.  
NOTE: Up to 32 characters become the job owner name.  
When an unacceptable character is entered in a job group name, the job owner name is treated as not  
specified.  
NOTE: Alphanumeric characters, including spaces and colons, and symbols can be entered to specify a job owner  
name.  
NOTE: Up to 32 characters can be entered to specify a group name.  
When an unacceptable character is entered in a password, or when a specified password is not within  
the range of the allowable character length, the authentication password is treated as not specified.  
NOTE: Acceptable password length is between 4 and 12 characters.  
Incomplete form of -Jown option is treated as no authentication setting being made. In such case, if  
authentication setting is made with the environmental variable, it is used as setting information.  
Example  
To output the displayed screen image to a file using the snapshot command and convert the file into the PostScript  
language program using the sunras2ps2 command, type as follows.  
% sunras2ps2 file.rs > file.ps  
To output the displayed screen image to a file using the snapshot command, convert the file into the PostScript language  
program using the sunras2ps2 command and output it to a printer, type as follows.  
% sunras2ps2 file.rs | lp  
Important  
When -s and -S are specified at the same time or when the same option is specified twice, the later setting will  
prevail.  
If the output size option (-s, -S) is not specified, scaling will be executed taking one pixel of the raster data as  
one pixel of the printer.  
If the print position option specifies a point beyond the printable area of the printer, data beyond the printable area  
will not be printed.  
tiff2ps2 (Solaris/HP-UX)  
Format  
/usr/local/dellbin5130/tiff2ps2 [-d] [-D] [-Itray-input] [-t] [-r] [-n] [-l=left,bottom] [-  
s=width,height] [-S=width] [-E] [-Nc=copies] [-Cl] [-Hd=position:format] [-Hffont] [-MSI] [-M=type]  
[-Mfo=mode] [-Pon] [-St=mode] [-Sp] [-Sb] [-Cm=mode] [-Pr=mode] [-Cc=mode] [-Gc=mode] [-Sc=mode] [-  
Gg=mode] [-Ct] [-Br= mode] [-RGBc= mode] [-RGBPr= mode] [-RGBTp= mode] [-Cb=cyan-low:cyan-  
middle:cyanhigh:magenta-low:magenta-middle:magenta-high:yellow-low;yellow-middle:yellow high:black-  
low:black-middle:black-high] [-Sl=mode] [-Os=mode] [-Lh=mode] [-Tr=mode] [-  
Hld=PrintType:UserID:Password:DocumentName] [-Jown= jobownername:password:jobgroupname] [filename...]  
Function  
Reads TIFF data, converts it to the PostScript language program and writes to standard output. If the filename is not  
specified, the standard input will be taken as the command input. TIFF files with a pixel depth of 1, 4, 8, 24, and 32 bits  
can be specified.  
There are four types of supported compression formats.  
Huffman compression (CCITT Group 3 transformed Huffman run length encoding)  
Fax-CCITT3 compression (facsimile-compatible CCITT Group 3)  
PackBits compression  
Non-compression  
Even in the above compression format, the TIFF file that has multiple images in one file is not supported.  
tiff2ps2 takes filename as having been created in 72 dpi and calculates the output size. Thus, to convert TIFF files created  
in other resolutions, specify the size option (-s, -S) explicitly for conversion.  
Option  
-d  
Enables the short-edge binding feature. When it is specified, the printing direction or position will be adjusted and  
both sides of the paper printed so that the shorter edge of the pages can be bound.  
-D  
Enables the long-edge binding feature. When it is specified, the printing direction or position will be adjusted and  
both sides of the paper printed so that the longer edge of the pages can be bound. This option is available only  
when the duplexer is installed on the printer.  
-Itray-input  
Specifies the paper tray.  
A paper tray can be selected by directly specifying a tray or by specifying a paper size.  
When a paper size is specified, the tray loaded with paper of the specified size will be found and selected  
automatically.  
The parameters for selecting a paper tray are as follows:  
1
Feed paper from tray 1 (top tray).  
2
Feed paper from tray 2 (the second tray from the top).  
3
Feed paper from tray 3 (the third tray from the top).  
4
Feed paper from tray 4 (the fourth tray from the top).  
5
Feed paper from tray 5 (the fifth tray from the top).  
A4  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with A4 (210 x 297 mm).  
A5  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with A5 (148 x 210 mm).  
B5  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with B5 (182 x 257 mm).  
LT  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Letter (8.5 x 11 inches).  
FL  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Folio (8.5 x 13 inches).  
LG  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Legal (8.5 x 14 inches).  
EX  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches).  
MO  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Monarch (3.875 x 7.5 inches).  
COM10  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Envelope #10 (4.125 x 9.5 inches).  
DL  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with DL (110 x 220 mm).  
C5  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with C5 (162 x 229 mm).  
MxNmm  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with MxNmm defined by users  
Possible range specified:  
Width: 76.2 to 215.9 mm  
Length: 127.0 to 355.6 mm  
MxNin  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with MxNinches defined by users  
Possible range specified:  
Width: 3.00 to 8.5 inches  
Length: 5.00 to 14.0 inches  
If this option is not specified or the tray specified is not available, feed paper from the default tray.  
-t  
Turns on the save toner mode for printing. The print result will be fainter than that of normal printing. In some  
cases, this option will be ignored.  
-r  
Rotates the image by 90° and uses the paper in the landscape orientation.  
-n  
Disables the addition of the showpage. It is used when files converted to the PostScript language program are  
merged with files created with other applications.  
-l=left,bottom  
Specifies the print position. Printing will be executed from the left and bottom of the page. The default is 0.25  
inches for both left and bottom.  
-s=width,height  
Specifies the output size. Printing will be executed with the width and height in inches.  
-S=width  
Sets the width of the output size in inches. The height will be calculated automatically according to the width.  
-E  
This function turns on the image enhancement function. In some cases, this option will be ignored.  
-Nc=copies  
Specifies the number of output copies (the value of copies must be a positive integer).  
-Cl  
Specifies that printing be collated. If the copies option is not specified, this option will be ignored.  
-Hd=position:format  
Specifies the position to be output the user information as the header or footer.  
position specifies output position. But this option is available only for converting text files.  
ul  
Output on the upper left corner of the paper.  
ur  
Output on the upper right corner of the paper.  
dl  
Output on the lower left corner of the paper.  
dr  
Output on the lower right corner of the paper.  
format specifies the contents and the order to output. This option is omissible.  
If this option is omitted, uh is specified as the default value.  
u
User name  
h
Host name  
t
Date and time  
If the output contents are specified as tuh, it is output as follows.  
Date and Time User: username Host: hostname.  
Specify these options as follows.  
In the case that convert text file, output the host name following the user name on the upper right corner of the  
paper, output all pages.  
(User name, Host name, all page output are default)  
-Hd=ur  
-Hd=ur:uh  
-Hffont  
Specify the font to print header and footer. European fonts the same as half size alphanumeric fonts can be  
specified. Helvetica is specified as default.  
If the wrong font is specified, default European font of the printer can be used.  
If header/footer output option is specified, the font specification of header/footer is ignored.  
-MSI  
Specifies multipurpose feeder.  
-M=type  
Specifies multipurpose feeder Paper Type.  
Available multipurpose feeder Paper Types are as follows:  
B
FinePaper/Bond/Plain Paper 2  
BB  
FinePaperBack/Bond/Plain Paper 2 - Side 2  
P
Stationery/Plain/Plain Paper 1  
PB  
StationeryBack/Plain/Plain Paper 1 - Side 2  
R
Recycled Paper  
RB  
RecycledPaperBack/ Recycled Paper - Side 2  
H1  
ThickPaper/Heavyweight 1/Covers 1  
H1B  
ThickPaperBack/Heavyweight 1/Covers 1 - Side 2  
H2  
ThickPaper2/Heavyweight 2/Covers 2  
H2B  
ThickPaper2Back/Heavyweight 2/Covers 2 - Side 2  
OHP  
Transparency  
L
LabelPaper/Labels  
C2  
Coated/Coated 2/Coated Paper 2  
C2B  
Coated Back/Coated 2/Coated Paper 2- Side 2  
C3  
Coated Thick/Coated 3/Coated Paper 3  
C3B  
Coated Thick Back/Coated 3/Coated Paper 3- Side 2  
LH  
Letterhead  
E
Envelope  
If this option is not specified, multipurpose feeder Paper Type of the printer can be used.  
-Mfo=mode  
Specifies orientation for multipurpose feeder.  
Available orientations for multipurpose feeder are as follows:  
le  
Landscape  
ler  
Landscape (Rotated)  
se  
Portrait  
ser  
Portrait (Rotated)  
-Pon  
Specifies alternate tray.  
Available alternate trays are follows.  
0
Use printer settings  
1
Display message  
2
Feed from multipurpose feeder  
3
Use nearest size (Adjust to fit)  
4
Use larger size (Adjust to fit)  
5
Use nearest size (No zoom)  
6
Use larger size (No zoom)  
-St=mode  
Specifies feed separators from.  
Available feed separators from the following.  
auto  
AutoTray/Auto  
1
1stTray/Tray 1 (Standard 550-sheet feeder)  
2
2ndTray/Tray 2 (Optional 550-sheet feeder)  
3
3rdTray/Tray 3 (Optional 550-sheet feeder)  
4
4thTray/Tray 4 (Optional 1100-sheet feeder)  
5
5thTray/Tray 5 (Optional 1100-sheet feeder)  
msi  
off  
Multipurpose Feeder  
Off  
-Sp  
-Sb  
Specifies printed separators.  
Available only when the paper tray for separators is specified.  
Specifies Skip Blank Pages.  
-Cm=mode  
Specifies output color.  
Available output colors are as follows:  
c
Color (CMYK)  
k
Black  
-Pr=mode  
Specifies print mode.  
Available print modes are as follows:  
hs  
High Speed  
hq  
High Quality  
hr  
High Resolution  
-Cc=mode  
Specifies image types.  
Available image types are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
Photo  
2
Screen Display  
3
Standard/ Normal  
4
Business Graphics  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Gc=mode  
Specifies RGB gamma correction.  
Available RGB gamma corrections are as follows:  
1.0  
1.0  
1.4  
1.8  
2.2  
2.6  
Off  
1.4  
1.8  
2.2  
2.6  
off  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Sc=mode  
Specifies screen.  
Available screens are as follows:  
0
Fineness  
1
Standard  
2
Auto  
3
Gradation  
-Gg=mode  
Specifies gray guaranteed.  
Available gray guaranteed options are as follows:  
on  
On  
off  
Off  
This option is available only for color printing.  
-Ct  
Specifies color transformation.  
This option is available only for color printing.  
-Br=mode  
Specifies brightness adjustment.  
Available brightness adjustment option values are as follows:  
+5  
Bright 5  
+4  
Bright 4  
+3  
Bright 3  
+2  
Bright 2  
Bright 1  
Normal  
Dark 1  
Dark 2  
Dark 3  
Dark 4  
Dark 5  
+1  
+0  
-1  
-2  
-3  
-4  
-5  
-RGBc=mode  
Specifies RGB color correction.  
Available RGB color corrections are as follows:  
10  
Perceptual  
11  
Saturation  
12  
RelativeC  
13  
AbsoluteC  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-RGBPr=mode  
Specifies RGB input profile.  
Available RGB input profile option value are as follows:  
0
sRGB  
1
AdobeRGB  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-RGBTp=mode  
Specifies RGB color temperature.  
Available RGB color temperature option value are as follows:  
5000  
5000K  
6000  
6000K  
9300  
9300K  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Cb=cyan-low:cyan-middle:cyan-high:magenta-low:magenta-middle:magenta-high:yellow-low:yellow-  
middle:yellow high:black-low:black-middle:black-high  
Specifies adjustment value for color balance of each color/density.  
Available adjustment values are as follows:  
+3  
Dark 3  
+2  
Dark 2  
+1  
Dark 1  
0
Normal  
-1  
Light 1  
-2  
Light 2  
-3  
Light 3  
-Cb  
Option value must be specified in the following order:  
Cyan low density, Cyan medium density, Cyan high density, Magenta low density, Magenta medium density,  
Magenta high density, Yellow low density, Yellow medium density, Yellow high density, Black low density,  
Black medium density, Black high density  
If no value is specified, it is treated as "0"(Normal).  
For example, if you want to specify "Light 2" for Cyan medium density, "Dark 3" for Yellow high density, and  
"Dark 2" for Black low density, it can be specified using either of the following:  
-Cb=0:-2:0:0:0:0:0:0:+3:+2:0:0  
-Cb=:-2:::::::+3:+2::  
-Sl=mode  
Specifies staple settings.  
Available staple option values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
This option is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
-Os=mode  
Specifies offset settings.  
Available offset option values are as follows:  
0
Auto  
1
Offset per Set (Offsets each copy before printing the next copy.)  
2
Offset per Job (Offsets each copy per paper job you specify.)  
This option is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
-Lh=mode  
Specifies letterhead duplex mode settings.  
When letterhead duplex mode is enabled, a print sheet is always fed through duplex feeding path in a printer. As  
the result, a user can set sheets without caring about sheet orientation in an input slot.  
Available Letterhead duplex mode values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
2
Auto  
-Tr=mode  
Specifies trapping settings.  
Available trapping option values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
-Hld=PrintType:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
Secure Print  
PrintType  
secure  
Secure Print  
private  
Private MailBox Print  
public  
Public MailBox Print  
proof  
Proof Print  
UserID  
Up to eight single-byte characters from 0x20 to 0x7E, except 0x20 " " (blank) and 0x3A":" (colon).  
Password  
Up to 12 single-byte characters from 0x30 to 0x39 (numeric characters).  
DocumentName  
Up to 12 single-byte characters from 0x20 to 0x7E, except 0x20 " " (blank) and 0x3A ":" (colon).  
Secure Print  
-Hld=secure:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
-Hld=secure:UserID:Password:  
Private MailBox Print  
-Hld=private:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
-Hld=private:UserID:Password:  
Public MailBox Print  
-Hld=public:UserID::DocumentName  
-Hld=public:UserID::  
Proof Print  
-Hld=proof:UserID::DocumentName  
-Hld=proof:UserID::  
NOTICE: Make sure you specify Secure Print only when you directly print data to a printer. Secure Print may not  
be available if you specify it when data need to be printed through another server or data need to be handled by  
another program such as PostScript files. Collate is automatically specified when you specify Proof Print.  
-Jown= jobownername: Password: jobgroupname Authentication Setting  
Specifies job owner name, password and job group name for authentication.  
When only job owner name is specified (-Jown=jobownername:) (no password specified),  
authentication password is treated as not specified.  
When only password is specified (-Jown=:password) (no job owner name specified), login user name  
is used as job owner name. Entered password is used as authentication password.  
When neither of job owner name nor password is specified (-Jown=:), login user name is used as job  
owner name, and authentication password is treated as not specified.  
When a job owner name exceeds allowable character length, the extra characters are ignored.  
When an unacceptable character is entered for a job owner name, "UnknownUser" becomes the job  
owner name.  
NOTE: Alphanumeric characters, including spaces and colons, and symbols can be entered to specify a job owner  
name.  
NOTE: Up to 32 characters can be entered to specify a job owner name.  
When an unacceptable character is entered in a job group name, the job owner name is treated as not  
specified.  
NOTE: Alphanumeric characters, including spaces and colons, and symbols can be entered to specify a job owner  
name.  
NOTE: Up to 32 characters can be entered to specify a group name.  
When an unacceptable character is entered in a password, or when a specified password is not within  
the range of the allowable character length, the authentication password is treated as not specified.  
NOTE: Acceptable password length is between 4 and 12 characters.  
Incomplete form of -Jown option is treated as no authentication setting being made. In such case, if authentication  
setting is made with the environmental variable, it is used as setting information.  
Example  
To convert the TIFF image into the PostScript language program and output it to a file, type as follows.  
% tiff2ps2 file.tiff > file1.ps  
To output the TIFF image to a printer, type as follows.  
% tiff2ps2 file.tiff | lp  
Important  
When -s and -S are specified at the same time or when the same option is specified twice, the later setting will  
prevail.  
When the output size option (-s, -S) is not specified, scaling will be executed taking one pixel of the TIFF data as  
one pixel of the printer.  
If the print position option (-lleft bottom) specifies a point beyond the printable area of the printer, data beyond  
the printable area will not be printed.  
xwd2ps2 (Solaris/HP-UX)  
Format  
/usr/local/dellbin5130/xwd2ps2 [-d] [-D] [-Itray-input] [-t] [-r] [-n] [-l=left,bottom] [-  
s=width,height] [-S=width] [-E] [-Nc=copies] [-Cl] [-Hd=position:format] [-Hffont] [-MSI] [-M=type]  
[-Mfo=mode] [-Pon] [-St=mode] [-Sp] [-Sb] [-Cm=mode] [-Pr=mode] [-Cc=mode] [-Gc=mode] [-Sc=mode] [-  
Gg=mode] [-Ct] [-Br= mode] [-RGBc= mode] [-RGBPr= mode] [-RGBTp= mode] [-Cb=cyan-low:cyan-  
middle:cyan-high:magentalow:magenta-middle:magenta-high:yellow-low;yellow-middle:yellow-high:black-  
low:black-middle:black-high] [-Sl=mode] [-Os=mode] [-Lh=mode] [-Tr=mode][-  
Hld=PrintType:UserID:Password:DocumentName] [-Jown= jobownername:password:jobgroupname] [filename...]  
Function  
Reads XWD data, converts it to the PostScript language program and writes to standard output. If the filename is not  
specified, the standard input will be taken as the command input. XWD files with a pixel depth of 1, 4, 8, 24, and 32 bits  
can be specified.  
There are three types of supported compression formats.  
The visual class is Static Gray and the pixel is 1 bit.  
The visual class is Pseudo Color and the pixel is 4 bits or 8 bit. The image format is Zpixmap.  
The visual class is True Color and the pixel is 24 bits or 32 bit. The image format is Zpixmap.  
xwd2ps2 takes filename as having been created in 72dpi and calculates the output size. Thus, to convert XWD files  
created in other resolutions, specify the size option (-s, -S) explicitly for conversion.  
Option  
-d  
Enables the short-edge binding feature. When it is specified, the printing direction or position will be adjusted and  
both sides of the paper printed so that the shorter edge of the pages can be bound.  
-D  
Enables the long-edge binding feature. When it is specified, the printing direction or position will be adjusted and  
both sides of the paper printed so that the longer edge of the pages can be bound.  
-Itray-input  
Specifies the paper tray.  
A paper tray can be selected by directly specifying a tray or by specifying a paper size.  
When a paper size is specified, the tray loaded with paper of the specified size will be found and selected  
automatically.  
The parameters for selecting a paper tray are as follows:  
1
Feed paper from tray 1 (top tray).  
2
Feed paper from tray 2 (the second tray from the top).  
Feed paper from tray 3 (the third tray from the top).  
3
4
Feed paper from tray 4 (the fourth tray from the top).  
5
Feed paper from tray 5 (the fifth tray from the top).  
A4  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with A4 (210 x 297 mm).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with A5 (148 x 210 mm).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with B5 (182 x 257 mm).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Letter (8.5 x 11 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Folio (8.5 x 13 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Legal (8.5 x 14 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Monarch (3.875 x 7.5 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with Envelope #10 (4.125 x 9.5 inches).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with DL (110 x 220 mm).  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with C5 (162 x 229 mm).  
A5  
B5  
LT  
FL  
LG  
EX  
MO  
COM10  
DL  
C5  
MxNmm  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with MxN mm defined by users.  
Possible range specified:  
Width: 76.2 to 215.9 mm  
Length: 127.0 to 355.6 mm  
MxNin  
Feed paper from the tray loaded with MxNinches defined by users  
Possible range specified:  
Width: 3.00 to 8.5 inches  
Length: 5.00 to 14.0 inches  
If this option is not specified or the tray specified is not available, feed paper from the default tray.  
-t  
Turns on the save toner mode for printing. The print result will be fainter than that of normal printing. In some  
cases, this option will be ignored.  
-r  
-n  
Rotates the image by 90° and uses the paper in the landscape orientation  
Disables the addition of the showpage. It is used when files converted to the PostScript language program are  
merged with files created with other applications.  
-l=left,bottom  
Specifies the print position. Printing will be executed from the left and bottom of the page. The default is 0.25  
inches for both left and bottom.  
-s=width,height  
Specifies the output size. Printing will be executed with the width and height in inches.  
-S=width  
Sets the width of the output size in inches. The height will be calculated automatically according to the width.  
-E  
This function turns on the image enhancement function. In some cases, this option will be ignored.  
-Nc=copies  
Specifies the number of output copies (the value of copies must be a positive integer).  
-Cl  
Specifies that printing be collated. If the copies option is not specified, this option will be ignored.  
-Hd=position:format  
Specifies the position to be output the user information as the header or footer.  
position specifies output position. But this option is available only for converting text files.  
ul  
Output on the upper left corner of the paper.  
ur  
Output on the upper right corner of the paper.  
dl  
Output on the lower left corner of the paper.  
dr  
Output on the lower right corner of the paper.  
format specifies the contents and the order to output. This option is omissible.  
If this option is omitted, uh is specified as the default value.  
u
User name  
h
Host name  
t
Date and time  
If the output contents are specified as tuh, it is output as follows.  
Date and Time User: username Host: hostname.  
-Hffont  
Specify the font to print header and footer. European fonts the same as half size alphanumeric fonts can be  
specified. Helvetica is specified as default.  
If the wrong font is specified, default European font of the printer can be used.  
If header/footer output option is specified, the font specification of header/footer is ignored.  
-MSI  
Specifies multipurpose feeder.  
-M=type  
Specifies multipurpose feeder Paper Type.  
Available multipurpose feeder Paper Types are as follows:  
B
FinePaper/Bond/Plain Paper 2  
BB  
P
FinePaperBack/Bond/Plain Paper 2 - Side 2  
Stationery/Plain/Plain Paper 1  
PB  
R
StationeryBack/Plain/Plain Paper 1 - Side 2  
Recycled Paper  
RB  
H1  
H1B  
H2  
H2B  
OHP  
L
RecycledPaperBack/ Recycled Paper - Side 2  
ThickPaper/Heavyweight 1/Covers 1  
ThickPaperBack/Heavyweight 1/Covers 1 - Side 2  
ThickPaper2/Heavyweight 2/Covers 2  
ThickPaper2Back/Heavyweight 2/Covers 2 - Side 2  
Transparency  
LabelPaper/Labels  
C2  
C2B  
C3  
C3B  
LH  
E
Coated/Coated 2/Coated Paper 2  
Coated Back/Coated 2/Coated Paper 2- Side 2  
Coated Thick/Coated 3/Coated Paper 3  
Coated Thick Back/Coated 3/Coated Paper 3- Side 2  
Letterhead  
Envelope  
If this option is not specified, multipurpose feeder Paper Type of the printer can be used.  
-Mfo=mode  
Specifies orientation for multipurpose feeder.  
Available orientations for multipurpose feeder are as follows:  
le  
Landscape  
ler  
Landscape (Rotated)  
se  
Portrait  
ser  
Portrait (Rotated)  
-Pon  
Specifies alternate tray.  
Available alternate trays are as follows:  
0
Use printer settings  
1
Display message  
2
Feed from multipurpose feeder  
3
Use nearest size (Adjust to fit)  
4
Use larger size (Adjust to fit)  
5
Use nearest size (No zoom)  
6
Use larger size (No zoom)  
-St=mode  
Specifies feed separators from.  
Available feed separators from the following.  
auto  
AutoTray/Auto  
1
1stTray/Tray 1 (Standard 550-sheet feeder)  
2
2ndTray/Tray 2 (Optional 550-sheet feeder)  
3
3rdTray/Tray 3 (Optional 550-sheet feeder)  
4
4thTray/Tray 4 (Optional 1100-sheet feeder)  
5
5thTray/Tray 5 (Optional 1100-sheet feeder)  
msi  
Multipurpose Feeder  
off  
Off  
-Sp  
-Sb  
Specifies printed separators.  
Available only when the paper tray for separators is specified.  
Specifies Skip Blank Pages.  
-Cm=mode  
Specifies output color.  
Available output colors are as follows:  
c
Color (CMYK)  
k
Black  
-Pr=mode  
Specifies print mode.  
Available print modes are as follows:  
hs  
High Speed  
hq  
High Quality  
hr  
High Resolution  
-Cc=mode  
Specifies image types.  
Available image types are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
Photo  
2
Screen Display  
3
Standard/ Normal  
4
Business Graphics  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Gc=mode  
Specifies RGB gamma correction.  
Available RGB gamma corrections are as follows:  
1.0  
1.0  
1.4  
1.4  
1.8  
1.8  
2.2  
2.2  
2.6  
2.6  
off  
Off  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Sc=mode  
Specifies screen.  
Available screens are as follows:  
0
Fineness  
1
Standard  
2
Auto  
3
Gradation  
-Gg=mode  
Specifies gray guaranteed.  
Available gray guaranteed options are as follows:  
on  
On  
off  
Off  
This option is available only for color printing.  
-Ct  
Specifies color transformation.  
This option is available only for color printing.  
-Br=mode  
Specifies brightness adjustment.  
Available brightness adjustment option values are as follows:  
+5  
Bright 5  
+4  
Bright 4  
+3  
Bright 3  
+2  
Bright 2  
+1  
Bright 1  
+0  
Normal  
-1  
Dark 1  
-2  
Dark 2  
-3  
Dark 3  
-4  
-5  
Dark 4  
Dark 5  
-RGBc=mode  
Specifies RGB color correction.  
Available RGB color corrections are as follows:  
10  
Perceptual  
11  
Saturation  
12  
RelativeC  
13  
AbsoluteC  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-RGBPr=mode  
Specifies RGB input profile.  
Available RGB input profile option value are as follows:  
0
sRGB  
1
AdobeRGB  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-RGBTp=mode  
Specifies RGB color temperature.  
Available RGB color temperature option value are as follows:  
5000  
5000K  
6000  
6000K  
9300  
9300K  
This option is available only for color printing and when entry data is RGB data.  
-Cb=cyan-low:cyan-middle:cyan-high:magenta-low:magenta-middle:magenta-high:yellow-low:yellow-  
middle:yellow high:black-low:black-middle:black-high  
Specifies adjustment value for color balance of each color/density.  
Available adjustment values are as follows:  
+3  
Dark 3  
+2  
Dark 2  
+1  
Dark 1  
0
Normal  
-1  
-2  
-3  
-Cb  
Light 1  
Light 2  
Light 3  
Option value must be specified in the following order:  
Cyan low density, Cyan medium density, Cyan high density, Magenta low density, Magenta medium density,  
Magenta high density, Yellow low density, Yellow medium density, Yellow high density, Black low density,  
Black medium density, Black high density  
If no value is specified, it is treated as "0"(Normal).  
For example, if you want to specify "Light 2" for Cyan medium density, "Dark 3" for Yellow high density, and  
"Dark 2" for Black low density, it can be specified using either of the following:  
-Cb=0:-2:0:0:0:0:0:0:+3:+2:0:0  
-Cb=:-2:::::::+3:+2::  
-Sl=mode  
Specifies staple settings.  
Available staple option values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
This option is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
-Os=mode  
Specifies offset settings.  
Available offset option values are as follows:  
0
Auto  
1
Offset per Set (Offsets each copy before printing the next copy.)  
2
Offset per Job (Offsets each copy per paper job you specify.)  
This option is available only when the optional output expander is installed.  
-Lh=mode  
Specifies letterhead duplex mode settings.  
When letterhead duplex mode is enabled, a print sheet is always fed through duplex feeding path in a printer. As  
the result, a user can set sheets without caring about sheet orientation in an input slot.  
Available Letterhead duplex mode values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
2
Auto  
-Tr=mode  
Specifies trapping settings.  
Available trapping option values are as follows:  
0
Off  
1
On  
-Hld=PrintType:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
Secure Print  
PrintType  
secure  
Secure Print  
private  
Private MailBox Print  
public  
Public MailBox Print  
proof  
Proof Print  
UserID  
Up to eight single-byte characters from 0x20 to 0x7E, except 0x20 " " (blank) and 0x3A":" (colon).  
Password  
Up to 12 single-byte characters from 0x30 to 0x39 (numeric characters).  
DocumentName  
Up to 12 single-byte characters from 0x20 to 0x7E, except 0x20 " " (blank) and 0x3A ":" (colon).  
Secure Print  
-Hld=store:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
-Hld=store:UserID:Password:  
Private MailBox Print  
-Hld=private:UserID:Password:DocumentName  
-Hld=private:UserID:Password:  
Public MailBox Print  
-Hld=public:UserID::DocumentName  
-Hld=public:UserID::  
Proof Print  
-Hld=proof:UserID::DocumentName  
-Hld=proof:UserID::  
NOTICE: Make sure you specify Secure Print only when you directly print data to a printer. Secure Print may not  
be available if you specify it when data need to be printed through another server or data need to be handled by  
another program such as PostScript files. Collate is automatically specified when you specify Proof Print.  
-Jown= jobownername: Password: jobgroupname Authentication Setting  
Specifies job owner name, password, and job group name for authentication.  
When only job owner name is specified (-Jown=jobownername:) (no password specified),  
authentication password is treated as not specified.  
When only password is specified (-Jown=:password) (no job owner name specified), login user name  
is used as job owner name. Entered password is used as authentication password.  
When neither of job owner name nor password is specified (-Jown=:), login user name is used as job  
owner name, and authentication password is treated as not specified.  
When a job owner name exceeds allowable character length, the extra characters are ignored.  
When an unacceptable character is entered to specify a job owner name, "UnknownUser" becomes the  
job owner name.  
NOTE: Characters acceptable for job owner name are alphanumeric characters and symbols, except for space and  
colon.  
NOTE: Up to 32 characters become the job owner name.  
When an unacceptable character is entered in a job group name, the job owner name is treated as not  
specified.  
NOTE: Alphanumeric characters, including spaces and colons, and symbols can be entered to specify a job owner  
name.  
NOTE: Up to 32 characters can be entered to specify a group name.  
When an unacceptable character is entered in a password, or when a specified password is not within  
the range of the allowable character length, the authentication password is treated as not specified.  
NOTE: Acceptable password length is between 4 and 12 characters.  
Incomplete form of -Jown option is treated as no authentication setting being made. In such case, if authentication  
setting is made with the environmental variable, it is used as setting information.  
Example  
To convert the XWD image into the PostScript language program and output it to a file, type as follows.  
% xwd2ps2 file.xwd > file.ps  
To output the XWD image to a printer, type as follows.  
% xwd2ps2 file.xwd | lp  
Important  
When -s and -S are specified at the same time or when the same option is specified twice, the later setting will  
prevail.  
When the output size option (-s, -S) is not specified, scaling will be executed taking one pixel of the TIFF data as  
one pixel of the printer.  
If the print position option (-lleft bottom) specifies a point beyond the printable area of the printer, data beyond  
the printable area will not be printed.  
Precautions and Limitations  
During Installation  
Pay attention to the following points during the installation.  
 
Solaris  
Use lpadmin command to register the default printer.  
# lpadmin -d PrinterName  
To inhibit the banner sheets output, change the value of nobanner=no to nobanner=yes that includes in the file  
corresponding to the printer name in /etc/lp/interfaces/.  
The printer registered by UX filter must not be changed by admintool.  
When Content types: postscript is displayed by typing lpstat -p printername -l, it's necessary to delete  
the printer and reinstall.  
To install UX filter into the default directory (/usr/local/dellbin5130), it's necessary to create /usr/local  
directory in advance.  
HP-UX  
The printer to specify as an output printer must be registered in your system. To register an output printer, use sam  
command and so on. See the HP-UX related manual for details.  
To install UX filter into the default directory (/usr/local/dellbin5130), it's necessary to create /usr/local  
directory in advance.  
During Printing  
Pay attention to the following points during printing.  
Using lp/lpr Command (Solaris/HP-UX)  
If an option is specified incorrectly, no error message will be output. If printing is not executed after the lp  
command is executed, activate each utility individually and error messages will be output.  
(Using Solaris, the error message is displayed on the screen.)  
In text printing, the environmental variable TXT2PS2OPTION will be ignored.  
In text printing, if a BS code is found at the beginning of a line, the print position of the next character will be on  
the left of the beginning of the line.  
In text printing, when there are multiple tab codes in one line, the positions of tab may be off due to automatic line  
feed. If this happens, specify l or w option.  
In text printing, the number of columns specified by the w option does not reflect the number of characters actually  
printed. The actual number of single-byte characters to be printed is derived by deducting the output column  
position (out columns) specified by the o option from the number of columns specified by the w option.  
If the same option is specified, or if s, S are both specified, the one specified later will prevail.  
In printing images, If the print position option (l) specifies an area beyond the printable area of the printer, data  
beyond the printable area will not be printed. (Using Solaris, it's impossible to output images by lp command.)  
Using txt2ps2 (Solaris/HP-UX)  
When the same option is specified twice, the later setting will prevail. As TXT2PS2OPTION is analyzed before the  
option of the command line, it is possible to temporarily modify the options already set in TXT2PS2OPTION by  
inputting at the command line  
The default output of txt2ps2 cannot output the comment description (%%page:m n) of the page number. This is  
because the converted PostScript language program controls line feed and form feed. Thus, when the output of  
txt2ps2 is to be taken as the output of another application (psrev of TRANSCRIPT, etc.), add the page number  
description by inserting the line command (-Ilines).  
If a BS code is found at the beginning of a line, the print position of the next character will be on the left of the  
beginning of a line.  
When there are multiple tab codes in one line, the positions of tab may be off due to automatic line feed. If this  
happens, specify the -l or -w option.  
The number of columns specified by the -w option does not reflect the number of characters actually printed. The  
actual number of single-byte characters to be printed is derived by deducting the output column position (out  
columns) specified by the o option from the number of columns specified by the w option.  
The -mg option cannot be specified when -w, -l, -o, and -L option are specified.  
The start positions of margins of the margin command (-mg=u:b:r:l) are not set against the edge of paper. The  
margins are set against the printable area for paper allowed by the printer.  
Use the -ps option only when a PostScript file that contains no %! at the beginning of the file is used as the  
PostScript file. If a normal text file is input, it will not function correctly.  
To use the same options as those of the dellpsif filter by TXT2PS2OPTION, set the user's home directory in the  
environmental variable HOME. If the environmental variable HOMEis not set up, the same options as those of the  
dellpsif filter cannot be used. (Linux)  
Using sunras2ps2/tiff2ps2/xwd2ps2 (sunras2ps2 apply to Solaris only)  
If the same option is specified, or if s, S are both specified, the one specified later will prevail.  
If the size option (s, S) is not specified, scaling will be executed taking one pixel of the image data as one pixel of  
the printer.  
If the print position option (-l left bottom) specifies a point beyond the printable area of the printer, data beyond  
the printable area will not be printed.  
Using tiff2ps2 (Solaris/HP-UX)  
There are four types of supported compression formats.  
Huffman compression (CCITT Group 3 transformed Huffman run length encoding)  
Fax-CCITT3 compression (facsimile-compatible CCITT Group 3)  
PackBits compression  
Non-compression  
Even if the format is a supported format, the tiff that has multiple images in one file is not supported.  
Using xwd2ps2 (Solaris/ HP-UX)  
There are three types of supported compression formats.  
The visual class is Static Gray and the pixel is 1 bit.  
The visual class is Pseudo Color and the pixel is 4 bits or 8 bit. The image format is Zpixmap.  
The visual class is True Color and the pixel is 24 bits. The image format is Zpixmap.  
Printing PostScript Files (Solaris/ HP-UX)  
If same options for the PostScript file that contains options, such as paper size, are specified using dellpsif (Linux)  
or the lp command (Solaris/HP-UX), the specified option will be ignored.  
Printing Image Files (Solaris)  
To print image files from Solaris the user cannot specify the image file directly with the lp command for printing.  
Make use of sunras2ps2, tiff2ps2, xwd2ps2 and convert the file to a PostScript file. Output it using the lp command  
after the conversion.  
% xwd2ps2 file.xwd | lp  
Header/footer Option (-Hd=position:format:page, -Hfheaderfont)  
(txt2ps2,sunras2ps2,tiff2ps2,xwd2ps2)  
If the paper size is not specified when using options, it outputs the header/footer at the position of A4-size paper.  
To specify the paper size at the same time to use header/footer option. (If the paper size for the PostScript file  
converted by using the option is specified by the option of lp command for example, the position of the header and  
footer cannot be changed.)  
The margin is specified automatically when the option is used. When the option to specify the margin is used at the  
same time, the value that is smaller than the value specified automatically as follows is ignored.  
In case of text files  
Upper margin: 0.23 inch  
Lower margin: 0.06 inch  
Right margin: 0.03 inch  
Left margin: 0.09 inch  
In case of images  
Lower margin: 0.3 inch  
When using the option, the number of lines and the number of columns specified are ignored. Also, it is impossible  
to specify landscape and 2-column.  
In case of the PostScript file, it happens that the printer doesn't output all pages despite that output all page is  
specified. In such a case, specify print the only top page.  
It's impossible to use lp command in Solaris.  
TBCPFilter (Solaris/HP-UX)  
Make sure the TBCPFilter is available so the printer can specify the availability of the TBCPFilter.  
As for libtiff  
Copyright © 1988-1997 Sam Leffler  
Copyright © 1991-1997 Silicon Graphics, Inc.  
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS-IS" AND WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR OTHERWISE,  
INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  
IN NO EVENT SHALL SAM LEFFLER OR SILICON GRAGHICS BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, INDIRECT OR  
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY KIND, OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR  
PROFITS, WHETHER OR NOT ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF DAMAGE, AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ARISING  
OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.  
Printing With CUPS (Linux)  
This section provides information for printing or setting up the printer driver with CUPS (Common UNIX Printing System)  
on Turbolinux FUJI, RedHat Enterprise Linux ES 4.0/RedHat Enterprise Linux 5.0 Desktop or SUSE Linux Enterprise  
Desktop 10.  
Operation on Turbolinux FUJI or RedHat Enterprise Linux ES  
4.0/RedHat Enterprise Linux 5.0 Desktop  
Setup Overview  
Turbolinux FUJI or RedHat Enterprise Linux ES 4.0/RedHat Enterprise Linux 5.0 Desktop:  
1. Install the printer driver.  
2. Set up the print queue.  
3. Specify the default queue.  
4. Specify the printing options.  
Installing the Printer Driver  
1. Double-click Dell-5130cdn-Color-Laser-x.x-x.noarch.rpm in the Drivers and Utilities CD.  
2. Type the administrator's password.  
3. Click Continue in the Completed System Preparation window.  
Installation starts. When the installation is complete, the window is automatically closed.  
Setting Up the Queue  
To execute printing, you must set up the print queue on your workstation.  
1. Open the URL "http://localhost:631" using a web browser.  
2. Click Administration.  
3. Type rootas the user name, and type the ROOT password as the password.  
4. Click Add Printer.  
5. Type the printer's name in the Name box in the Add New Printer window, and then click Continue.  
The Location and Description do not have to be specified.  
6. Select LPD/LPR Host or Printer from Device menu, and then click Continue.  
7. Type the printer's IP address in Device URI.  
   
Format: lpd://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx (printer's IP address)  
8. Select Dell from the Make menu, and then click Continue.  
9. Select Dell 5130cdn Color Laser... from the Model menu, and then click Continue.  
The message Printer xxx has been added successfully. appears.  
The set up is complete.  
When you have finished setting up the queue you can print jobs from the software program. Start the print job from the  
software program, and then specify the queue in the print dialog box.  
However, sometimes you can only print from the default queue depending on the software program (for example Mozilla).  
In these cases, before you start printing, set queue you want to print to as the default queue. For information on  
specifying the default queue, see "Setting the Default Queue."  
Setting the Default Queue  
1. Select Main Menu® System Tools® Terminal.  
2. Type the following command in the terminal window.  
su  
(Type the administrator's password)  
lpadmin -d (The queue name)  
Specifying Printing Options  
You can specify the printing options such as color mode or double-sided printing.  
1. Open the URL "http://localhost:631" using a web browser.  
2. Click Manage Printers.  
3. Click Configure Printer of the queue for which you want to specify the printing options.  
4. Type rootas the user name, and type the administrator's password.  
5. Specify the required settings, and then click Continue.  
The message Printer xxx has been configured successfully. appears.  
The setting is complete. Execute printing from the software program.  
Uninstalling the Printer Driver  
1. Select Main Menu® System Tools® Terminal.  
2. Type the following command in the terminal window.  
su  
(Type the administrator's password)  
rpm -e Dell-5130cdn-Color-Laser  
The printer driver is uninstalled.  
Operation on SUSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 10  
   
Installing the Printer Driver  
1. Double-click Dell-5130cdn-Color-Laser-x.x-x.noarch.rpm in the Drivers and Utilities CD.  
2. Type the administrator's password and click Install.  
Installation starts. When the installation is complete, the window is automatically closed.  
Setting Up the Queue  
To execute printing, you must set up the print queue on your workstation.  
1. Select Computer® More Applications... and select YaST on the Application Browser.  
2. Type the administrator's password.  
YaST Control Center is activated.  
3. Select Hardware on the YaST Control Center and select Printer.  
4. Printer setup: Autodetected printers is activated.  
For USB connections:  
a. Select Dell 5130cdn Color Laser on USB (//Dell/5130cdn%20Color%20Laser or /dev/usblp*) as  
Available are, and then click Configure....  
b. Confirm the settings in Edit configuration, and then click OK.  
For parallel connections:  
a. Click Add.  
b. Select Directly Connected Printers as Printer Type, and then click Next.  
c. Select Parallel printer as Printer Type, and then click Next.  
d. Click Next.  
e. Set the name of the printer queue in Queue name, and type the queue name for printing in Name for  
printing.  
The Description of Printer and Location of Printer do not have to be specified.  
f. Select the Do Local Filtering check box, and then click Next.  
g. Select DELL in Select manufacturer. Select 5130cdn Color Laser in Select Model, and then click Next.  
h. Confirm the settings in Edit configuration, and then click OK.  
For network connections:  
a. Click Add.  
b. Select Network Printers as Printer Type, and then click Next.  
c. Select the Print via LPD-Style Network Server as Printer Type, and then click Next.  
d. Type the printer's IP address in Host name of the printer server. And type the name of the printer queue  
in Name of the remote queue, and then click Next.  
e. Type the printer name in Name for printing.  
The Description of Printer and Location of Printer do not have to be specified.  
f. Select the Do Local Filtering check box, and then click Next.  
g. Select DELL as Select manufacturer. Select 5130cdn Color Laser as Select Model, and then click Next.  
h. Confirm the settings in Edit configuration, and then click OK.  
5. Click Finish.  
Printing From the Application Program  
When you have finished setting up the queue you can print jobs from the application program. Start the print job from the  
application program, and then specify the queue in the print dialog box.  
However, sometimes you can only print from the default queue depending on the application program (for example  
Mozilla). In these cases, before you start printing, set queue you want to print to as the default queue. For information on  
specifying the default queue, see "Setting the Default Queue."  
Setting the Default Queue  
1. To activate the Printer setup: Autodetected printers, do the following.  
a. Select Computer® More Applications... and select YaST on the Application Browser.  
b. Type the administrator's password.  
YaST Control Center is activated.  
c. Select Hardware on the YaST Control Center and select Printer.  
2. Select the printer you want to set to default on the Printer Configuration, and select Set default in Other  
button menu.  
3. Click Finish.  
Specifying the Printing Options  
You can specify the printing options such as color mode or double-sided printing.  
1. Open a web browser.  
2. Type http://localhost:631/admin in Location, and then press the <Enter> key.  
3. Type rootas the user name, and type the administrator's password.  
The CUPS window appears.  
NOTE: Set the password for authority as the printer administrator before setting the printer queue. If you  
4. Click Manage Printers.  
5. Specify the required settings, and then click Continue.  
The message Printer xxx has been configured successfully. appears.  
The setting is complete. Execute printing from the application program.  
   
Setting the Password for Authority as the Printer Administrator  
You must set the password for authority as the printer administrator to do operations as the printer administrator.  
1. Select Computer® More Applications... and select Konsole on the Application Browser.  
2. Type the following command on the terminal window.  
su  
(Type the administrator's password.)  
lppasswd -g sys -a root  
(Type the password for authority as the printer administrator after the Enter password prompt.)  
(Retype the password for authority as the printer administrator after the Enter password again prompt.)  
Uninstalling the Printer Driver  
1. Select Computer® More Applications... and select Konsole on the Application Browser.  
2. Type the following command on the terminal window.  
su  
(Type the administrator's password)  
rpm -e Dell-5130cdn-Color-Laser  
The printer driver is uninstalled.  
Printer Specifications  
OS Compatibility  
®
Your Dell™ 5130cdn Color Laser Printer is compatible with Windows (2000, XP, XP x64, Vista, Vista x64, 7, 7 x64, Server  
2003, Server 2003 x64, Server 2008, Server 2008 x64, Server 2008 R2 x64); Mac OS X (10.2.8/10.3.9/10.4.x/10.5.x);  
®
1
Novell (3.12, 3.2, 4.1, 4.11, 4.2, 5, 5.1, 6, 6.5 (SP1.1 or later)) but not supported ; Linux (Turbolinux FUJI (English),  
2
SUSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 10 (English), RedHat Enterprise Linux ES 4.0/5.0 (English)) but not supported ; Unix (HP-  
UX 11.i (English), Solaris 9/10 (English)) but not supported.  
1
Dell technical phone support only supports factory-installed operating systems (Microsoft) for the first 30 days for free.  
details. The customer will have to purchase technical support from the manufacturer of the operating system in order to  
get technical assistance beyond 30 days.  
2
If the customer has other operating systems and has purchased Gold Technical Support (for more information on Gold  
c=us&cs=555&l=en&s=biz), the telephone support will be a "best effort" attempt to resolve the operating system  
issue. If the manufacturer needs to be contacted, the customer must pay an additional fee for that support. The only time  
that Dell pays for the third-party support is when Dell is responsible for the issue. In the case of getting the printer  
installed and working, this is configuration and the customer would be responsible for paying.  
Power Supply  
220-240 VAC 110-127 VAC  
Rated Voltage  
50/60 Hz  
4 A  
50/60 Hz  
8 A  
Frequency  
Current  
Dimensions  
Height: 431 mm (17 in.) Width: 560 mm (22 in.) Depth: 505 mm (20 in.)  
Weight (not including cartridge): 41.5 kg (91.5 lb)  
Memory  
Base memory  
256 MB  
Maximum memory  
DIMM Connector  
1280 MB (256 MB + 1024 MB)  
144 pin DDR2 SO-DIMM  
         
DIMM Size  
1024 MB  
DIMM Speed  
EP2-2100  
Page Description Language (PDL)/Emulation, Operating  
System, and Interface  
PDL/Emulations PostScript 3, PCL 6, PCL5e, XPS  
®
Microsoft Windows 7/7 x64/Server 2008 R2 x64/Vista/Vista x64/Server 2008/Server 2008 x64/XP/XP  
OSes  
x64/Server 2003/Server 2003 x64/2000 (SP3 or later), Mac OS X (10.2.8, 10.3.9, 10.4.x, 10.5.x)  
Standard local:  
USB2.0, IEEE 1284  
Interfaces  
Standard network:  
Optional network:  
10Base-T/100Base-TX/1000Base-T Ethernet  
IEEE802.11b/802.11g/802.11n (Wireless)  
MIB Compatibility  
A Management Information Base (MIB) is a database containing information about network devices (such as adapters,  
bridges, routers, or computers). This information helps network administrators manage the network (analyze  
performance, traffic, errors, and so on). Dell 5130cdn Color Laser Printer complies with standard-industry MIB  
specifications, allowing the printer to be recognized and managed by various printer and network management software  
systems.  
Environment  
Operation  
Temperature  
10-32°C  
15-85% RH (no condensation)  
(Temperature should be 28°C or below at 85% RH.)  
Relative humidity  
Print Quality Guarantee  
Temperature  
15-28°C  
Relative humidity 20-70% RH (no condensation)  
Storage  
Temperature range  
0-35°C (32-95°F)  
Storage humidity range 15-80% RH (no condensation)  
Altitude  
Operating Up to 3,100 m (10,000 feet)  
Storage  
70.9275 Kpa  
   
Cables  
Your interconnection cable must meet the following requirements:  
Connection type Connection specifications and symbols  
1 Ethernet  
2 Wireless  
10 Base-T/100 Base-TX/1000 Base-T  
IEEE802.11b/802.11g/802.11n  
3 USB  
USB2.0  
4 Parallel  
IEEE1284  
 
Maintaining Your Printer  
Periodically, your printer requires you to complete certain tasks to maintain optimum print quality. If several people are  
using the printer, you may want to designate a key operator to maintain your printer. Refer printing problems and  
maintenance tasks to this key operator.  
Determining the Status of Supplies  
If your printer is connected to the network, the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool can provide instant feedback on  
remaining toner levels. Type the printer's IP address in your web browser to view this information. To use the E-Mail  
Alert Setup feature that notifies you when the printer requires new supplies, type your name or the name of the key  
operator in the e-mail list box.  
On the operator panel, you can also confirm the following:  
Any supply or maintenance items that require attention replacing (However, the printer can only display  
information about one item at a time.)  
Amount of toner remaining in each toner cartridge  
Conserving Supplies  
You can change several settings in your printer driver to conserve toner cartridge and paper.  
Supply  
Setting  
Function  
Toner Saving  
Mode in the  
cartridge Advanced tab of  
Toner  
This check box allows the users to select a print mode that uses less toner. When this  
feature is used, the image quality will be lower than when it is not used.  
the printer driver  
The printer prints two or more pages on one side of a sheet. Values for Multiple Up are  
2 Up, 4 Up, 8 Up, 16 Up, or 32 Up. Combined with the duplex setting, Multiple Up  
allows you to print up to 64 pages on one sheet of paper. (32 images on the front and  
32 on the back)  
Multiple Up in the  
Print  
Layout tab of the  
media  
printer driver  
     
Storing Print Media  
To avoid potential paper feeding problems and uneven print quality, there are several things you can do.  
To achieve the best possible print quality, store print media in an environment where the temperature is  
approximately 21°C (70°F) and the relative humidity is 40%.  
Store cartons of print media on a pallet or shelf, rather than directly on the floor.  
If you store individual packages of print media out of the original carton, ensure that they rest on a flat surface so  
the edges do not buckle or curl.  
Do not place anything on top of the print media packages.  
Storing Consumables  
Store consumables in their original packaging until you need to use them. Do not store consumables in:  
Temperatures greater than 40°C (104°F).  
An environment with extreme changes in humidity or temperature.  
Direct sunlight.  
Dusty places.  
A car for a long period of time.  
An environment where corrosive gases are present.  
An environment with salty air.  
Replacing the Toner Cartridges  
NOTICE: Before performing any of the following procedures, read and follow the safety instructions in your Product  
Information Guide provided with your product.  
NOTICE: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from the grounded  
outlet before performing maintenance.  
Dell toner cartridges are available only through Dell. You can order more cartridges online at support.dell.com or by  
phone. To order by phone, see "Contacting Dell."  
It is recommended that you use Dell toner cartridges for your printer. Dell does not provide warranty coverage for  
problems caused by using accessories, parts, or components not supplied by Dell.  
Removing the Toner Cartridges  
1. Turn off the printer.  
     
2. Open the front cover.  
3. Pull out the toner cartridge you want to replace.  
CAUTION: Always pull out the cartridge slowly so you do not spill any toner.  
NOTICE: Do not touch the parts shown in the illustration. Toner can dirty and stain your hands.  
NOTE: Be careful not to spill toner when handling the toner cartridge.  
Installing a Toner Cartridge  
1. Unpack a new toner cartridge of the desired color.  
2. Shake the toner cartridge 5 to 6 times to distribute the toner evenly.  
NOTE: Do not touch the area shown in the illustration when you shake the cartridge.  
NOTE: Be careful not to spill toner when handling the toner cartridge.  
3. Align the arrow on the cartridge with the arrow on the printer, and slide in the cartridge until it stops.  
4. Close the front cover.  
Replacing the Drum Cartridges  
CAUTION: Before performing any of the following procedures, read and follow the safety instructions in  
your Product Information Guide provided with your product.  
CAUTION: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from  
the grounded outlet before performing maintenance.  
NOTICE: To protect the drum cartridges against bright light, close the inner cover within five minutes. If the front  
cover remains open for more than five minutes, print quality may deteriorate.  
NOTE: Video instructions are also available in the Maintenance Guide.  
The Maintenance Guide is included in the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with your printer. Insert the Drivers and  
Utilities CD into your printer.  
Click start® Run, and then type D:\MaintenanceGuide\MaintenanceGuide.exe (where D is the drive  
letter of your CD), and then click OK.  
Removing the Drum Cartridges  
1. Turn off the printer.  
2. Open the front cover.  
 
3. Rotate the lock levers of the inner cover to open it.  
4. Grasp the handles on the drum cartridge you want to replace and pull out the cartridge halfway.  
5. Grasp one side of the drum cartridge with the other hand and pull out the cartridge from the printer.  
NOTICE: Do not touch the parts shown in the illustration. Toner can dirty and stain your hands.  
NOTE: Be careful not to spill toner when handling the drum cartridge.  
 
Installing a Drum Cartridge  
1. Unpack a new drum cartridge.  
NOTICE: To protect the drum from overexposure to bright light, do not remove the orange protective covering  
until you have inserted the cartridge in the printer.  
NOTE: Be careful not to spill toner when handling the drum cartridge.  
2. Pull out the two ribbons.  
3. Slide the cartridge into the correct slot.  
4. Remove the orange protective covering of the installed drum cartridge and discard.  
5. Close the inner cover.  
6. Rotate the lock levers to secure the inner cover while pressing the cover with the other hand.  
7. Remove the cleaning rod from the backside of the front cover.  
8. Remove the cleaning pad by pressing the white tabs between your thumb and index finger.  
9. Unpack a new cleaning pad.  
10. Attach the new cleaning pad to the cleaning rod.  
11. Insert the cleaning rod fully into one of the four holes until it clicks into the interior of the printer as illustrated  
below, and then pull it out.  
12. Repeat Step 11 also on the other three holes. One time insertion is enough for each hole.  
13. Return the cleaning rod to its original location.  
14. Close the front cover.  
NOTE: Whenever you replace the drum cartridges, also clean inside the printer to maintain high image quality. See  
 
Replacing the Fuser  
CAUTION: A CAUTION indicates a potential for property damage, personal injury, or death.  
CAUTION: Before performing any of the following procedures, read and follow the safety instructions in  
your Product Information Guide provided with your product.  
CAUTION: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from  
the grounded outlet before performing maintenance.  
NOTE: Video instructions are also available in the Maintenance Guide.  
The Maintenance Guide is included in the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with your printer.  
Click start® Run, and then type D:\MaintenanceGuide\MaintenanceGuide.exe (where D is the drive letter of  
your CD), and then click OK.  
Dell fuser is available only through Dell. To order by phone, see "Contacting Dell."  
It is recommended to use a Dell fuser for your printer. Dell does not provide warranty coverage for problems caused by  
using accessories, parts, or components not supplied by Dell.  
Removing the Fuser  
CAUTION: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from  
the grounded outlet before performing maintenance.  
CAUTION: To avoid burns, do not replace the fuser immediately after printing. The fuser becomes  
extremely hot during use.  
1. Turn off the printer and wait for 30 minutes before removing the fuser.  
2. Raise the latch on the handle of the right hand cover to open the cover.  
 
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you replace the  
fuser.  
3. Grasp both handles of the installed fuser with your hands and pull it out.  
Installing a Fuser  
1. Unpack a new fuser.  
2. Grasp both handles of the fuser with your hands and install the fuser in the printer.  
3. Close the right hand cover.  
NOTE: When closing the right hand cover, apply your hand in the vicinity of the handle as shown in the illustration,  
and then press the cover firmly toward the printer.  
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you close the  
right hand cover.  
Replacing the Separator Rollers  
There are three separator rollers in the printer which need to be replaced periodically. One is in the tray and the others  
are inside the printer. All the separator rollers are replaced in the same way as described in this section.  
 
CAUTION: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from  
the grounded outlet before performing maintenance.  
CAUTION: Before performing any of the following procedures, read and follow the safety instructions in  
your Product Information Guide provided with your product.  
NOTE: Video instructions are also available in the Maintenance Guide.  
The Maintenance Guide is included in the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with your printer.  
Click start ® Run, and then type D:\MaintenanceGuide\MaintenanceGuide.exe (where D is the drive  
letter of your CD), and then click OK.  
Removing the Separator Roller in a Tray  
NOTE: Remove all paper or media from the tray before pulling the tray out of the printer.  
1. Remove the tray from the printer.  
2. Turn the separator roller cover to the left to open it, and then hold the cover.  
3. Turn the separator roller cartridge to the right.  
4. Pull out the rear axle, then the front axle from the holes of the tray and remove the separator roller cartridge.  
Installing a Separator Roller in a Tray  
1. Turn the separator roller cover to the left to open it, and then hold the cover.  
2. Slide the front axle, then the rear axle of the separator roller cartridge in the holes of the tray.  
3. Turn the separator roller cartridge to the left to fix it in place.  
4. Turn the separator roller cover to the right to close it.  
5. Load paper in the tray and replace the tray in the printer.  
Removing the Separator Rollers Inside the Printer  
1. Remove the tray from the printer.  
2. Turn the separator roller until the roller hook is visible.  
NOTE: The roller is located approximately 165 mm (6.5 inches) inside the printer when measured from the  
face of the paper tray opening.  
 
3. Pull the separator roller hook out of the groove on the axle, and then slide the separator roller to the front.  
4. Repeat Step 2 and Step 3 to remove other separator rollers from inside the printer.  
Installing Separator Rollers Inside the Printer  
1. Align the hole of the new separator roller with the axle.  
2. Slide the separator roller along the axle so the protrusions fit completely into the slots and the roller hook reseats  
into the groove on the axle.  
3. Replace the tray into the printer.  
 
Replacing the Belt Unit  
CAUTION: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from  
the grounded outlet before performing maintenance.  
CAUTION: Before performing any of the following procedures, read and follow the safety instructions in  
your Product Information Guide provided with your product.  
NOTE: Video instructions are also available in the Maintenance Guide.  
The Maintenance Guide is included in the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with your printer.  
Click start® Run, and then type D:\MaintenanceGuide\MaintenanceGuide.exe (where D is the drive letter  
of your CD), and then click OK.  
NOTICE: Ensure nothing touches or scratches the surface (black-colored film) of the belt unit. Scratches, dirt, or oil  
from your hands on the film of the belt unit may reduce print quality.  
NOTICE: To protect the drum cartridges from overexposure to bright light, close the inner cover within five  
minutes. If the front cover remains open for more than five minutes, print quality may degrade.  
Dell belt units are available only through Dell. To order by phone, see "Contacting Dell." It is recommended to use a Dell  
belt unit for your printer. Dell does not provide warranty coverage for problems caused by using accessories, parts, or  
components not supplied by Dell.  
Removing the Belt Unit  
CAUTION: Do not touch the inside of the printer. Some parts may be hot. Allow time for the printer to  
cool before attempting to remove parts.  
NOTE: Remove all paper from the center output tray, and close the MPF cover before opening the front cover.  
1. Turn off the printer and wait 30 minutes before removing the belt unit.  
2. Raise the latch of the right hand cover and open the cover.  
NOTE: Belt unit can be replaced only when the right hand cover is open.  
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you open  
the right hand cover.  
 
3. Open the front cover.  
4. Rotate the lock levers of the inner cover to open it.  
5. Grasp the handle on the front of the belt unit.  
6. Pull out the belt unit until the line on the unit becomes completely visible.  
7. Grasp the handles on the top of the belt unit. Pull out the unit to remove it from the printer.  
NOTICE: Do not hold the parts shown in the illustration.  
8. Slide the blue tab back-and-forth five times to clean the conductivity temperature depth sensor.  
CAUTION: Be careful not to touch the fuser. It can burn your fingers.  
Installing a Belt Unit  
1. Unpack a new belt unit and place the unit on a level surface.  
 
2. Remove the protective parts shown in the illustration.  
3. Grasp the handles on top of the belt unit.  
NOTICE: Do not hold the sides of the belt unit. It may degrade print quality.  
4. Align the arrows on the belt unit with the arrows on the printer.  
5. Slide the unit into the printer and stop when the visible line reaches the printer.  
6. Lower the handles.  
7. Push the front of the belt unit to reinstall it in the printer until it stops.  
8. Close the inner cover.  
9. Rotate the lock levers to secure the inner cover while pressing the cover with the other hand.  
10. Close the front cover.  
11. Close the right hand cover.  
NOTE: When closing the right hand cover, apply your hand in the vicinity of the handle as shown in the illustration,  
and then press the cover firmly toward the printer.  
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you close the  
right hand cover.  
Replacing the Transfer Roller  
CAUTION: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from  
the grounded outlet before performing maintenance.  
CAUTION: Before performing any of the following procedures, read and follow the safety instructions in  
your Product Information Guide provided with your product.  
NOTE: Video instructions are also available in the Maintenance Guide.  
The Maintenance Guide is included in the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with your printer.  
Click start® Run, and then type D:\MaintenanceGuide\MaintenanceGuide.exe (where D is the drive letter  
of your CD), and then click OK.  
 
Removing the Transfer Roller  
1. Turn off the printer.  
2. Raise the latch of the right hand cover and open the cover.  
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you open  
the right hand cover.  
3. Unlock the two levers on the transfer roller and lift up the roller to remove it.  
Installing a Transfer Roller  
1. Grasp the levers on both sides of the new transfer roller and align the arrows on the transfer roller with the arrows  
inside the printer.  
2. Lower the front of the transfer roller until the roller clicks into place.  
3. Close the right hand cover.  
NOTE: When closing the right hand cover, apply your hand in the vicinity of the handle as shown in the illustration,  
and then press the cover firmly toward the printer.  
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you close the  
right hand cover.  
Replacing the Stapler Cartridge  
CAUTION: Before performing any of the following procedures, read and follow the safety instructions in  
your Product Information Guide provided with your product.  
CAUTION: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from  
the grounded outlet before performing maintenance.  
NOTE: Video instructions are also available in the Maintenance Guide.  
The Maintenance Guide is included in the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with your printer.  
Click start® Run, and then type D:\MaintenanceGuide\MaintenanceGuide.exe (where D is the drive letter  
of your CD), and then click OK.  
Removing the Stapler Cartridge  
1. Confirm that the printer is not in operation, and open the front door of the output expander.  
 
2. Press the orange lever of the staple cartridge holder and pull out the cartridge.  
3. Squeeze the sides of the empty staple case and remove it from the cartridge.  
Installing a Stapler Cartridge  
1. Slide the tip of the new staple case into the cartridge and press the end into place.  
2. Holding the orange lever, push the staple cartridge back into the holder until it clicks into place.  
3. Close the front door of the output expander.  
Replacing the Waste Toner Box  
CAUTION: Before performing any of the following procedures, read and follow the safety instructions in  
your Product Information Guide provided with your product.  
CAUTION: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from  
the grounded outlet before performing maintenance.  
NOTE: Video instructions are also available in the Maintenance Guide.  
The Maintenance Guide is included in the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with your printer.  
Click start® Run, and then type D:\MaintenanceGuide\MaintenanceGuide.exe (where D is the drive letter  
of your CD), and then click OK.  
Removing a Waste Toner Box  
1. Confirm that the printer is not in operation, and open the front cover.  
2. Hook your finger over the top of the waste toner box and pull it out towards you.  
 
3. Grasp the waste toner box with your other hand as shown in the illustration, and pull it out of the printer.  
NOTICE: Take care to avoid dropping the waste toner box while you are removing it.  
NOTICE: After removing the waste toner box, do not touch the parts shown in the illustration. Toner can dirty or  
stain your hands.  
NOTE: Be careful not to spill toner when handling the waste toner box.  
4. Insert the used waste toner box into the plastic bag that came with the new waste toner box and seal the bag.  
Installing a Waste Toner Box  
1. Insert the new waste toner box into the slot and press it in until it stops.  
2. Close the front cover.  
Cleaning Inside the Printer  
To prevent deterioration of printing quality due to stains inside the printer, clean inside the printer regularly by using the  
cleaning rod whenever you replace drum cartridges.  
CAUTION: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from  
the grounded outlet before performing maintenance.  
1. Confirm that the printer is not in operation, and open the front cover.  
2. Remove the cleaning rod from the backside of the front cover.  
3. Insert the cleaning rod fully into one of the four holes until it clicks into the interior of the printer as illustrated  
below, and then pull it out.  
   
4. Repeat Step 3 also on the other three holes.  
5. Return the cleaning rod to its original location.  
6. Close the front cover.  
Cleaning the Conductivity Temperature Depth (CTD) Sensor  
CAUTION: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from  
the grounded outlet before performing maintenance.  
NOTICE: Ensure nothing touches or scratches the surface (black-colored film) of the belt unit. Scratches, dirt, or oil  
from your hands on the film of the belt unit may reduce print quality.  
NOTICE: To protect the drum cartridges from overexposure to bright light, close the inner cover within five  
minutes. If the front cover remains open for more than five minutes, print quality may degrade.  
1. Turn off the printer.  
2. Raise the latch of the right hand cover and open the cover.  
 
NOTE: Belt unit can be replaced only when the right hand cover is open.  
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you open  
the right hand cover.  
3. Open the front cover.  
4. Rotate the lock levers of the inner cover to open it.  
5. Grasp the handle on the front of the belt unit.  
6. Pull out the belt unit until the line on the unit becomes completely visible.  
7. Grasp the handles on the top of the belt unit. Pull out the unit to remove it from the printer.  
NOTICE: Do not hold the parts shown in the illustration.  
8. Slide the blue tab back and forth five times.  
9. Grasp the handles on top of the belt unit.  
10. Align the arrows on the belt unit with the arrows on the printer.  
11. Slide the unit into the printer and stop when the visible line reaches the printer.  
12. Lower the handles.  
13. Push the front of the belt unit to reinstall it in the printer and until it stops.  
14. Close the inner cover.  
15. Rotate the lock levers to secure the inner cover while pressing the cover with the other hand.  
16. Close the front cover.  
17. Close the right hand cover.  
NOTE: When closing the right hand cover, apply your hand in the vicinity of the handle as shown in the illustration,  
and then press the cover firmly toward the printer.  
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you close the  
right hand cover.  
Adjusting Color Registration  
To adjust the color registration when you first install the printer or after moving it to a new location, follow the procedure  
below.  
Printing the Color Registration Chart  
When Using the Operator Panel  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
3. Press  
4. Press  
5. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
button until Maintenance is highlighted, and then press  
button until Color Reg Adj is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
button until Color Regi Chart is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
The color registration chart is printed.  
When Using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Enter the IP address of your printer into the web browser.  
If you do not know how to launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, see "Dell Printer Configuration Web  
Tool."  
The Dell Printer Configuration Tool opens.  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Maintenance tab.  
4. Select Color Registration Adjustment.  
The Color Registration Adjustment page is displayed.  
5. Click the Start button on Color Regi Chart.  
The color registration chart is printed.  
 
6. Adjust all straight lines to a value of 0. Preview image of before and after adjustment will help.  
CAUTION: After printing the color registration chart, do not turn off the printer until the printer motor  
has stopped running.  
NOTE: If the straightest line does not line up perfectly with 0, then determine a value and adjust the color again.  
Determining Values  
From the lines to the right of the Y (Yellow), M (Magenta), and C (Cyan) pattern, find the values of the straightest lines.  
NOTE: You can also use the densest colors of the lattice pattern to find the straightest lines. The colors printed at  
the highest density are those next to the straightest lines. When 0 is the value nearest the straightest line, you do  
not need to adjust the color registration. When the value is not 0, follow the procedure outlined in "Entering  
Values".  
Entering Values  
When Using the Operator Panel  
Using the operator panel, enter the values that you found in the color registration chart to make adjustments.  
1. Press Menu button.  
2. Press  
3. Press  
4. Press  
5. Press  
button until Admin Menuis highlighted, and then press  
button until Maintenance is highlighted, and then press  
button until Color Reg Adj is highlighted, and then press  
button until Enter Number is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
(Set) button.  
The first digit of the Enter Number (for LY, LM, and LC) is highlighted.  
6. Press  
7. Press  
or  
button until you reach the value (for example, +3) displayed on the chart.  
button once until the next value is highlighted.  
(Set) button.  
The first digit of the Enter Number (for RY, RM, and RC) is highlighted.  
When all values are entered, press  
8. Repeat Step 6 and then press  
button once until the next value is highlighted.  
When all values are entered, press  
(Set) button.  
9. Press  
button until Color Regi Chart is highlighted, and then press  
(Set) button.  
The color registration chart is printed with the new values.  
   
10. Color registration adjustment is complete when the straightest Y (Yellow), M (Magenta), and C (Cyan) lines are  
next to the 0 line.  
When Using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool  
1. Enter the IP address of your printer into the web browser.  
If you do not know how to launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, see "Dell Printer Configuration Web  
Tool."  
The Dell Printer Configuration Tool opens.  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Maintenance tab.  
4. Select Color Registration Adjustment.  
The Color Registration Adjustment page is displayed.  
5. Select the value with the straight line respectively, and then click the Apply New Settings button.  
6. Click the Start button on Color Regi Chart.  
The color registration chart is printed.  
7. Adjust all straight lines to a value of 0. Preview image of before and after adjustment will help.  
CAUTION: After printing the color registration chart, do not turn off the printer until the printer motor  
has stopped running.  
NOTE: If the straightest line does not line up perfectly with 0, then determine a value and adjust the color again.  
Removing Options  
If the printer location needs to change or the printer and print media handling options need to be shipped to a new  
location, all print media handling options must be removed from the printer. For shipping, pack the printer and print  
media handling options securely to avoid damage.  
Removing the 550-Sheet Feeder  
CAUTION: If you are removing the 550-sheet feeder, be sure to turn off the printer, unplug the power  
cable, and disconnect all cables from the back of the printer before completing these tasks.  
1. Turn off the printer and unplug the power cable. Then, disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.  
2. Pull the tray out of the printer until it stops. Hold the tray with both hands, lift the front slightly, and remove it  
from the printer.  
3. Remove the plastic part and the two screws provided with the feeder by unscrewing them with a coin or similar  
object.  
   
4. Remove the two screws joining the printer and the sheet feeders by unscrewing them with a coin or similar object.  
5. Gently lift the printer off the tray module, and place it on a level surface.  
CAUTION: To lift the printer safely, lift it with three people.  
6. Insert the tray into the printer, and push it until it stops.  
7. Reconnect all cables including the power cable into the back of the printer and turn on the printer.  
Removing the 1100-Sheet Feeder  
CAUTION: If you are removing the 1100-sheet feeder, be sure to turn off the printer, unplug the power  
cable, and disconnect all cables from the back of the printer before completing these tasks.  
1. Turn off the printer and unplug the power cable. Then, disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.  
2. Lock down the brakes of the two casters at the front of the optional 1100- sheet feeder.  
CAUTION: Failure to lock the brakes can cause the printer to move unexpectedly, resulting in injury.  
NOTE: For easier and safer locking, make the brakes of the two casters face forward by pushing the 1100-sheet  
feeder backward.  
3. Pull the tray out of the printer until it stops. Hold the tray with both hands, Lift the front of the tray slightly, and  
remove it from the printer.  
 
4. Remove the plastic part and the longer screw provided with the feeder by unscrewing them with a coin or similar  
object.  
5. Remove the two screws joining the printer and the sheet feeders by unscrewing them with a coin or similar object.  
6. Gently lift the printer off the tray module, and place it on a level surface.  
CAUTION: To lift the printer safely, lift it with three people.  
7. Insert the tray into the printer, and push it until it stops.  
8. Reconnect all cables including the power cable into the back of the printer and turn on the printer.  
Removing an Output Expander  
1. Turn off the printer.  
2. Remove tray 1.  
3. Open the front cover.  
 
4. Unplug the cables and the connector from the socket.  
5. Remove connector cover 1.  
6. Remove connector cover 2.  
7. Unplug the cables and connector from the socket.  
8. Unplug power cable as shown in the illustration.  
9. Remove the stacker tray.  
10. Gently lift up the output expander from the printer.  
11. Unplug the cables.  
12. Remove the two screws.  
13. Remove the bracket.  
14. Remove the H transport unit from the printer.  
15. Insert the center output tray.  
16. Attach the two parts to the printer.  
17. Close the front cover.  
18. Return the tray 1 to its original position.  
Removing a Memory  
1. Ensure that the printer is turned off.  
2. Rotate the screw counterclockwise on the metal casing to open the cover.  
3. Remove the control board cover.  
4. Push the latches on both edges of the socket at the same time to raise the memory up.  
 
5. Hold the memory and pull it out.  
6. Replace the control board cover.  
7. Close the control board cover and turn the screw clockwise.  
Removing a Hard Disk  
1. Ensure that the printer is turned off.  
2. Rotate the screw counterclockwise on the metal casing to open the cover.  
3. Remove the control board cover.  
4. Remove the hard disk cables from the connectors of the control board.  
 
5. Remove the left side connector to the control board.  
6. Remove the hard disk from the printer by releasing the hard disk's hook.  
7. Replace the control board cover.  
8. Close the control board cover and turn the screw clockwise.  
Removing the Wireless Adapter  
1. Turn off the printer and unplug the power cable. Then, disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.  
2. Rotate the screw counterclockwise on the metal casing to open the cover.  
3. Remove the control board cover.  
 
4. Remove the wireless adapter from the printer by releasing the adapter's hook from underside of the wireless  
adapter socket.  
5. Insert the cap into the wireless adapter socket.  
6. Replace the control board cover.  
7. Close the control board cover and turn the screw clockwise.  
Clearing Jams  
Careful selection of appropriate print media and proper loading allow you to avoid most jams. See "Print Media Guidelines"  
for more information.  
NOTE: It is recommended that you try a sample first before buying large quantities of any print media.  
Avoiding Jams  
Use only recommended print media. See "Print Media Guidelines" for more information.  
media properly.  
Do not overload the print media sources. Ensure the stack print media height does not exceed the maximum height  
indicated by the load line labels in the trays.  
Do not load wrinkled, creased, damp, or curled print media.  
Flex, fan, and straighten print media before you load it. If a jam occurs with print media, try feeding one sheet at a  
time through the multipurpose feeder (MPF).  
Do not use print media that you have cut or trimmed yourself.  
Do not mix print media sizes, weights, or types in the same print media source.  
Ensure that the recommended print side is face up when you insert the print media. Also, the recommended print  
side should be face down when using the MPF.  
Keep print media stored in an acceptable environment. For more information, see "Storing Print Media."  
Do not remove the feeding tray during a print job.  
Push all trays in firmly after loading them.  
Ensure that all cables that connect to the printer are correctly attached.  
Overtightening the guides may cause jams.  
Wipe the feeder rollers in the trays or MPF with a cloth that is slightly dampened with water if jams caused by  
misfeeding paper occur frequently.  
Identifying the Location of Paper Jams  
The following illustration shows where paper jams may occur along the print media path.  
     
CAUTION: Do not attempt to clear any jams using tools or instruments. This may permanently damage  
the printer.  
1 Fuser  
2 Duplexer  
3 Front Cover  
4 MPF  
5 550-Sheet Feeder (optional)  
6 Tray 1  
Clearing Paper Jams From the MPF  
NOTE: To resolve the error displayed on the operator panel, you must clear all print media from the print media  
path.  
1. Remove any paper loaded on or jammed in the MPF.  
2. Close the MPF.  
 
3. Raise the latch on the handle of the right hand cover to open the cover.  
4. Remove any remaining pieces of paper jammed in the MPF.  
5. Use the handle to lift the duplexer.  
6. Remove any remaining pieces of paper.  
7. Close the right hand cover.  
NOTE: When closing the right hand cover, apply your hand in the vicinity of the handle as shown in the illustration,  
and then press the cover firmly toward the printer.  
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you close the  
right hand cover.  
Clearing Paper Jams From the Standard Tray  
NOTE: To resolve the error displayed on the operator panel, you must clear all print media from the print media  
path.  
1. Raise the latch on the handle of the right hand cover to open the cover.  
2. Remove the jammed paper.  
 
3. Use the handle to lift the duplexer.  
4. Remove any remaining pieces of paper.  
5. Close the right hand cover.  
NOTE: When closing the right hand cover, apply your hand in the vicinity of the handle as shown in the illustration,  
and then press the cover firmly toward the printer.  
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you close the  
right hand cover.  
6. Remove tray 1 from the printer.  
7. Remove any paper jammed, creased or both from tray 1.  
8. Replace tray 1 in the printer.  
Clearing Paper Jams From the Fuser  
CAUTION: Before performing any of the following procedures, read and follow the safety instructions in  
your Product Information Guide.  
CAUTION: To prevent electric shock, always turn off the printer and disconnect the power cable from  
the grounded outlet before performing maintenance.  
NOTE: Video instructions are also available in the Maintenance Guide.  
The Maintenance Guide is included in the Drivers and Utilities CD provided with your printer.  
CAUTION: To avoid burns, do not clear paper jams immediately after printing. The fuser becomes  
extremely hot during use.  
NOTE: To resolve the error displayed on the operator panel, you must clear all print media from the print media  
path.  
1. Raise the latch on the handle of the right hand cover to open the cover.  
 
2. Hold and lower the tab to open the inner part.  
CAUTION: Be careful not to touch the fuser. It can burn your fingers.  
3. Remove the jammed paper.  
4. Replace the inner part.  
5. Close the right hand cover.  
NOTE: When closing the right hand cover, apply your hand in the vicinity of the handle as shown in the illustration,  
and then press the cover firmly toward the printer.  
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you close the  
right hand cover.  
Clearing Paper Jams From the Duplexer  
NOTE: To resolve the error displayed on the operator panel, you must clear all print media from the print media  
path.  
1. Open the right hand cover.  
2. Use the handle to lift the duplexer.  
3. Remove any paper from the duplexer.  
 
4. Close the right hand cover.  
NOTE: When closing the right hand cover, apply your hand in the vicinity of the handle as shown in the illustration,  
and then press the cover firmly toward the printer.  
NOTE: Stand straight in front of the right hand cover and not in front of the front cover, whenever you close the  
right hand cover.  
Clearing Paper Jams From the Optional Feeder  
NOTE: To resolve the error displayed on the operator panel, you must clear all print media from the print media  
path.  
1. Open the right hand cover of the optional feeder where paper is jammed.  
2. Remove the jammed paper.  
 
3. Close the right hand cover of the optional feeder.  
4. Remove the tray from the same feeder.  
5. Remove any paper jammed, creased or both from the feeder.  
6. Replace the feeder in the printer.  
Clearing Paper Jams From the Output Expander  
Clearing Paper Jams From Inside the Output Expander  
NOTE: To resolve the error displayed on the operator panel, you must clear all print media from the print media  
path.  
1. Ensure that the printer is not in operation, and open the front door of the output expander.  
2. Rotate the knob clockwise and remove the jammed paper from the paper exit of the output expander.  
NOTICE: If the paper jam message remains, repeat the same procedure.  
3. Close the front door of the output expander.  
     
4. If the paper jam message remains, repeat Step 1 and Step 2.  
5. Close the front door of the output expander.  
Clearing Paper Jams From H Transport Unit  
NOTE: To resolve the error displayed on the operator panel, you must clear all print media from the print media  
path.  
1. Grasp the top cover handle of the output expander and open the cover.  
2. Remove the jammed paper.  
3. Close the top cover of the output expander.  
Clearing Staple Jams From the Output Expander  
1. Ensure that the printer is not in operation, and open the front door of the output expander.  
2. Grasp the orange lever on the stapler cartridge and pull out the cartridge.  
3. Visually check inside the output expander for any remaining staples.  
4. Lift the metal part of the stapler cartridge.  
5. Remove any staples jammed in the stapler cartridge.  
6. Close the metal part.  
7. Grasp the orange lever on the stapler cartridge and push the cartridge in the printer until it clicks into place.  
8. Close the front door of the output expander.  
Troubleshooting  
Basic Printer Problems  
Some printer problems can be easy to resolve. If a problem occurs with your printer, check each of the following:  
The power cable is plugged into the printer and a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
The printer's power is on.  
The electrical outlet is not turned off at any switch or breaker.  
Other electrical equipment plugged into the outlet is working.  
All options are properly installed.  
If you have checked all of the above and still have a problem, turn off the printer, wait for 10 seconds, and then turn on  
the printer. This often fixes the problem.  
Display Problems  
Problem  
Action  
Turn off the printer, wait for 10 seconds, and turn  
on the printer.  
After the printer is turned on, the display on the operator  
panel is blank, keeps showing Please wait..., or the  
back light is not lit.  
Self Test Message appears on the operator panel.  
When the test is completed, Ready to Print is  
displayed.  
Settings in the software program, the printer driver, or the  
printer utilities are overriding the settings made on the  
operator panel.  
Menu settings changed from the operator panel have no  
effect.  
Change the menu settings from the printer driver,  
the printer utilities, or the software program instead  
of the operator panel.  
Printing Problems  
Problem  
Action  
       
Ensure Ready to Print appears on the operator panel before you send a job to print. Press  
Menu button to return to Ready to Print.  
Ensure print media is loaded in the printer. Press Menu button to return to Ready to  
Print.  
Verify the printer is using the correct page description language (PDL).  
Verify that you are using the correct printer driver.  
Job did not print or  
incorrect characters  
printed.  
Ensure you are using the correct Ethernet, USB, Parallel cable, or wireless adapter and that  
it is securely connected to the printer.  
Verify that the correct print media size is selected.  
If using a print spooler, verify that the spooler has not stalled.  
Check the printer's interface from the Admin Menu.  
Determine the host interface you are using. Print a panel settings page to verify that the  
current interface settings are correct. Refer to "Printing a Panel Settings Page" for details on  
how to print a panel settings page.  
Ensure the print media you are using meets the specifications for your printer. See  
"Identifying Print Media and Specifications" for more information."  
Flex print media before loading it in any of the sources.  
Ensure the print media is loaded correctly.  
Ensure the width and length guides on the print media sources are adjusted correctly.  
Ensure the trays are securely inserted.  
Do not overfill the print media sources.  
Do not force print media into the multipurpose feeder (MPF) when you load it; otherwise, it  
may skew or buckle.  
Print media misfeeds  
or multiple feeds occur.  
Remove any curled print media from sources.  
Load the recommended print side correctly for the type of print media you are using. See  
Turn the print media over or around and try printing again to see if feeding improves.  
Do not mix print media types.  
Do not mix reams of print media.  
Remove the top and bottom curled sheets of a ream before loading the print media.  
Load a print media source only when it is empty.  
Wipe the separator rollers in the trays or MPF with a cloth that is slightly dampened with  
water.  
Envelope misfeeds or  
multiple feeds occur.  
Reduce the number of envelopes in the stack.  
Page breaks in  
unexpected places.  
Increase the setting for Time-Out in the Printer Settings menu in the Dell Printer  
Configuration Web Tool.  
Job prints from the wrong  
source or on the wrong  
print media.  
Check the Paper Types in the Tray Settings menu on the printer operator panel and in  
the printer driver.  
Print media does not  
stack neatly in the output Turn the print media stack over in the tray or MPF.  
bin.  
Ensure 2 Sided is selected in both the PCL (Printer Control Language) menu on the printer  
operator panel and in the printer driver.  
Printer does not duplex  
pages.  
Ensure you have enough print memory installed.  
Paper is curled in the  
trays.  
Load the paper into the MPF.  
Print Quality Problems  
NOTE: For information on how to use the operator panel and Dell Configuration Web Tool, see "Understanding the  
The output is too light.  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Go to  
action  
8.  
Go to  
action 2.  
1 Check if the whole page is printed light.  
The toner cartridges may be low or need to be replaced. Confirm the amount of toner in each  
toner cartridge.  
The task Go to  
is action  
2
1. Check the toner level in the Status tab in the Status Monitor.  
2. Replace the toner cartridges as necessary.  
complete. 3.  
Does this solve your problem?  
If you are using non-Dell brand toner cartridges, enable the Non-Dell Toner option.  
1. Launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool by entering your printer's IP address  
in your web browser. (If you do not know how to launch the Dell Printer Configuration  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
The task Go to  
3
is  
action  
3. Click the Printer Maintenance tab.  
complete. 4.  
4. Select Non-Dell Toner.  
5. Ensure that the On check box is not selected.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Disable the Toner Saving Mode in the printer driver.  
The task Go to  
4
5
1. On the Advanced tab, ensure that the Toner Saving Mode check box is not selected.  
is  
action  
complete. 5.  
Does this solve your problem?  
The print media surface may be uneven. Try changing the Paper Type setting in the printer  
driver. For example, change the plain paper to plain thick.  
The task Go to  
is  
complete. 6.  
action  
1. On the Paper/Output tab, change the Paper Type setting.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Verify that the correct print media is being used. See "Supported Paper Sizes." If not, use the  
print media recommended for the printer.  
The task Go to  
6
7
is  
action  
complete. 7.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Ensure that eight yellow ribbons are correctly removed from the drum cartridges. See "Replacing  
the Drum Cartridges." If not, remove the ribbons.  
The task Go to  
is  
action  
complete. 9.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Clean inside the printer by using the cleaning rod. See "Cleaning Inside the Printer."  
1. After the cleaning is completed, start Tool Box. For how to start Tool Box, see  
The task Go to  
8
The Tool Box opens.  
is  
action  
2. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
complete. 9.  
 
3. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button. The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare. See "Replacing the Drum Cartridges."  
1. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box. For how to start Tool Box, see  
The Tool Box opens.  
2. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
The task  
is  
complete.  
Contact  
Dell.  
9
3. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button. The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Toner smears or print comes off.  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Check if the envelope lever of the printer is lifted when you  
print on plain paper.  
If so, change it to the plain paper mode.  
For more information on how to change the mode, see  
Then raise the fixing temperature by turning up the value of  
the Adjust Fuser of the Dell Configuration Web Tool.  
Go to  
action  
2.  
1
The task is complete.  
NOTE: When you use the optional output expander, check if  
the lever of the output expander is pulled down (normal  
mode).  
For more information on how to change the mode, see  
Does this solve your problem?  
The print media surface may be uneven. Try changing the  
Paper Type setting in the printer driver. For example, change  
the plain paper to plain thick.  
Go to  
action  
3.  
2
The task is complete.  
The task is complete.  
1. On the Paper/Output tab, change the Paper Type  
setting.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Verify that the correct print media is being used. See  
"Supported Paper Sizes." If not, use the print media  
recommended for the printer.  
Go to  
action  
4.  
3
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the Drum  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box. For  
how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your Printer  
The task is complete. (The drum cartridge  
you are using has been damaged. Replace  
it with a new one.)  
Go to  
action  
5.  
4
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the 4 Colors Configuration Chart button. The 4  
Colors Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the fuser if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the fuser. See "Replacing the Fuser."  
2. After you replace the fuser, start Tool Box. For how to  
start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your Printer  
The task is complete. (The fuser you are  
using has been damaged. Replace it with a  
new one.)  
Contact  
Dell.  
5
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Random spots/blurred images  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Ensure that the toner cartridges are installed correctly.  
Go to  
action  
2.  
1
The task is complete.  
The task is complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Ensure that the drum cartridges are installed correctly.  
Go to  
action  
3.  
2
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box.  
For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your The task is complete. (The drum cartridge you  
Contact  
Dell.  
3
are using has been damaged. Replace it with a  
new one.)  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
The entire output is blank.  
Action  
The toner cartridges may be low or need to be replaced. Confirm the  
Yes  
No  
amount of toner in each toner cartridge.  
Go to  
action  
2.  
1
1. Check the toner level in the Status tab in the Status Monitor.  
2. Replace the toner cartridges as necessary.  
The task is complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
If you are using non-Dell brand toner cartridges, enable the Non-Dell  
Toner option.  
1. Launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool by entering  
your printer's IP address in your web browser. (If you do not know  
how to launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, see "Dell  
Go to  
action  
3.  
2
The task is complete.  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Maintenance tab.  
4. Select Non-Dell Toner.  
5. Ensure that the On check box is not selected.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Disable the Toner Saving Mode in the printer driver.  
Go to  
action  
4.  
1. On the Advanced tab, ensure that the Toner Saving Mode check  
3
4
The task is complete.  
The task is complete.  
box is not selected.  
Does this solve your problem?  
The print media surface may be uneven. Try changing the Paper Type  
setting in the printer driver. For example, change the plain paper to plain  
thick.  
Go to  
action  
5.  
1. On the Paper/Output tab, change the Paper Type setting.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Verify that the correct print media is being used. See "Supported Paper  
Sizes." If not, use the print media recommended for the printer.  
Go to  
action  
6.  
5
6
The task is complete.  
The task is complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Ensure that eight yellow ribbons are correctly removed from the drum  
cartridge. See "Replacing the Drum Cartridges." If not, remove the  
ribbons.  
Go to  
action  
7.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the Drum Cartridges."  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box. For how to  
start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your Printer Software."  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the 4 Colors Configuration Chart button.  
The 4 Colors Configuration Chart is printed.  
The task is complete. (The drum  
cartridge you are using has  
been damaged. Replace it with  
a new one.)  
Contact  
Dell.  
7
Does this solve your problem?  
Streaks appear on the output.  
Action  
The toner cartridges may be low or need to be replaced. Confirm the  
Yes  
No  
amount of toner in each toner cartridge.  
Go to  
action  
2.  
1
1. Check the toner level in the Status tab in the Status Monitor.  
2. Replace the toner cartridges as necessary.  
The task is complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
If you are using non-Dell brand toner cartridges, enable the Non-Dell  
Toner option.  
1. Launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool by entering  
your printer's IP address in your web browser. (If you do not know  
how to launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, see "Dell  
Go to  
action  
3.  
2
The task is complete.  
2. Select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Maintenance tab.  
4. Select Non-Dell Toner.  
5. Ensure that the On check box is not selected.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the Drum Cartridges."  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box. For how to  
start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your Printer Software."  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the 4 Colors Configuration Chart button.  
The 4 Colors Configuration Chart is printed.  
The task is complete. (The drum  
cartridge you are using has  
been damaged. Replace it with  
a new one.)  
Contact  
Dell.  
3
Does this solve your problem?  
Part or the entire output is black.  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Ensure that the toner cartridges are installed correctly.  
Go to  
action  
2.  
1
The task is complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Ensure Output Color is set to Color (Auto) in the printer  
driver.  
Go to  
action  
3.  
2
1. On the Graphics tab, ensure that the Output Color The task is complete.  
is set to Color (Auto).  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box.  
For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your The task is complete. (The drum cartridge you  
Contact  
Dell.  
3
are using has been damaged. Replace it with a  
new one.)  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the 4 Colors Configuration Chart button.  
The 4 Colors Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Pitched color dots  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Locate the cause of the problem using the Pitch  
Configuration Chart.  
1. Start Tool Box. For how to start Tool Box, see  
The Tool Box opens.  
Proceed to the action corresponding to the  
location of the problem:  
2. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
Contact  
Dell.  
3. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
1
Drum cartridge - 2  
Fuser - 3  
Belt unit - 4  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
4. Compare the pitch of the color spots on your output  
with that on the Pitch Configuration Chart, and  
locate the cause of the problem.  
Is the cause of the problem located?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the Drum  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box.  
For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
The task is complete. (The drum cartridge  
you are using has been damaged. Replace it  
with a new one.)  
Contact  
Dell.  
2
3
4
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the fuser if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the fuser. See "Replacing the Fuser."  
2. After you replace the fuser, start Tool Box. For how to  
start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your Printer  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The task is complete. (The fuser you are  
using has been damaged. Replace it with a  
new one.)  
Contact  
Dell.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the belt unit if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the belt unit. See "Replacing the Belt Unit."  
2. After you replace the belt unit, start Tool Box. For how  
to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your Printer  
The task is complete. (The belt unit you are  
using has been damaged. Replace it with a  
Contact  
The Tool Box opens.  
Dell.  
new one.)  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Vertical blanks  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Clean inside the printer by using the cleaning rod.  
1. After the cleaning is completed, start Tool Box. For  
how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your  
The Tool Box opens.  
2. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
Go to  
action  
8.  
1
The task is complete.  
3. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Ensure the light path is not covered.  
1. Remove the drum cartridge, and keep it in the dark  
2. Check the light path, and then remove the  
shielding.  
3. Reinstall the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the  
4. Start Tool Box. For how to start Tool Box, see  
The Tool Box opens.  
Go to  
action  
3.  
2
The task is complete.  
5. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
6. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box.  
For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
The task is complete. (The drum cartridge you  
are using has been damaged. Replace it with a  
new one.)  
Contact  
Dell.  
3
Does this solve your problem?  
Ghosting  
Action  
Locate the cause of the problem using the Ghost  
Yes  
No  
Configuration Chart.  
1. Start Tool Box. For how to start Tool Box, see  
The Tool Box opens.  
2. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
3. Click the Ghost Configuration Chart button.  
Proceed to the action corresponding to the  
type of ghosting.  
Contact  
Dell.  
1
Positive ghost - 2a  
Negative ghost - 2b  
The Ghost Configuration Chart is printed.  
Is the type of ghosting identified?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool  
Box. For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding The task is complete. (The drum cartridge you  
Contact  
Dell.  
2a  
2b  
The Tool Box opens.  
are using has been damaged. Replace it with  
a new one.)  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Ghost Configuration Chart button.  
The Ghost Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
If using non-recommended print media, use the print  
media recommended for the printer.  
Go to  
action  
2a.  
The task is complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Light-Induced Fatigue  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Check if the print defect falls under the patterns of light-  
induced fatigue.  
1. Start Tool Box. For how to start Tool Box, see  
The Tool Box opens.  
2. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
Contact  
Dell.  
1
Go to action 2.  
3. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does the print defect fall under the patterns of light-  
induced fatigue?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box.  
The task is complete. (The drum cartridge you  
are using has been damaged. Replace it with a  
new one.)  
For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Contact  
Dell.  
2
Does this solve your problem?  
Fog  
Action  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
Yes  
No  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box.  
For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your  
The task is complete. (The drum cartridge you  
are using has been damaged. Replace it with a  
new one.)  
Contact  
Dell.  
1
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the 4 Color Configuration Chart button.  
The 4 Color Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Bead-Carry-Out (BCO)  
Action  
Yes  
No  
If the printer is installed in a high altitude location, set the altitude of the  
location.  
1. Launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool by entering  
your printer's IP address in your web browser. (If you do not know  
how to launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, see "Dell  
2. When the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool starts, select Printer The task is complete.  
Settings.  
Go to  
action  
2.  
1
3. Click the Printer Maintenance tab.  
4. Click Adjust Altitude on the Printer Maintenance tab.  
5. Select the value close to the altitude of the location where the  
printer is installed.  
Is the problem recovered?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the Drum Cartridges."  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box. For how to  
The task is complete. (The drum  
cartridge you are using has  
start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your Printer Software."  
The Tool Box opens.  
Contact  
2
been damaged. Replace it with  
a new one.)  
Dell.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the 4 Color Configuration Chart button.  
The 4 Color Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Jagged characters  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Set Print Mode to High Quality in the printer driver.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to  
action 2.  
1
1. On the Graphics tab, select High Quality from Print Mode.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Enable Bitmap Text Smoothing in the printer driver.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to  
action 3.  
2
3
1. On the Advanced tab, set Bitmap Text Smoothing under Items to On.  
Does this solve your problem?  
If using a downloaded font, ensure that the font is recommended for the printer,  
operating system, and the application being used.  
The task is  
complete.  
Contact  
Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Banding  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Locate the cause of the problem using the MQ Chart.  
1. Start Tool Box. For how to start Tool Box, see  
The Tool Box opens.  
2. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
3. Click the MQ Chart button.  
Proceed to the action corresponding to the  
location of the problem:  
1
Drum cartridge - 2  
Fuser - 3  
Belt unit- 4  
-
The MQ Chart is printed.  
Is the cause of the problem located?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box.  
For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the MQ Chart button.  
The task is complete. (The drum cartridge you  
are using has been damaged. Replace it with a  
new one.)  
Contact  
Dell.  
2
The MQ Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the fuser if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the fuser. See "Replacing the Fuser."  
2. After you replace the fuser, start Tool Box. For how  
to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your Printer  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the MQ Chart button.  
The task is complete. (The fuser you are using  
has been damaged. Replace it with a new  
one.)  
Contact  
Dell.  
3
The MQ Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the belt unit if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the belt unit. See "Replacing the Belt Unit."  
2. After you replace the belt unit, start Tool Box. For  
how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
Contact  
Dell.  
4
The task is complete.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Auger mark  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Check if the print defect falls under the patterns of auger  
marks.  
1. Start Tool Box. For how to start Tool Box, see  
The Tool Box opens.  
2. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
Contact  
Dell.  
1
Go to action 2.  
3. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does the print defect fall under the patterns of auger  
marks?  
The toner cartridges may be low or need to be replaced.  
Confirm the amount of toner in each toner cartridge.  
Go to  
action  
3.  
1. Check the toner level in the Status tab in the Status  
2
The task is complete.  
Monitor.  
2. Replace the toner cartridges as necessary.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the drum cartridge. See "Replacing the  
2. After you replace the drum cartridge, start Tool Box.  
For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your The task is complete. (The drum cartridge you  
Contact  
Dell.  
3
are using has been damaged. Replace it with a  
new one.)  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Wrinkled/stained paper  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Verify that the correct print media is being used.  
See "Supported Paper Sizes." If not, use the print  
media recommended for the printer, and test print  
Proceed to the action  
corresponding to the type of print  
media.  
1
The task is complete.  
your document again.  
Plain paper - 2  
Envelope - 4  
Does this solve your problem?  
Check if the envelope lever of the printer is lifted  
up when you print on plain paper, and test print  
your document again.  
NOTE: When you use the optional output  
expander, check if the lever of the output  
2
The task is complete.  
Go to action 3.  
expander is pulled down (normal mode).  
For more information on how to change the mode,  
Does this solve your problem?  
If using non-recommended print media, use the  
print media recommended for the printer, and test  
The print media you are  
3
using is not supported. Use Contact Dell.  
another one.  
print your document again.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Check if the envelope lever of the printer is down  
when you print on envelope, and test print your  
document again.  
NOTE: When you use the optional output  
expander, check if the lever of the output  
expander is pulled up (envelope mode).  
For more information on how to change the mode,  
4
5
The task is complete.  
Go to action 5.  
Does this solve your problem?  
If using non-recommended envelope, change it to  
recommended one and try again.  
The envelope you are using  
is not supported. Use the  
Go to action 6.  
recommended one.  
Does this solve your problem?  
The wrinkle had appeared  
within the allowable range.  
You can use the envelope  
you are using.  
Check if the wrinkle appeared within the square  
whose each edge is 30 mm inside the four sides of  
the envelope.  
6
7
Go to action 7.  
Contact Dell.  
Change the envelope with another one and try  
again.  
The task is complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
If the wrinkle appeared on the envelope flap,  
confirm the type of the tray in which the envelope Go to action 9.  
is set first. Is it the MPF?  
(Tray 1)  
8
Go to action 11.  
Press the envelope to expel any remaining air in it.  
9
The task is complete.  
Go to action 10.  
Go to action 11.  
Is the problem reduced or recovered?  
Use Tray 1 to feed the envelope.  
10  
The task is complete.  
The task is complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
The occurrence of wrinkles on  
envelope flaps does not indicate  
printer failure. There is no  
problem to use the printer.  
Change the envelope with another one and then  
try again.  
11  
Is the problem reduced or recovered?  
Damage on the leading edge of paper  
Action  
Yes  
No  
(MPF)  
When you use the MPF, reverse the paper and then try again.  
Go to action 2.  
1 When you use any of the Tray 1 to 5, change the paper and then try again. The task is complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
(Tray 1 to 5)  
Contact Dell.  
Change the paper with another one and then try again.  
2
3
The task is complete. Go to action 3.  
The task is complete. Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Use any of the Tray 1 to 5 in place of the MPF.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Jam/Alignment Problems  
NOTE: Some of the following procedures that use the Tool Box can also be performed using the operator panel or  
Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. For information on how to use the operator panel and Dell Configuration Web  
The top margin is incorrect  
 
Action  
Ensure that the margin is installed correctly on the application being used.  
Yes  
No  
1
The task is complete. Go to action 2.  
The task is complete. Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
In Customer mode, correct the S-S direction KtoP parameter.  
2
Does this solve your problem?  
The side margin is incorrect  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The tray where the trouble  
occurred is:  
Ensure that the margin is installed correctly on the application  
being used.  
The task is  
complete.  
1
MPF: Go to action 2a.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Others: Go to action 2b.  
Ensure that the paper guides are installed correctly.  
The task is  
complete.  
2a  
Go to action 3a.  
Go to action 3b.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Ensure that the paper guides are installed correctly.  
The task is  
complete.  
2b  
Does this solve your problem?  
In Customer mode, correct the F-S direction parameter of  
the MPF.  
The task is  
complete.  
3a  
Contact Dell.  
Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
In Customer mode, correct the F-S direction parameter of  
the tray.  
The task is  
complete.  
3b  
Does this solve your problem?  
Color registration is out of alignment  
Action  
Adjust the settings of the paper type on the printer driver to those of the tray.  
Yes  
No  
The task Go to  
is action  
complete. 2.  
1
Does this solve your problem?  
Execute auto color registration adjustment.  
1. Launch the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool by entering your printer's IP address  
in your web browser. (If you do not know how to launch the Dell Printer Configuration  
2. When the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool starts, select Printer Settings.  
3. Click the Printer Maintenance tab.  
The task Go to  
2
is  
action  
complete. 3a.  
4. Select Color Registration Adjustments.  
5. Select Auto Correct and then click start.  
6. See the report output from the printer.  
Does this solve your problem?  
The task  
is  
complete.  
Replace the drum cartridge if you have a spare. See "Prepare Printer Hardware."  
Does this solve your problem?  
Contact  
Dell.  
3a  
3b  
Print the Color Regi Configuration Chart and manually correct the color registration.  
1. On the Registration Adjustment page, click the Color Regi Chart button.  
The Color Regi Configuration Chart is printed.  
The task  
is  
complete.  
Contact  
Dell.  
2. Identify the offset values from the chart and enter them in Enter Number. See  
3. Click the Apply New Settings button.  
4. Click the Color Regi Chart button to print the Color Regi Configuration Chart again.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Images are skewed  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Adjust the paper guides properly.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
2.  
1
Does this solve your problem?  
Install the belt unit according to an appropriate procedure. See "Installing a Belt  
Unit."  
The task is  
complete.  
2
Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Tray 1 Misfeed jam  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Proceed to the action corresponding to the type of  
the print media being used:  
Thick - 2a  
Thin - 2b  
Coated - 2c  
Envelope - 2d  
Label paper - 2e  
Transparency - 2f  
Manual Dup - 2g  
Others - 2h  
Ensure that the tray 1 is properly inserted.  
The task is  
complete.  
1
Does this solve your problem?  
Use thick paper that is 216 gsm or less.  
The task is  
complete.  
2a  
Go to action 3a.  
Go to action 3a.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Use thin paper that is 60 gsm or more.  
The task is  
complete.  
2b  
Does this solve your problem?  
Load coated paper on the MPF one sheet at a  
time.  
The task is  
complete.  
2c  
Go to action 3b.  
Go to action 3c.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Correct the position of the envelop flap. See  
The task is  
complete.  
2d  
Does this solve your problem?  
Reduce label papers set to 49 mm or less.  
The task is  
complete.  
2e  
Go to action 2g.  
Go to action 3a.  
Go to action 3a.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Reduce transparencies set to 12 mm or less.  
The task is  
complete.  
2f  
Does this solve your problem?  
Ensure that the print media is not curled.  
The task is  
complete.  
2g  
Does this solve your problem?  
Is the print media damp?  
The task is  
complete.  
2h If so, turn the media over and then try again.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Go to action 4a.  
Fan the print media.  
3a  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action 3b.  
Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Wipe the separator rollers in tray 1 with a  
The task is  
complete.  
cloth moistened with water.  
3b  
Does this solve your problem?  
Press the envelope to expel any remaining air  
in it.  
The task is  
complete.  
3c  
Go to action 3d.  
Go to action 4b.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Smooth the envelope if there is any distortion  
on it.  
The task is  
complete.  
3d  
Does this solve your problem?  
Use print media that is not damp.  
4a  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action 3a.  
Go to action 4c.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Reduce the number of envelopes set.  
4b  
The task is  
complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Change the envelope with another one and  
then try again.  
The task is  
complete.  
4c  
Go to action 3b.  
Is the problem reduced or recovered?  
MPF Misfeed jam  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Proceed to the action corresponding to the type of the print media being  
used:  
Thick - 2a  
Thin - 2b  
1
-
-
Coated - 2c  
Envelope - 2d  
manual Dup - 2e  
Others - 2f  
Use thick paper that is 216 gsm or less.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
3a.  
2a  
2b  
2c  
2d  
2e  
Does this solve your problem?  
Use thin paper that is 60 gsm or more.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
3a.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Load coated paper one sheet at a time.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
3b.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Correct the position of the envelop flap. See "Loading Print Media."  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
3c.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Ensure that the print media is not curled.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
3a.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Is the print media damp?  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
4a.  
2f If so, turn the media over and then try again.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Fan the print media.  
3a  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
3b.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Wipe the separator rollers in MPF with a cloth moistened with water.  
The task is  
complete.  
3b  
Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Press the envelope to expel any remaining air in it.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
3d.  
3c  
Does this solve your problem?  
Smooth the envelope if there is any distortion on it.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
4b.  
3d  
Does this solve your problem?  
Use print media that is not damp.  
4a  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
3a.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Reduce the number of envelopes set.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
4c.  
4b  
Does this solve your problem?  
Change the envelope with another one and then try again.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
3b.  
4c  
Is the problem reduced or recovered?  
Option Tray Misfeed jam  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Ensure that the tray is properly inserted.  
The task is  
complete.  
1
Go to action 2.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Proceed to the action corresponding to the type of  
the print media being used:  
Ensure the right hand cover is closed.  
The task is  
complete.  
Thick - 3a  
Thin - 3b  
Manual Dup - 3c  
Others - 3d  
2
Does this solve your problem?  
Use thick paper that is 216 gsm or less.  
The task is  
complete.  
3a  
Go to action 4a.  
Go to action 4a.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Use thin paper that is 60 gsm or more.  
The task is  
complete.  
3b  
Does this solve your problem?  
Ensure that the print media is not curled.  
The task is  
complete.  
3c  
Go to action 4a.  
Go to action 5.  
Go to action 4b.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Go to action  
4c.  
3d Is the print media damp?  
Fan the print media.  
4a  
The task is  
complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Wipe the separator rollers in tray with a cloth  
moistened with water.  
The task is  
complete.  
4b  
Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Turn over the print media.  
4c  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action 4a.  
Go to action 4a.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Use print media that is not damp.  
The task is  
complete.  
5
Does this solve your problem?  
Regi jam (Exit Sensor On JAM)  
Action  
Yes  
The task is complete.  
No  
Go to  
action  
2.  
Ensure that the fuser is set properly.  
1
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the fuser if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the fuser. See "Replacing the Fuser."  
2. After you replace the fuser, start Tool Box. For how  
to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your Printer  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
The task is complete. (The fuser you are using Go to  
2
has been damaged. Replace it with a new  
one.)  
action  
3.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Go to  
action  
Ensure that the transfer roller is installed correctly.  
3
The task is complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
4.  
Replace the transfer roller if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the transfer roller. See "Replacing the  
2. After you replace the transfer roller, start Tool Box.  
For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your The task is complete. (The transfer roller you  
Go to  
4
5
6
The Tool Box opens.  
are using has been damaged. Replace it with a action  
new one.)  
5.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Go to  
action  
6.  
Ensure that the belt unit is installed correctly.  
Does this solve your problem?  
The task is complete.  
Replace the belt unit if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the belt unit. See "Replacing the Belt Unit."  
2. After you replace the belt unit, start Tool Box. For  
how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The task is complete. (The belt unit you are  
using has been damaged. Replace it with a  
new one.)  
Contact  
Dell.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Exit Jam (Exit Sensor Off JAM)  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Go to  
action  
2.  
Ensure the fuser is installed correctly.  
1
The task is complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the fuser if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the fuser. See "Replacing the Fuser."  
2. After you replace the fuser, start Tool Box. For how  
to start Tool Box, see "Understanding Your Printer  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
The task is complete. (The fuser you are using Go to  
2
has been damaged. Replace it with a new  
one.)  
action  
3.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Tray 1/Option Tray Multi-feed jam  
Action  
Yes  
No  
If using coated paper, go to  
action 2.  
Ensure that the tray where the multi-feed occurred is inserted  
properly.  
The task is  
complete.  
1
If using other type of print  
media, go to action 3.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Load coated paper on the MPF one sheet at a time.  
The task is  
complete.  
2
Go to action 4.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Use print media that is not damp.  
The task is  
complete.  
3
4
Go to action 4.  
Go to action 5.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Fan the print media.  
The task is  
complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Wipe the separator rollers in the tray where the multi-feed occurred  
with a cloth moistened with water.  
The task is  
complete.  
5
6
Go to action 6.  
Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the separator rollers in the tray where the multi-feed  
occurred if you have a spare.  
The task is  
complete.  
Does this solve your problem?  
MPF Multi-feed jam  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Ensure the media type you are using.  
1 If using coated paper, go to action 2.  
-
-
If using other type of print media, go to action 3.  
Use print media that is not damp.  
2
The task is complete. Go to action 3.  
The task is complete. Go to action 4.  
The task is complete. Go to action 5.  
The task is complete. Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Fan the print media.  
3
Does this solve your problem?  
Wipe the separator rollers in the MPF with a cloth moistened with water.  
4
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the separator rollers in the MPF if you have a spare.  
5
Does this solve your problem?  
Noise  
Action  
To specify the cause of the noise, perform the Auto  
Yes  
No  
Go to  
action  
3.  
Registration Adjustment.  
1
Go to action 2.  
Does the noise persist?  
Replace the belt unit if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the belt unit. See "Replacing the Belt  
Unit."  
2. After you replace the belt unit, start Tool Box.  
For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding  
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The task is complete. (The belt unit you are  
using has been damaged. Replace it with a new  
one.)  
Go to  
action  
4.  
2
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the fuser if you have a spare.  
1. Replace the fuser. See "Replacing the Fuser."  
 
2. After you replace the fuser, click start Tool Box.  
For how to start Tool Box, see "Understanding  
Go to  
action  
7
The task is complete. (The fuser you are using  
has been damaged. Replace it with a new one.)  
3
The Tool Box opens.  
3. Select Chart Print from the left list.  
4. Click the Pitch Configuration Chart button.  
The Pitch Configuration Chart is printed.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the waste box.  
The task is complete. (The waste box you are  
using has been damaged. Replace it with a new  
one.)  
Go to  
action  
5.  
4
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the drum cartridge (K).  
Does this solve your problem?  
Replace the drum cartridge (YMC).  
Does this solve your problem?  
The task is complete. (The drum cartridge (K)  
you are using has been damaged. Replace it with action  
a new one.)  
Go to  
5
6.  
The task is complete. (The drum cartridge (YMC)  
you are using has been damaged. Replace it with  
a new one.)  
Contact  
Dell.  
6
The task is complete. (The toner cartridge (K)  
you are using has been damaged. Replace it with action  
a new one.)  
Go to  
Replace the toner cartridge (K). See "Replacing the  
7
8.  
The task is complete. (The toner cartridge (Y)  
you are using has been damaged. Replace it with action  
a new one.)  
Go to  
Replace the toner cartridge (Y). See "Replacing the  
8
9.  
The task is complete. (The toner cartridge (M)  
you are using has been damaged. Replace it with action  
a new one.)  
Go to  
Replace the toner cartridge (M). See "Replacing the  
9
10.  
The task is complete. (The toner cartridge (C)  
you are using has been damaged. Replace it with  
a new one.)  
Replace the toner cartridge (C). See "Replacing the  
Contact  
Dell.  
10  
Digital Certificate Problem  
Symptom  
Cause  
Action  
The LDAP-  
SSL/TLS  
Communication  
setting and the  
Upload Signed  
Certificate  
Confirm whether the HDD is connected  
correctly, and confirm whether Data  
Encryption is enabled from the operator  
panel or EWS.  
An encrypted HDD is not connected.  
button are not  
displayed  
The certificate  
import button is  
disabled.  
Create a self-signed certificate and enable  
SSL.  
SSL communication is disabled.  
The time setting is incorrect.  
The certificate  
details button is  
disabled.  
Confirm validity period of the certificate as  
well as the time setting of the device.  
Confirm whether the password is correct.  
Confirm whether the file type is  
PKCS#7/#12 or x509CACert (extension:  
p7b/p12/pfx/cer/crt).  
The certificate  
cannot be  
imported.  
The certificate file is incorrect.  
The browser is incorrect.  
Confirm whether the attribute information  
(key Usage/ Extended key usage) of the  
certificate to be imported is set correctly.  
Use Internet Explorer.  
 
016-404 is  
displayed when  
setting the  
encryption of  
the HDD to  
OFF.  
016-404 is  
displayed when  
formatting the  
HDD.  
Security is set  
to OFF when  
setting  
encryption of  
the HDD to  
OFF.  
The HDD is formatted and the certificate data is deleted  
when setting encryption of the HDD to OFF. Since a  
certificate is required and the security function cannot be  
enabled when restarting the device afterward, 016-404 is  
displayed and the security setting must be initialized. The  
cause is the same when formatting the HDD or removing  
the HDD.  
After initializing, import the certificate and  
enable the security settings again. The  
action is the same when formatting the  
HDD.  
Security is set  
to OFF when  
formatting the  
HDD.  
A certificate is  
deleted when  
setting  
encryption of  
the HDD to  
OFF.  
A certificate is  
deleted when  
formatting the  
HDD.  
The validity period of the certificate is  
invalid. Confirm whether the time setting  
of the machine is correct, and whether  
the validity period of the certificate has  
expired.  
The validity period is invalid.  
The certificate path is invalid.  
A certificate  
cannot be set  
with "Certificate  
Details".  
The certificate chain (path validation) of  
the imported certificate may not be  
correctly validated. Confirm whether all of  
the high-level certificates  
(Trusted/Intermediate) have been  
imported and are not deleted, and  
whether the validity period has expired.  
Although a  
certificate was  
imported, it is  
not displayed  
when selecting  
with "Local  
To import a certificate for use with the  
device (own device), import the secret  
key and a certificate of the PKCS#12  
(p12/pfx) format as a pair.  
The type of the certificate is incorrect.  
Device".  
Although importing a root certificate  
(Trusted) to use for server authentication,  
an Intermediate certificate may be  
required when validating the path.  
Server  
validation is not  
operating  
correctly.  
The certificate chain is incorrect when importing.  
When executing a certificate file with the  
certification authority, create the  
certificate with a format including all  
paths and then import that certificate.  
Digital  
Either the certificate has not been  
Signature  
cannot be  
selected with  
the IPsec  
setting.  
imported or the certificate has not been  
associated for use with Digital Signature  
The certificate cannot be associated.  
of IPsec. Refer to "  
a certificate of Ipsec.  
Problems with Installed Optional Accessories  
If an option does not operate correctly following installation or stops working:  
Turn off the printer, wait for 10 seconds, and then turn on the printer. If this does not fix the problem, unplug the  
printer, and check the connection between the option and the printer.  
Print the printer settings page to see if the option is listed in the Installed Options list. If the option is not listed,  
reinstall it. See "Printing a Printer Settings Page."  
Ensure that the printer driver is updated with the option you want to use.  
Ensure the option is selected in the printer driver you are using.  
The following table lists printer's option and corrective action for related problem. If the suggested corrective action does  
not correct the problem, call customer service.  
Problem  
Action  
Ensure the 550-sheet feeder is correctly connected to the printer. Reinstall the feeder. See  
Ensure the print media is loaded correctly. See "Loading Print Media in Standard and Optional Trays"  
for more information.  
550-sheet  
feeder  
Ensure the 1100-sheet feeder is correctly connected to the printer. Reinstall the feeder. See  
1100-  
sheet  
feeder  
Ensure the print media is loaded correctly. See "Loading Print Media in Standard and Optional Trays" for  
more information.  
Memory  
Ensure the memory is securely connected to the memory connector.  
Ensure the hard disk is securely inserted to the correct slot.  
Hard disk  
Wireless  
adapter  
Ensure the wireless adapter is securely inserted to the correct slot.  
Ensure the output expander is securely inserted to the correct slot.  
Output  
expander  
If a problem occurs with the output expander, check the following solutions:  
Compile Exit SNR ON Jam  
Action  
Ensure that the print media is loaded in the tray properly.  
Yes  
No  
1
The task is complete. Go to action 2.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Check if the print media is deformed.  
2 If deformed, change the print media to one not deformed.  
The task is complete. Go to action 3.  
The task is complete. Go to action 4.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Check if the print media is curled.  
3 Uncurl the print media and then set it again.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Remove the print media left in the H Transport Unit.  
4
The task is complete. Go to action 5.  
The task is complete. Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Wipe the separator rollers in tray 1 with a cloth moistened with water.  
5
Does this solve your problem?  
 
Compile Exit SNR OFF Jam  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Remove the print media left in the H Transport Unit.  
1
The task is complete. Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Set Eject Jam  
Action  
Yes  
No  
If using non-recommended print media, use the print media recommended for  
the printer.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
2.  
1
Does this solve your problem?  
Check if the print media on the tray obstruct the output slot.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
3.  
2 Remove the print media on the tray.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Check if the print media is curled.  
The task is  
complete.  
Go to action  
4.  
3 Uncurl the print media and then set it again.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Wipe the separator rollers in tray 1 with a cloth moistened with water.  
The task is  
complete.  
4
Contact Dell.  
Does this solve your problem?  
Other Problems  
Problem  
Action  
Condensation  
has occurred  
inside the  
This usually occurs within several hours after you heat the room in winter. This also occurs when the  
printer is operating in a location where relative humidity reaches 85% or more. Adjust the humidity  
or relocate the printer to an appropriate environment.  
printer.  
Contacting Service  
When you call for printer service, be prepared to describe the problem you are experiencing or the error message on the  
display.  
You need to know your printer's model type and serial number. See the label located inside the side door of your printer.  
   
Appendix  
Dell Technical Support Policy  
Technician-assisted technical support requires the cooperation and participation of the customer in the troubleshooting  
process and provides for restoration of the operating system, software program and hardware drivers to the original  
default configuration as shipped from Dell, as well as the verification of appropriate functionality of the printer and all Dell-  
installed hardware. In addition to this technician assisted technical support, online technical support is available at Dell  
Support. Additional technical support options may be available for purchase.  
Dell provides limited technical support for the printer and any Dell-installed software and peripherals. Support for third-  
party software and peripherals is provided by the original manufacturer, including those purchased and/or installed  
through Software & Peripherals (DellWare), ReadyWare, and Custom Factory Integration (CFI/DellPlus).  
Online Services  
You can learn about Dell products and services on the following websites:  
www.dell.com/jp (Japan only)  
www.euro.dell.com (Europe only)  
www.dell.com/la (Latin American and Caribbean countries)  
www.dell.ca (Canada only)  
You can access Dell Support through the following websites and e-mail addresses:  
Dell Support websites  
Dell Support e-mail addresses  
[email protected] (Latin America and Caribbean countries only)  
[email protected] (Asian/Pacific countries only)  
Dell Marketing and Sales e-mail addresses  
[email protected] (Asian/Pacific countries only)  
[email protected] (Canada only)  
Anonymous file transfer protocol (FTP)  
ftp.dell.com  
Log in as user: anonymous, and use your e-mail address as your password.  
   
Warranty and Return Policy  
Dell Computer Corporation ("Dell") manufactures its hardware products from parts and components that are new or  
equivalent to new in accordance with industry-standard practices. For information about the Dell warranty for your  
Recycling Information  
It is recommended that customers dispose of their used computer hardware, monitors, printers, and other peripherals in  
an environmentally sound manner. Potential methods include reuse of parts or whole products and recycling of products,  
components, and/or materials.  
For specific information on Dell's worldwide recycling programs, see www.dell.com/recyclingworldwide.  
Contacting Dell  
For customers in the United States, call 800-WWW-Dell (800-999-3355).  
NOTE: If you do not have an active Internet connection, you can find contact information on your purchase invoice,  
packing slip, bill, in your Dell catalog.  
Dell provides several online and telephone-based support and service options. Availability varies by country and product,  
and some services may not be available in your area. To contact Dell for sales, technical support, or customer service  
issues:  
1. Visit support.dell.com.  
2. Verify your country or region in the Choose A Country/Region drop-down menu at the bottom of the page.  
3. Click Contact Us on the left side of the page.  
4. Select the appropriate service or support link based on your need.  
5. Choose the method of contacting Dell that is convenient for you.  
   

Xerox All In One Printer M15 User Manual
Toshiba Air Conditioner Rav Sm1102bt E User Manual
Schumacher Ssc 1000a User Manual
Sanyo Kr 800aae User Manual
Psc Falcon 315 User Manual
Philips Scd590 User Manual
Panasonic Kx Fm189e User Manual
Motorola L404c User Manual
LG LRBP1031T User Manual
BLACK DECKER GH1000 User Manual